Mercedes-Benz SLK Class 2007 Operator's Manual
Add to My manuals473 Pages
The Mercedes-Benz SLK Class 2007 is a sleek roadster designed for exhilarating drives. This manual provides a comprehensive guide to its features, covering everything from unlocking and starting the engine to operating the advanced driving systems and safety features. Learn about its unique SmartKey technology, navigate the multifunction steering wheel, and explore the powerful audio system. This manual will help you master the intricate details of your SLK Class 2007 and ensure a safe and enjoyable driving experience.
advertisement
▼
Scroll to page 2
of
473
Sommer\ Corporate\ Media\ AG 1 7 1 5 8 4 1 6 8 2 Order No. 6515 3269 13 Part No. 171 584 16 82 Edition B 2007 SLK-Class Operator’s Manual SLK-Class SLK 280 SLK 350 SLK 55 AMG Our company and staff congratulate you on the purchase of your new Mercedes-Benz. Your selection of our product is a demonstration of your trust in our company name. Furthermore, it exemplifies your desire to own an automobile that will be as easy as possible to operate and provide years of service. Your Mercedes-Benz represents the efforts of many skilled engineers and craftsmen. To help assure your driving pleasure, and also the safety of you and your passengers, we ask you to make a small investment of time: 앫 Please read this manual carefully, then return it to your vehicle where it will be handy for your reference. 앫 Please follow the recommendations contained in this manual. They are designed to acquaint you with the operation of your Mercedes-Benz. 앫 Please pay attention to the warnings and cautions contained in this manual. They are designed to help improve the safety of the vehicle operator and occupants. We extend our best wishes for many miles of safe, pleasurable driving. Mercedes-Benz USA, LLC A DaimlerChrysler Company Contents Introduction ......................................... 9 Product information................................ 9 Operator’s Manual ............................... 10 Service and warranty information .. 10 Important notice for California retail buyers and lessees of Mercedes-Benz automobiles .......... 11 Maintenance .................................. 12 Roadside Assistance ...................... 12 Change of address or ownership.... 12 Operating your vehicle outside the USA or Canada......................... 13 Where to find it.................................... 14 Symbols............................................... 15 Operating safety .................................. 16 Proper use of the vehicle ............... 16 Problems with your vehicle.................. 17 Reporting safety defects...................... 18 Reporting safety defects ................ 18 Vehicle data recording......................... 19 Information regarding electronic recording devices........................... 19 At a glance .......................................... 21 Exterior view......................................... 22 Cockpit................................................. 24 Instrument cluster ................................ 26 Multifunction steering wheel ................ 28 Center console ..................................... 29 Upper part ...................................... 29 Lower part ...................................... 30 Overhead control panel ........................ 31 Storage compartments......................... 32 Door control panel................................ 34 Getting started................................... Unlocking ............................................. Unlocking with the SmartKey ......... Starter switch positions.................. Adjusting .............................................. Seats .............................................. Steering wheel................................ Mirrors............................................ Driving.................................................. Fastening the seat belts ................. Starting the engine ......................... Parking brake ................................. Driving off ....................................... Switching on headlamps................. Turn signals .................................... Windshield wipers........................... Problems while driving.................... Parking and locking.............................. Parking brake ................................. Switching off headlamps................. Turning off engine........................... Releasing seat belts........................ Locking ........................................... 35 36 36 37 39 39 43 46 48 48 51 53 53 55 55 56 58 59 59 61 61 61 62 Contents Safety and Security ........................... Occupant safety................................... Air bags .......................................... Occupant Classification System..... Seat belts ....................................... Children in the vehicle.................... Panic alarm .......................................... Activating ....................................... Deactivating ................................... Driving safety systems......................... ABS ................................................ BAS ................................................ ESP® ............................................... Anti-theft systems................................ Immobilizer..................................... Anti-theft alarm system.................. Tow-away alarm ............................. 63 64 66 71 76 79 83 83 83 84 84 86 86 90 90 90 91 Controls in detail ............................... 93 Locking and unlocking ......................... 94 SmartKey ....................................... 94 Opening the doors from the inside ....................................... 99 Opening the trunk ........................ 100 Closing the trunk.......................... 100 Trunk lid emergency release ........ 101 Automatic central locking ............ 102 Locking and unlocking from the inside ........................................... 102 Seats ................................................. 104 Seat heating*............................... 104 AIRSCARF neck-level heating* ..... 105 Memory function* ............................. 107 Storing positions into memory ..... 108 Recalling positions from memory. 108 Lighting.............................................. 109 Exterior lamp switch..................... 109 Combination switch ..................... 113 Corner-illuminating front fog lamps* ................................... 114 Hazard warning flasher ................ 115 Interior lighting............................. 116 Door entry lamps ......................... 117 Instrument cluster ............................. Adjusting instrument cluster illumination .................................. Tachometer.................................. Outside temperature indicator..... Resetting trip odometer ............... Clock............................................ Control system .................................. Multifunction display.................... Multifunction steering wheel........ Menus.......................................... Standard display menu ................ AMG menu ................................... AUDIO menu ................................ NAV* menu.................................. Vehicle status message memory menu.............................. Settings menu.............................. Trip computer menu..................... TEL* menu ................................... Manual transmission ......................... Shifting into reverse..................... 118 118 119 119 120 120 121 121 122 124 127 128 133 135 135 136 148 149 153 154 Contents Automatic transmission*................... Gear selector lever....................... Shifting procedure ....................... Gear selector lever positions ....... Driving tips................................... Gear ranges ................................. Automatic shift program .............. Gear selector lever one-touch gearshifting .................................. Steering wheel gearshift control one-touch gearshifting* ............... Manual shift program* ................. Emergency operation (Limp-Home Mode) ...................... Good visibility .................................... Headlamp cleaning system* ........ Rear view mirrors ......................... Sun visors .................................... Rear window defroster ................. 155 155 156 157 159 160 161 162 163 165 167 168 168 168 170 170 Climate control................................... 172 Switching climate control system on/off............................... 175 Setting the temperature................ 175 Adjusting air distribution............... 176 Adjusting air volume ..................... 177 Basic settings ............................... 177 Front defroster.............................. 177 Air recirculation mode .................. 178 Air conditioning............................. 180 Residual engine heat utilization .... 181 Automatic climate control* ................ 182 Deactivating the climate control system .......................................... 185 Operating the climate control system in automatic mode............ 186 Setting the temperature................ 186 Adjusting air distribution............... 187 Adjusting air volume ..................... 188 Front defroster.............................. 188 Maximum cooling MAX COOL ....... 189 Air recirculation mode .................. 189 Air conditioning............................. 191 Residual heat and ventilation........ 192 Audio system...................................... 193 Audio and telephone*, operation.. 193 Operating safety ........................... 193 Operating and display elements ... 194 Button and soft key operation ...... 196 Operation...................................... 196 Radio operation ............................ 199 Introduction to satellite radio* (USA only)..................................... 203 CD mode....................................... 208 GSM network phones ................... 219 TDMA or CDMA network phones .. 226 Emergency calls “911” ................. 233 Power windows .................................. 235 Opening and closing the windows 235 Synchronizing power windows...... 239 Retractable hardtop ........................... 240 Opening and closing the retractable hardtop....................... 240 Wind screen*................................ 246 Driving systems.................................. 247 Cruise control ............................... 247 Contents Loading .............................................. Roof rack...................................... Useful features .................................. Storage compartments................. Shelf behind roll bars ................... Cup holder.................................... Ashtray......................................... Cigarette lighter ........................... Power outlet................................. Floormat (driver’s side only) ......... Telephone*................................... Tele Aid* ...................................... Garage door opener* ................... Heated steering wheel* (SLK 280, SLK 350, Canada only) 251 251 252 252 254 254 255 256 257 257 258 261 270 276 Operation ......................................... The first 1000 miles (1500 km)......... Driving instructions............................ Drive sensibly – save fuel............. Drinking and driving ..................... Pedals .......................................... Power assistance ......................... Brakes.......................................... Driving off .................................... Parking......................................... Tires ............................................. Hydroplaning................................ Tire traction.................................. Tire speed rating .......................... Winter driving instructions ........... Standing water............................. Passenger compartment .............. Driving abroad.............................. Control and operation of radio transmitter ................................... Catalytic converter....................... Emission control .......................... Coolant temperature.................... 277 278 279 279 279 279 280 280 282 282 283 284 284 285 286 287 287 287 287 288 289 289 At the gas station .............................. Refueling...................................... Check regularly and before a long trip ....................................... Engine compartment ......................... Hood ............................................ Engine oil ..................................... Transmission fluid level*.............. Coolant level ................................ Windshield washer system and headlamp cleaning system*......... Battery ......................................... Tires and wheels................................ Important guidelines .................... Tire care and maintenance........... Direction of rotation..................... Loading the vehicle ...................... Recommended tire inflation pressure....................................... Checking tire inflation pressure ... MOExtended system* .................. Tire labeling ................................. Load identification ....................... 291 291 292 294 294 296 300 300 302 303 304 304 305 307 307 312 314 317 318 322 Contents DOT, Tire Identification Number (TIN) ............................... Maximum tire load ....................... Maximum tire inflation pressure .. Uniform Tire Quality Grading Standards (U.S. vehicles) ............. Tire ply material ........................... Tire and loading terminology........ Rotating tires ............................... Winter driving .................................... Winter tires .................................. Snow chains................................. Maintenance...................................... Maintenance service indicator message....................................... Clearing the maintenance service indicator message............ Maintenance service term exceeded ..................................... Calling up the maintenance service indicator display............... Resetting the maintenance service indicator........................... Vehicle care....................................... Cleaning and care of vehicle ........ 322 324 324 325 327 327 330 332 332 333 334 334 335 335 335 336 337 337 Practical hints .................................. 345 What to do if … ................................... 346 Lamps in instrument cluster ......... 346 Lamp in center console................. 354 Vehicle status messages in the multifunction display..................... 356 Where will I find...? ............................. 382 First aid kit.................................... 382 Vehicle tool kit, vehicle jack ......... 382 Spare wheel with collapsible tire .. 385 Spare wheel bolts ......................... 386 Unlocking/locking in an emergency... 387 Unlocking the vehicle.................... 387 Locking the vehicle ....................... 388 Manually unlocking the gear selector lever (automatic transmission*) ............ 389 Opening/closing in an emergency ..... 390 Raising retractable hardtop manually ....................................... 390 Replacing SmartKey batteries ............ 391 SmartKey ...................................... 391 Replacing bulbs.................................. 393 Bulbs............................................. 393 Replacing bulbs for front lamps .... 396 Replacing bulbs for rear lamps ..... 397 Replacing wiper blades ...................... 399 Placing wiper arms in vertical position......................................... 399 Removing wiper blades................. 400 Installing wiper blades .................. 400 Flat tire............................................... 401 Preparing the vehicle .................... 401 Sealing tires with TIREFIT ............. 401 Mounting the spare wheel ............ 407 MOExtended system* ................... 414 Battery ............................................... 415 Disconnecting the battery ............ 416 Removing the battery ................... 417 Charging and reinstalling battery.. 417 Reconnecting the battery ............. 418 Jump starting...................................... 419 Towing the vehicle.............................. 421 Installing towing eye bolt .............. 422 Fuses.................................................. 425 Fuse box in passenger compartment ................................ 425 Fuse box in engine compartment . 426 Contents Technical data.................................. Parts service ...................................... Warranty coverage............................. Loss of Service and Warranty Information Booklet...................... Identification labels............................ Layout of poly-V-belt drive ................. SLK 280, SLK 350 ........................ SLK 55 AMG................................. Engine................................................ Rims and tires.................................... Same size tires............................. Mixed size tires ............................ Spare wheel with collapsible tire.. Electrical system................................ Main Dimensions ............................... Weights.............................................. 427 428 429 429 430 432 432 432 433 434 435 437 439 440 441 442 Fuels, coolants, lubricants, etc. ......... Capacities .................................... Engine oils.................................... Engine oil additives ...................... Air conditioning refrigerant .......... Brake fluid.................................... Premium unleaded gasoline ......... Fuel requirements ........................ Gasoline additives ........................ Coolants....................................... Windshield washer system and headlamp cleaning system*......... 443 443 445 445 445 446 446 447 447 448 450 Index................................................. 451 Introduction Product information 왔 Product information Please observe the following in your own best interest: We recommend using Genuine Mercedes-Benz Parts as well as conversion parts and accessories explicitly approved by us for your vehicle model. We have tested these parts to determine their reliability, safety and special suitability for Mercedes-Benz vehicles. We are unable to make an assessment for other products and therefore cannot be held responsible for them, even if in individual cases an official approval or authorization by governmental or other agencies should exist. Use of such parts and accessories could adversely affect the safety, performance or reliability of your vehicle. Please do not use them. Genuine Mercedes-Benz Parts as well as conversion parts and accessories approved by us are available at your authorized Mercedes-Benz Center where you will receive comprehensive information, also on permissible technical modifications, and where proper installation will be performed. 9 Introduction Operator’s Manual This Operator’s Manual contains a great deal of useful information. We urge you to read it carefully and familiarize yourself with the vehicle before driving. For your own safety and longer service life of the vehicle, we urge you to follow the instructions and warnings contained in this manual. Ignoring them could result in damage to the vehicle or personal injury to you or others. Vehicle damage caused by failure to follow instructions is not covered by the Mercedes-Benz Limited Warranty. Your vehicle may have some or all of the equipment described in this manual. Therefore, you may find explanations for optional equipment not installed in your vehicle. If you have any questions about the operation of any equipment, your authorized Mercedes-Benz Center will be glad to demonstrate the proper procedures. 10 We continuously strive to improve our product, and ask for your understanding that we reserve the right to make changes in design and equipment. Therefore, information, illustrations and descriptions in this Operator’s Manual might differ from your vehicle. Service and warranty information 앫 New Car Limited Warranty Optional equipment is also described in this manual, including operating instructions wherever necessary. Since they are special-order items, the descriptions and illustrations herein may vary slightly from the actual equipment of your vehicle. 앫 Emission System Warranty 앫 Emission Performance Warranty 앫 California, Maine, Massachusetts, and Vermont Emission Control System Warranty (California, Maine, Massachusetts, and Vermont only) 앫 State Warranty Enforcement Laws (Lemon Laws) If there are any equipment details that are not shown or described in this Operator’s Manual, your authorized Mercedes-Benz Center will be glad to inform you of correct care and operating procedures. The Operator’s Manual and Maintenance Booklet are important documents and should be kept with the vehicle. The Service and Warranty Information Booklet contains detailed information about the warranties covering your Mercedes-Benz, including: Introduction Operator’s Manual Important notice for California retail buyers and lessees of Mercedes-Benz automobiles Under California law you may be entitled to a replacement of your vehicle or a refund of the purchase price or lease price, if Mercedes-Benz USA, LLC and/or its authorized repair or service facilities fail to fix one or more substantial defects or malfunctions in the vehicle that are covered by its express warranty after a reasonable number of repair attempts. During the period of 18 months from original delivery of the vehicle or the accumulation of 18000 miles (approximately 29000 km) on the odometer of the vehicle, whichever occurs first, a reasonable number of repair attempts is presumed for a retail buyer or lessee if one or more of the following occurs: (1) the same substantial defect or malfunction results in a condition that is likely to cause death or serious bodily injury if the vehicle is driven, that defect or malfunction has been subject to repair two or more times, and you have directly notified Mercedes-Benz USA, LLC in writing of the need for its repair, (2) the same substantial defect or malfunction of a less serious nature than category (1) has been subject to repair four or more times and you have directly notified us in writing of the need for its repair, or (3) the vehicle is out of service by reason of repair of the same or different substantial defects or malfunctions for a cumulative total of more than 30 calendar days. Written notification should not be sent to a dealer, it should be addressed to: Mercedes-Benz USA, LLC Customer Assistance Center One Mercedes Drive Montvale, NJ 07645-0350 11 Introduction Operator’s Manual Maintenance Roadside Assistance Change of address or ownership The Maintenance Booklet describes all the necessary maintenance work which should be performed at regular intervals. The Mercedes-Benz Roadside Assistance Program provides factory-trained technical help in the event of a breakdown. Calls to the toll-free Roadside Assistance number If you change your address, be sure to send in the “Change of Address Notice” found in the Service and Warranty Information Booklet, or simply call the Mercedes-Benz Customer Assistance Center (in the USA) at 1-800-FOR-MERCedes, or Customer Service (in Canada) at 1-800-387-0100. It is in your own interest that we can contact you should the need arise. Always have the Maintenance Booklet with you when you take the vehicle to your authorized Mercedes-Benz Center for service. The service advisor will record each service in the booklet for you. 1-800-FOR-MERCedes (in the USA) 1-800-387-0100 (in Canada) will be answered by Mercedes-Benz Customer Assistance Representatives 24 hours a day, 365 days a year. For additional information refer to the Mercedes-Benz Roadside Assistance Program Brochure in your vehicle literature portfolio. 12 If you sell your Mercedes, please leave all literature with the vehicle to make it available to the next operator. If you bought this vehicle used, be sure to send in the “Notice of Purchase of Used Car” found in the Service and Warranty Information Booklet, or call the Mercedes-Benz Customer Assistance Center (in the USA) at 1-800-FOR-MERCedes, or Customer Service (in Canada) at 1-800-387-0100. Introduction Operator’s Manual Operating your vehicle outside the USA or Canada If you plan to operate your vehicle in foreign countries, please be aware that: Certain Mercedes-Benz models are available for delivery in Europe under our European Delivery Program. For details, consult an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center or write to: 앫 service facilities or replacement parts may not be readily available, In the USA: 앫 unleaded gasoline for vehicles with catalytic converters may not be available; the use of leaded fuels will damage the catalysts, 앫 gasoline may have a considerably lower octane rating, and improper fuel can cause engine damage. Mercedes-Benz USA, LLC European Delivery Department One Mercedes Drive Montvale, NJ 07645-0350 In Canada: Mercedes-Benz Canada Inc. European Delivery Department 98 Vanderhoof Avenue Toronto, Ontario M4G 4C9 13 Introduction Where to find it This Operator’s Manual is designed to provide comprehensive support information for you, the vehicle operator. Each section has its own reference color. Controls in detail Technical data All important technical data for your vehicle can be found in this section. Here you will find an overview of all the controls that can be operated from the driver’s seat. Here you will find detailed information about the equipment installed in your vehicle. This section expands on the “Getting started” section and also describes technical innovations. If you are already familiar with the basic functions of your vehicle, this section will be of particular interest to you. Getting started Operation Here you will find all the information you need for your first drive. You should read this section first if this is your first Mercedes-Benz vehicle or if you are renting or borrowing this vehicle. Here you will find all the information you need for the proper operation of your vehicle. At a glance Practical hints Safety and Security Here you will find descriptions of the safety and security features of your vehicle. 14 This section provides fast assistance for dealing with problems you may encounter. Indexes The table of contents and the index are designed to help you find information quickly and easily. The following publications are part of your vehicle documentation: 앫 this Operator’s Manual 앫 the Maintenance Booklet Separate operating instructions will be provided as required depending on the equipment options installed in your vehicle. Introduction Symbols 왔 Symbols Trademarks: 앫 앫 앫 ESP® is a registered trademark of DaimlerChrysler. ® HomeLink is a registered trademark of Prince, a Johnson Controls Company. SIRIUS and related marks are trademarks of SIRIUS Satellite Radio Inc. The following symbols are found in this Operator’s Manual: 왘 This symbol points to instructions for you to follow. * 왘 A number of these symbols appearing in succession indicates a multiple-step procedure. Optional equipment is identified with an asterisk. Since standard equipment varies between models, the descriptions and illustrations in this manual may differ slightly from the actual equipment of your vehicle. Warning! 컄 page 컄컄 This continuation symbol marks a warning which is continued on the next page. 컄컄 This continuation symbol marks a procedure which is continued on the next page. -> This symbol is used to indicate cross-references to term definitions. Display Words appearing in the multifunction display are printed in the type shown here. G Warning notices draw your attention to hazards that may endanger your health or life, or the health or life of others. ! Highlights hazards that may result in damage to your vehicle. i Helpful hints or further information you may find useful. This symbol tells you where to look for further information on a topic. 15 Introduction Operating safety Warning! G Work improperly carried out on electronic components and associated software could cause them to cease functioning. Because the vehicle’s electronic components are interconnected, any modification made may produce an undesired effect on other systems. Contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center for repairs or modifications to electronic components. Other improper work or modifications on the vehicle could also have a negative impact on the operating safety of the vehicle. Some safety systems only function while the engine is running. You should therefore never turn off the engine while driving. 16 Warning! G Heavy blows against the vehicle undercarriage or tires/wheels, for example when running over an obstacle, road debris or a pothole, may cause serious damage and impair the operating safety or your vehicle. If you feel a sudden significant vibration or ride disturbance, or you suspect that damage to your vehicle has occurred, you should turn on your hazard warning flashers, carefully slow down, and drive with caution to an area which is a safe distance from the road. Inspect the vehicle undercarriage or tires/wheels for possible damage. If the vehicle appears unsafe, have it towed to the nearest authorized Mercedes-Benz Center or other qualified maintenance or repair facility for further inspection or repairs. Proper use of the vehicle Proper use of the vehicle requires that you are familiar with the following information and rules: 앫 the safety precautions in this manual 앫 the “Technical data” section (컄 page 427) in this manual 앫 the traffic rules and regulations 앫 the motor vehicle laws and safety standards Warning! G Various labels are attached to your vehicle. These warning labels are intended to make you and others aware of various risks. You should not remove any of these warning labels unless explicitly instructed to do so by information on the label itself. Removal of any of these labels may cause you and others to be unaware of certain risks which may result in an accident and/or personal injury. Introduction Problems with your vehicle 왔 Problems with your vehicle If you should experience a problem with your vehicle, particularly one that you believe may affect its safe operation, we urge you to immediately contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center to have the problem diagnosed and corrected if required. If the matter is not handled to your satisfaction, please discuss the problem with the Mercedes-Benz Center management, or if necessary contact us at one of the following addresses: In the USA: Customer Assistance Center Mercedes-Benz USA, LLC One Mercedes Drive Montvale, NJ 07645-0350 In Canada: Customer Relations Department Mercedes-Benz Canada Inc. 98 Vanderhoof Avenue Toronto, Ontario M4G 4C9 17 Introduction Reporting safety defects For the USA only: The following text is published as required of manufacturers under Title 49, Code of U.S. Federal Regulations, Part 575 pursuant to the “National Traffic and Motor Vehicle Safety Act of 1966”. Reporting safety defects If you believe that your vehicle has a defect which could cause a crash or could cause injury or death, you should immediately inform the National Highway Traffic Safety Administration (NHTSA) in addition to notifying Mercedes-Benz USA, LLC. If NHTSA receives similar complaints, it may open an investigation, and if it finds that a safety defect exists in a group of vehicles, it may order a recall and remedy campaign. However, NHTSA cannot become involved in individual problems between you, your dealer, or Mercedes-Benz USA, LLC. To contact NHTSA, you may call the Vehicle Safety Hotline toll-free at 1-888-327-4236 (TTY: 1-800-424-9153); go to http://www.safercar.gov; or write to: Administrator, NHTSA, 400 Seventh Street, SW., Washington, D.C. 20590. You can also obtain other information about motor vehicle safety from http://www.safercar.gov. 18 Introduction Vehicle data recording 왔 Vehicle data recording Information regarding electronic recording devices (Including notice pursuant to California Code § 9951) Please note that your vehicle is equipped with devices that can record vehicle systems data and, if equipped with the Tele Aid* system, may transmit some data in certain accidents. This information helps, for example, to diagnose vehicle systems after a collision and to continuously improve vehicle safety. DaimlerChrysler may access the information and share it with others 앫 for safety research or vehicle diagnosis purposes 앫 with the consent of the vehicle owner or lessee 앫 in response to an official request by law enforcement or other government agency 앫 for use in dispute resolution involving DaimlerChrysler, its affiliates or sales/service organization and/or 앫 as otherwise required or permitted by law. Please check the Tele Aid* subscription service agreement for details regarding the information that may be recorded or transmitted via that system. 19 20 At a glance Exterior view Cockpit Instrument cluster Multifunction steering wheel Center console Overhead control panel Storage compartments Door control panel 21 At a glance Exterior view 22 At a glance Exterior view Item Page 1 Trunk 6 Towing Opening the trunk 100 Closing the trunk 100 Spare wheel 385 Vehicle tool kit 2 Rear lamps 3 Rear window defroster 4 Fuel filler flap Refueling Gasoline Installing towing eye bolt 7 Tires and wheels Page 421 Item a Windshield wipers Page 56 422 Wiper blades, replacing 399 304 Wiper blades, cleaning 340 b Windshield 314 382 Checking tire inflation pressure 393 Run Flat Indicator* 315 170 General information 304 291 Flat tire 401 Opening/closing 242 291 8 Front lamps 393 Wind screen 246 446 9 Hood Luggage cover 241 5 Doors Locking and unlocking 94 Opening 99 Locking/unlocking in an emergency Item 387 Cleaning with wiper fluid Opening 294 Engine oil 296, 445 Coolant 300, 448 Cleaning c Retractable hardtop 58 340 240 d Exterior rear view mirrors Adjusting Auto-dimming rear view mirrors* 46 169 23 At a glance Cockpit 24 At a glance Cockpit Item Page 1 Automatic transmission*: Steering wheel gearshift control* 163 2 Multifunction steering wheel 28, 122 3 Horn 4 Instrument cluster 26, 118 5 Overhead control panel 31, 116 6 Glove box 252 CD changer* 7 Center console 216, 252 29, 30 8 Sun sensor for automatic climate control* 9 Starter switch 37 Item Page a Steering wheel adjustment release handle, manual 43 b Steering wheel adjustment stalk, electrical* 44 Heated steering wheel stalk* (SLK 280, SLK 350, Canada only) 276 c Headlamp cleaning button* 168 d Hood lock release lever 294 e Exterior lamp switch 55, 109 f Combination switch 앫 High beam 55 앫 Turn signals 55 앫 Windshield wipers 56 g Power window switches 235 h Inside door handle 99 j Cruise control lever 247 25 At a glance Instrument cluster 26 At a glance Instrument cluster Item Page 1 Multifunction display with: Item Page Item Page < Seat belt telltale 78, 351 L Left turn signal indicator lamp A High beam headlamp indicator lamp 55, 113 K Right turn signal indicator lamp 86, 350 55 Main odometer 127 Trip odometer 120 Automatic transmission*: Gear range indicator 52, 160 Automatic transmission*: Program mode indicator 161 4 Fuel reserve warning lamp 353 v Electronic Stability Program (ESP®) warning lamp 140 The arrow indicates that the fuel filler flap is on the rear right-hand side. 291 ; Brake warning lamp, USA only 59, 348 3 Brake warning lamp, Canada only 59, 348 Outside temperature indicator (or digital speedometer when selected) 3 Fuel gauge with: 4 Clock 2 Tachometer with: ? Engine malfunction indicator lamp, USA only 349 ± Engine malfunction indicator lamp, Canada only 349 120 5 Speedometer with: 1 Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) indicator lamp 64, 353 - Antilock Brake System (ABS) indicator lamp 84, 346 6 Reset button for: 앫 Resetting trip odometer 120 앫 Resetting all settings 136 7 Knobs for instrument cluster illumination 118 27 At a glance Multifunction steering wheel Item 1 Multifunction display Operating control system 2 Selecting a submenu or setting the volume: Press button æ up/to increase ç down/to decrease 3 Telephone*: Press button Page 118 121 Item Page 4 Moving within a menu: Press button j for next display k for previous display 5 Menu systems: Press button è for next menu · for previous menu s to take a call to dial to redial t to end a call to reject an incoming call i SLK 55 AMG: The steering wheel in this vehicle will vary from steering wheel shown. However, multifunction steering wheel symbols and feature description apply to AMG vehicles as well. 28 At a glance Center console 왔 Center console Upper part Item Page Item Page 1 Cup holder 254 8 ESP® switch 2 Audio system or COMAND* system (see separate operating instructions) 193 9 Seat heating* switch, driver’s side 104 a AIRSCARF* switch, driver’s side 105 3 AIRSCARF* switch, passenger-side 105 b Passenger front air bag off indicator lamp 71, 354 4 Seat heating* switch, passenger-side 104 c Climate control 172 5 Central unlocking switch 102 6 Hazard warning flasher switch 115 7 Central locking switch 102 Alarm system indicator lamp 86 Automatic climate control* 182 Rear window defroster switch 170 d Cigarette lighter 256 e Ashtray 255 92 29 At a glance Center console Lower part Item Item Page 1 Automatic transmission*: Gear selector lever 155, 157 6 Passenger-side exterior rear view mirror button 46, 168 Manual transmission: Gearshift lever 153 7 Driver’s side exterior rear view mirror button 46, 168 2 Retractable hardtop switch 240 8 Exterior rear view mirror adjustment button 46 9 Automatic transmission*: Program mode selector switch 161 3 Tow-away alarm deactivation switch 91 4 Parking brake lever 53, 59 5 Storage/telephone* compartment Telephone* compartment (depending on vehicle production date) 30 Page 252 253 At a glance Overhead control panel 왔 Overhead control panel Item Page 1 Interior lighting on/off 116 2 Interior lighting automatic control switch 116 3 Right reading lamp on/off 117 4 Tele Aid* (emergency call system) button 261 5 Garage door opener* 270 6 Sensor for auto-dimming rear view mirrors* 169 7 Interior rear view mirror 46, 168 8 Microphone for Tele Aid* and telephone* 261, 258 9 Left reading lamp on/off 117 31 At a glance Storage compartments 32 At a glance Storage compartments Item 1 Glove box Page Item Page 253 2 Door pocket 6 Parcel net in passenger footwell 3 Trunk 7 Ashtray 255 252 Vehicle tool kit, jack, spare wheel 382 Luggage cover 241 Trunk load 442 Load limit 309 256 8 Storage tray 4 Door pocket 5 Cupholder Cigarette lighter 254 9 Storage/telephone* compartment Telephone* compartment (depending on vehicle production date) a Storage compartment between seat backrests 252 253 253 33 At a glance Door control panel Item 1 Inside door handle 34 Page 99 2 Power window switch for opening/closing passenger-side window 235 3 Power window switch for opening/closing driver’s side window 235 Getting started Unlocking Adjusting Driving Parking and locking 35 Getting started Unlocking The “Getting started” section provides an overview of the vehicle’s most basic functions. First-time Mercedes-Benz owners should pay special attention to the information given here. Unlocking with the SmartKey Warning! When leaving the vehicle, always remove the SmartKey from the starter switch, take it with you, and lock the vehicle. Do not leave children unattended in the vehicle, or with access to an unlocked vehicle. A child’s unsupervised access to a vehicle could result in an accident and/or serious personal injury. If you are already familiar with the basic functions described here, the “Controls in detail” section (컄 page 93) will provide you with further information. The corresponding page references are located at the end of each segment. SmartKey with remote control 1 ‹ Lock button 2 Š Unlock button for trunk lid 3 Œ Unlock button 4  Panic button (컄 page 83) 36 G ! Opening a door causes the windows on that side of the car to open slightly. They will return to the up position when the door is closed. The side windows will not open or close if the battery is discharged or the windows are impeded by ice. As a result, you may no longer be able to properly close the door. Do not attempt to force the door shut. Doing so may damage the door or the side window. Correct the condition that prevents the windows from operating before attempting to close the door. Getting started Unlocking 왘 왘 Press unlock button Œ on the SmartKey. 앫 All turn signal lamps flash once. 앫 An acoustic warning sounds once (if equipped and feature activated). For more information, see “Factory setting” (컄 page 96). 앫 The locking knobs in the doors move up. 앫 The anti-theft alarm system is disarmed. Enter the vehicle and insert the SmartKey in the starter switch. Starter switch positions Warning! G When leaving the vehicle, always remove the SmartKey from the starter switch, take it with you, and lock the vehicle. Do not leave children unattended in the vehicle, or with access to an unlocked vehicle. A child’s unsupervised access to a vehicle could result in an accident and/or serious personal injury. SmartKey i Without the antenna on the left rear side of the vehicle installed, the SmartKey signaling range is considerably reduced. Hold the SmartKey in close proximity towards the antenna base when locking or unlocking the vehicle. 0 For removing the SmartKey The steering is locked when the SmartKey is removed from the starter switch. 1 Power supply for some electrical consumers, such as seat adjustment* 2 Ignition (power supply for all electrical consumers) and driving position All lamps (except high beam headlamp indicator lamp and turn signal indicator lamps unless activated) in the instrument cluster come on. If a lamp in the instrument cluster fails to come on when the ignition is switched on, have it checked and replaced if necessary. If a lamp in the instrument cluster remains on after starting the engine or comes on while driving, see “Lamps in instrument cluster” (컄 page 346). 3 Starting position For more information, see “SmartKey” (컄 page 94). Starter switch 37 Getting started Unlocking i When you switch on ignition, the indicator and warning lamps (except high beam headlamp indicator lamp and turn signal indicator lamps unless activated) in the instrument cluster come on. The indicator and warning lamps (except high beam headlamp indicator lamp and turn signal indicator lamps if activated) will go out when the engine is running. This indicates that the respective systems are operational. i Vehicles with automatic transmission*: The SmartKey can only be removed from the starter switch with the gear selector lever in position P. i If the SmartKey is left in starter switch position 0 for an extended period of time, it can no longer be turned in the starter switch. In this case the steering is locked. To unlock, remove SmartKey from the starter switch and reinsert. 38 ! If the SmartKey cannot be turned in the starter switch, the vehicle battery may not be sufficiently charged. 앫 Check the vehicle battery and charge it if necessary (컄 page 415). 앫 Get a jump start (컄 page 419). To prevent accelerated vehicle battery discharge or a completely discharged vehicle battery, always remove the SmartKey from the starter switch when the engine is not in operation. For information on starting the engine, see (컄 page 51). Getting started Adjusting 왔 Adjusting Warning! G All seat, head restraint, steering wheel, and rear view mirror adjustments, as well as fastening of seat belts, must be done before the vehicle is put into motion. Seats The seats can be adjusted either manually or electrically, depending on the vehicle’s equipment. Warning! G Do not adjust the driver seat while driving. Adjusting the seat while driving could cause the driver to lose control of the vehicle. Never ride in a moving vehicle with the seat back in an excessively reclined position as this can be dangerous. You could slide under the seat belt in a collision. If you slide under it, the seat belt would apply force at the abdomen or neck. That could cause serious or fatal injuries. The seat backrest and seat belts provide the best restraint when the wearer is in a position that is as upright as possible and seat belts are properly positioned on the body. Your seat must be adjusted so that you can correctly fasten your seat belt (컄 page 48). Observe the following points: 앫 Adjust the seat backrest until your arms are slightly angled when holding the steering wheel. 앫 Adjust the seat to a comfortable seating position that still allows you to reach the accelerator/brake pedal safely. The position should be as far back as possible with the driver still able to operate the controls properly. 앫 Adjust head restraint so that it is as close to the head as possible and the center of the head restraint supports the back of the head at eye level. 앫 Never place hands under the seat or near any moving parts while a seat is being adjusted. Failure to do so could result in result in an accident and/or serious personal injury. 39 Getting started Adjusting Warning! G When leaving the vehicle, always remove the SmartKey from the starter switch, take it with you, and lock the vehicle. Even with the SmartKey removed from the starter switch, the power seats* can be operated when the respective door is open. Therefore, do not leave children unattended in the vehicle, or with access to an unlocked vehicle. A child’s unsupervised access to a vehicle could result in an accident and/or serious personal injury. Warning! G Children 12 years old and under must be seated and properly secured in an appropriate infant, or toddler restraint, or booster seat recommended for the size and weight of the child. For additional information, see “Children in the vehicle” (컄 page 79). A child’s risk of serious or fatal injuries is significantly increased if the child restraints are not properly secured in the vehicle and/or the child is not properly secured in the child restraint. ! When moving the seats, make sure there are no items in the footwell or behind the seats; otherwise you could damage the seats. 40 Manual seat adjustment 1 Seat fore and aft adjustment 2 Seat height 3 Seat backrest tilt Getting started Adjusting Seat fore and aft adjustment Seat height Power seat* adjustment 왘 Pull handle 1. 왘 왘 Slide the seat to the desired position. The seat adjustment switches are located on the outer side of each seat. 왘 Allow handle 1 to reengage with an audible click. 왘 Check for proper engagement before driving. Pull or push handle 2 up or down and adjust the seat height until your legs are slightly supported. Seat backrest tilt 왘 Pull handle 3 and adjust the backrest until your arms are slightly angled when holding the steering wheel. 왘 Release handle 3 when the desired backrest tilt is reached. When you hear an audible click, the backrest is again fixed into place. For more information, see “Seats” (컄 page 104). 1 Seat fore and aft adjustment 2 Seat height 3 Seat backrest tilt 4 Seat cushion tilt 왘 Switch on the ignition (컄 page 37). or 왘 Open the respective door. 41 Getting started Adjusting i The memory function* (컄 page 107) lets you store the settings for power seats*, steering wheel adjustment (electrical)*, and exterior rear view mirrors. Seat fore and aft adjustment 왘 Press the horizontal switch forward or backward in direction of arrows 1. Seat height 왘 Press the horizontal switch up or down in direction of arrows 2 and adjust the seat height until your legs are slightly supported. Seat backrest tilt 왘 Press the vertical switch forward or backward in direction of arrows 3. Seat cushion tilt 왘 Press the horizontal switch up or down in direction of arrows 4 until your upper legs are lightly supported. 42 Head restraint height Warning! G For your protection, drive only with properly positioned head restraints. Adjust head restraint so that the head restraint supports the back of the head at eye level. This will reduce the potential for injury to the head and neck in the event of an accident or similar situation. Do not drive the vehicle without the seat head restraints. Head restraints are intended to help reduce injuries during an accident. Head restraint 왘 Adjust the height of head restraints manually by pulling them upwards or pushing them downwards. i Adjust the head restraint in such a way that it is as close to the head as possible. Getting started Adjusting Steering wheel Make sure that 앫 Warning! G Do not adjust the steering wheel while driving. Adjusting the steering wheel while driving, or driving without the steering wheel adjustment feature locked could cause the driver to lose control of the vehicle. When leaving the vehicle, always remove the SmartKey from the starter switch, take it with you, and lock the vehicle. you can reach the steering wheel with your arms slightly bent at the elbows 앫 you can move your legs freely 앫 all displays (including malfunction and indicator lamps) on the instrument cluster are clearly visible 왘 To unlock the steering wheel, pull handle 1 out to its stop limit. 왘 Move the steering wheel to the desired position. 왘 To lock the steering wheel, push handle 1 in all the way until it engages. The steering wheel is locked into position again. Steering wheel adjustment, manual The steering wheel adjustment release handle is located on the lower left of the steering column. Even with the SmartKey removed from the starter switch, the electrical steering wheel adjustment feature* can be operated when the driver’s door is open. Therefore, do not leave children unattended in the vehicle, or with access to an unlocked vehicle. A child’s unsupervised access to a vehicle could result in an accident and/or serious personal injury. 왘 Make sure the steering column is securely locked by trying to move the steering wheel up and down, in and out before driving off. ! Do not drive the vehicle until you have properly locked the steering wheel. 1 Steering wheel adjustment release handle 43 Getting started Adjusting Steering wheel adjustment, electrical* Adjusting steering wheel in or out Easy-entry/exit feature* The steering wheel adjustment stalk is located on the lower left of the steering column. 왘 This feature allows for easier entry into and exit from the vehicle. When entering and exiting the vehicle, the steering wheel is in its uppermost position. Move stalk forward or back in direction of arrows 1 until a comfortable steering wheel position is reached with your arms slightly bent at the elbow. Adjusting steering wheel up or down 왘 1 Adjusting steering wheel, in or out 2 Adjusting steering wheel, up or down 왘 Switch on the ignition (컄 page 37). or 왘 Open the driver’s door. i The memory function* (컄 page 107) lets you store the settings for the steering wheel together with the settings for the exterior rear view mirrors and the driver’s seat position. 44 Move the stalk up or down in direction of arrows 2. The easy-entry/exit feature can be activated or deactivated in the Convenience submenu of the control system (컄 page 147). Getting started Adjusting Warning! G You must make sure no one can become trapped or injured by the moving steering wheel when the easy-entry/exit feature is activated. With the easy-entry/exit feature activated, the steering wheel will return to its last set position when you: 앫 With the easy-entry/exit feature activated, the steering wheel tilts upwards when you: 앫 close the driver’s door with the ignition switched on or remove the SmartKey from the starter switch or 앫 open the driver’s door with the SmartKey in starter switch position 0 or 1 To cancel steering wheel movement, do one of the following: 앫 앫 Move steering wheel adjustment stalk* (컄 page 44). i The last set steering wheel position is stored i If the current position for the steering wheel when Press one of the memory position buttons* or the memory button M* (컄 page 107). 앫 the ignition is switched off 앫 is in the uppermost tilt position, the steering wheel will no longer be able to move upward when the easy-entry/exit feature is activated. the position is stored in memory (컄 page 107) 앫 Do not leave children unattended in the vehicle, or with access to an unlocked vehicle. Children could open the driver’s door and unintentionally activate the easy-entry/exit feature, which could result in an accident and/or serious personal injury. insert the SmartKey into the starter switch The adjustment procedure is briefly interrupted when the engine is started. 45 Getting started Adjusting Warning! G Let the system complete the adjustment procedure before setting the vehicle in motion. All steering wheel adjustment must be completed before setting the vehicle in motion. Driving off with the steering wheel still adjusting could cause the driver to lose control of the vehicle. Mirrors Adjust the interior and exterior rear view mirrors before driving so that you have a good view of the road and traffic conditions. Interior rear view mirror 왘 Adjust the interior rear view mirror manually. For more information, see “Rear view mirrors” (컄 page 168). Exterior rear view mirrors Warning! G Exercise care when using the passenger-side exterior rear view mirror. The mirror surface is convex (outwardly curved surface for a wider field of view). Objects in mirror are closer than they appear. Check your interior rear view mirror or glance over your shoulder before changing lanes. ! If an exterior rear view mirror housing is forcibly pushed forward (hit from the rear) or rearward (hit from the front), reposition it by applying firm pressure until it snaps into place. The exterior rear view mirror housing is now properly positioned and you can adjust the mirror in the usual manner. 46 Getting started Adjusting The buttons are located on the lower part of the center console. 왘 Press button 1 for the driver’s side exterior rear view mirror or button 3 for passenger-side exterior rear view mirror. The indicator lamp in the respective button comes on for approximately 10 seconds. i At low ambient temperatures, the exterior rear view mirrors will be heated automatically. i The memory function* (컄 page 107) lets you store the settings for the exterior rear view mirrors together with the settings for the steering wheel and the driver’s seat position. i If you do not make adjustments to the 1 Driver’s side exterior rear view mirror button 2 Adjustment button 3 Passenger-side exterior rear view mirror button 왘 Switch on the ignition (컄 page 37). selected exterior rear view mirror within 10 seconds, the indicator lamp goes out. You will then have to select the desired exterior rear view mirror again before any adjustments can be made. Adjustments can only be made with the indicator lamp for the respective exterior rear view mirror button illuminated. 왘 Press adjustment button 2 up, down, left, or right according to the desired setting. 47 Getting started Driving Warning! G Make sure that absolutely no objects are obstructing the pedal’s range of movement. Keep the driver’s footwell clear of all obstacles. If there are any floormats or carpets in the footwell, make sure the pedals still have sufficient clearance. During sudden driving or braking maneuvers, the objects could get caught between the pedals. You could then no longer brake or accelerate. This could lead to accidents and injury. 48 Fastening the seat belts Warning! G Always fasten your seat belt before driving off. Always make sure your passenger is properly restrained. Failure to wear and properly fasten and position your seat belt greatly increases your risk of injuries and their likely severity in an accident. You and your passenger should always wear seat belts. If you are ever in an accident, your injuries can be considerably more severe without your seat belt properly buckled. Without your seat belt buckled, you are much more likely to hit the interior of the vehicle or be ejected from it. You can be seriously injured or killed. In the same crash, the possibility of injury or death is lessened if you are wearing your seat belt. The air bags can only provide the protection they were designed to afford if the occupants are using their seat belts (컄 page 64). Warning! G Children 12 years old and under must be seated and properly secured in an appropriate infant, or toddler restraint, or booster seat recommended for the size and weight of the child. For additional information, see “Children in the vehicle” (컄 page 79). A child’s risk of serious or fatal injuries is significantly increased if the child restraints are not properly secured in the vehicle and/or the child is not properly secured in the child restraint. Getting started Driving Warning! G Never let more people ride in the vehicle than there are seat belts available. Be sure everyone riding in the vehicle is correctly restrained with a separate seat belt. Never use a seat belt for more than one person at a time. Warning! Warning! Read and observe the additional warning notices printed in the “Safety and Security” section (컄 page 68) and (컄 page 76). G Never ride in a moving vehicle with the seat backrest in an excessively reclined position as this can be dangerous. You could slide under the seat belt in a collision. If you slide under it, the seat belt would apply force at the abdomen or neck. That could cause serious or even fatal injuries. The seat backrest and seat belt provide the best restraint when the wearer is in a position that is as upright as possible and the seat belt is properly positioned on the body. G 왘 With a smooth motion, pull the seat belt from the seat belt outlet. 왘 Place the shoulder portion of the seat belt across the top of your shoulder and the lap portion across your hips. 왘 Push latch plate 2 into buckle 4 until it clicks. 왘 If necessary, tighten the lap portion to a snug fit by pulling shoulder portion up. For more information, see “Safety guidelines for the seat belt, emergency tensioning device and air bag” (컄 page 68). 1 Loop for seat belt guidance 2 Latch plate 3 Release button 4 Buckle 49 Getting started Driving Proper use of seat belts 앫 앫 앫 앫 Do not twist the seat belt when fastening. Adjust seat belt so that the shoulder portion is located as close as possible to the middle of the shoulder (it should not touch the neck). Never pass the shoulder portion of the seat belt under your arm. Position the lap belt as low as possible on your hips (over hip joint) and not across the abdomen. Place the seat backrest in a position that is as upright as possible. 50 앫 앫 Never use a seat belt for more than one person at a time. Do not fasten a seat belt around a person and another object at the same time. When using a seat belt to secure infant or toddler restraints or children in booster seats, always follow the child seat manufacturer’s instructions. 앫 Check your seat belt during travel to make sure it is properly positioned. 앫 Make sure the seat belt is always fitted snugly. Take special care of this when wearing loose clothing. Warning! G Do not pass seat belts over sharp edges. They could tear. Do not allow the seat belt to get caught in the door or in the seat adjustment mechanism. This could damage the seat belt. Never attempt to make modifications to seat belts. This could impair the effectiveness of the seat belts. Do not bleach or dye seat belts as this may severely weaken them. In a crash, they may not be able to provide adequate protection. Damaged seat belts or seat belts that were highly stressed in an accident must be replaced. Contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. Getting started Driving Starting the engine Warning! Manual transmission G Inhalation of exhaust gas is hazardous to your health. All exhaust gas contains carbon monoxide (CO), and inhaling it can cause unconsciousness and possible death. Do not run the engine in confined areas (such as a garage) which are not properly ventilated. If you think that exhaust gas fumes are entering the vehicle while driving, have the cause determined and corrected immediately. If you must drive under these conditions, drive only with at least one window fully open. Starting 왘 Depress brake pedal. 왘 Make sure the gearshift lever is in neutral position (no gear selected). 왘 Fully depress clutch pedal. Otherwise the engine cannot be started due to the integrated safety interlock. Gearshift pattern for manual transmission For more information, see “Manual transmission” (컄 page 153). 왘 Do not depress accelerator. 왘 Turn the SmartKey in the starter switch to position 3 (컄 page 37) and hold until the engine starts. For information on turning off the engine, see “Turning off engine” (컄 page 61). 51 Getting started Driving Automatic transmission* Gearshift pattern for automatic transmission P Park position with gear selector lever lock R Reverse gear N Neutral position D Drive position For more information, see “Automatic transmission*” (컄 page 155). Starting Starting difficulties 왘 Place the gear selector lever in position P. 왘 Do not depress accelerator. If the SmartKey is left in starter switch position 0 for an extended period of time, it can no longer be turned in the starter switch. In this case the steering is locked. 왘 Turn the SmartKey in the starter switch to position 3 (컄 page 37) and release it again immediately. The engine starts automatically. For information on turning off the engine, see “Turning off engine” (컄 page 61). 왘 If the engine does not start as described, carry out the following steps: 왘 Turn the SmartKey in the starter switch to position 0 and repeat the starting procedure. Remember that extended starting attempts can drain the vehicle battery. 왘 Get a jump start (컄 page 419). If the engine does not start after several starting attempts, there could be a malfunction in the engine electronics or in the fuel supply system. 왘 52 To unlock, remove SmartKey from the starter switch and reinsert. Contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center or call Roadside Assistance. Getting started Driving Parking brake Warning! Driving off G When leaving the vehicle, always remove the SmartKey from the starter switch, take it with you, and lock the vehicle. Do not leave children unattended in the vehicle, or with access to an unlocked vehicle. Children could release the parking brake, which could result in an accident and/or serious personal injury. Warning! G On slippery road surfaces, never downshift in order to obtain braking action. This could result in drive wheel slip and reduced vehicle control. Your vehicle’s ABS will not prevent this type of loss of control. 1 Parking brake lever 2 Release button 왘 Pull up slightly on parking brake lever 1 and press release button 2. ! If you hear a warning signal and the message Release parking brake appears in the multifunction display when driving off, you have forgotten to release the parking brake. 왘 Push parking brake lever 1 down to its original position. Release the parking brake (컄 page 53). The brake warning lamp ; (USA only) or 3 (Canada only) in the instrument cluster goes out. ! Do not run cold engine at high engine speed. Running a cold engine at high engine speed may shorten the service life of the engine. ! Simultaneously depressing the accelerator pedal and applying the brakes reduces engine performance and causes premature brake and drivetrain wear. 53 Getting started Driving i Once the vehicle is in motion, the automatic Automatic transmission* ! In order to avoid damage to the transmis- central locking system engages and the locking knobs drop down. 왘 Depress the brake pedal. sion: 왘 Move the gear selector lever to position D or R. The automatic door lock feature can be deactivated (컄 page 146). You can open a locked door from the inside. Open door only when conditions are safe to do so. Manual transmission 왘 Depress the brake pedal. 왘 Fully depress the clutch pedal. 왘 Move gearshift lever to first gear to drive forward, or to reverse gear to drive rearward. 왘 Simultaneously release the brake pedal and slowly the clutch pedal. 왘 Carefully depress the accelerator pedal. 54 Warning! 앫 Wait for the gear selection process to complete before setting the vehicle in motion. 앫 Place the gear selector lever in position D or R only when the vehicle is stopped. 왘 Release the brake pedal. 왘 Carefully depress the accelerator pedal. G It is dangerous to shift the gear selector lever out of P or N if the engine speed is higher than idle speed. If your foot is not firmly on the brake pedal, the vehicle could accelerate quickly forward or in reverse. You could lose control of the vehicle and hit someone or something. Only shift into gear when the engine is idling normally and when your right foot is firmly on the brake pedal. After a cold start, the transmission engages at a higher revolution. This allows the catalytic converter to reach its operating temperature earlier. Getting started Driving Switching on headlamps High beam Low beam headlamps The combination switch is located on the left of the steering column. Turn signals The combination switch is located on the left of the steering column. The exterior lamp switch is located on the dashboard to the left of the steering wheel. Combination switch Exterior lamp switch 1 Off 2 Low beam headlamps on 왘 Turn the exterior lamp switch to position B. The low beam headlamps come on. 1 High beam 2 High beam flasher 왘 Combination switch 1 Turn signals, right 2 Turn signals, left Push the combination switch in direction of arrow 1. The high beam headlamps and high beam headlamp indicator lamp A in the instrument cluster come on (컄 page 26). For more information on headlamps, see “Lighting” (컄 page 109). 55 Getting started Driving 왘 Press the combination switch in direction of arrow 1 or 2. The corresponding turn signal indicator lamp K or L in the instrument cluster flashes (컄 page 26). Windshield wipers The combination switch is located on the left of the steering column. The combination switch resets automatically after major directional changes. the windshield is dry. Dust that accumulates on a windshield might scratch the glass and/or damage the wiper blades when wiping occurs on a dry windshield. If it is necessary to operate the windshield wipers in dry weather conditions, always operate the windshield wipers with windshield washer fluid (컄 page 58). ! If anything blocks the windshield wipers (leaves, snow, etc.), switch them off immediately. i To signal minor directional changes such as changing lanes, press combination switch only to point of resistance and release. The corresponding turn signals will flash three times. Combination switch 1 Single wipe Wiping with windshield washer fluid 2 Switching on windshield wipers 왘 56 ! Do not operate the windshield wipers when Switch on the ignition (컄 page 37). 앫 For safety reasons, stop the vehicle in a safe location, turn off the engine and remove the SmartKey from the starter switch before attempting to remove any blockage. 앫 Remove blockage. 앫 Turn the windshield wipers on again. If the windshield wipers fail to function at all with the combination switch in position I, 앫 set the combination switch to the next higher wiper speed 앫 have the windshield wipers checked at the nearest authorized Mercedes-Benz Center Getting started Driving Switching on windshield wipers 왘 Turn the combination switch to the desired position depending on the intensity of the rain. 0 Windshield wipers off I Intermittent wiping II Normal wiper speed III Fast wiper speed Intermittent wiping ! Vehicles with rain sensor*: Do not leave windshield wipers on an intermittent setting when the vehicle is taken to an automatic car wash or during windshield cleaning. Windshield wipers will operate in the presence of water sprayed on the windshield, and windshield wipers may be damaged as a result. ! Vehicles with rain sensor*: If you have set intermittent wiping, dirt on the surface of the rain sensor or optical effects may cause the windshield wipers to wipe in an undesired fashion. This could then damage the windshield wiper blades or scratch the windshield. You should therefore switch off the windshield wipers when weather conditions are dry. Vehicles with rain sensor*: Intermittent wiping interval is dependent on wetness of windshield. 왘 Turn the combination switch to position I. i Intermittent wiping is interrupted when the vehicle is at a standstill and a door is opened. This protects persons getting into or out of the vehicle from being sprayed. Intermittent wiping will be continued when all doors are closed and 앫 the clutch pedal is depressed (vehicles with manual transmission) or 앫 the gear selector lever is in position D or R (vehicles with automatic transmission*) or 앫 the wiper setting is changed using the combination switch Vehicles with rain sensor*: After the initial wipe, pauses between wipes are automatically controlled by the rain sensor. 57 Getting started Driving Single wipe 왘 Press the combination switch briefly in direction of arrow 1 (컄 page 58) to the resistance point. The engine runs erratically and misfires 앫 An ignition cable may be damaged. The windshield wipers wipe one time without washer fluid. 앫 Wiping with windshield washer fluid 왘 Problems while driving Press the combination switch in direction of arrow 1 (컄 page 58) past the resistance point. If the vehicle is leaking gasoline: 왘 Do not start the engine under any circumstances. The engine electronics may not be operating properly. 왘 Notify local fire and/or police authorities. 앫 Unburned gasoline may have entered the catalytic converter and damaged it. If the extent of the damage cannot be determined: 왘 Give very little gas. 왘 왘 Have the problem repaired by an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center as soon as possible. If no damage can be determined on the The windshield wipers operate with washer fluid. i To prevent smears on the windshield or noisy/chattering wiper blades, wipe with windshield washer fluid every now and then even when it is raining. For information on filling up the washer reservoir, see “Windshield washer system and headlamp cleaning system*” (컄 page 302). 58 In case of accident Contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center or call Roadside Assistance. 앫 Major assemblies The coolant temperature is above 248°F (120°C) 앫 Fuel system 앫 Engine mount The coolant is too hot and is no longer cooling the engine. 왘 Start the engine in the usual manner. 왘 Stop the vehicle as soon as possible and turn off the engine. Allow engine and coolant to cool off. 왘 Check the coolant level and add coolant if necessary (컄 page 300). Getting started Parking and locking 왔 Parking and locking You have now completed your first drive. You have properly stopped and parked your vehicle. End your drive as follows. Warning! G Vehicles with manual transmission: Wait until the vehicle is stationary before removing the SmartKey from the starter switch. The vehicle cannot be steered when the SmartKey is removed. Warning! G With the engine not running, there is no power assistance for the brake and steering system. In this case, it is important to keep in mind that a considerably higher degree of effort is necessary to brake and steer the vehicle. G 앫 Turn the SmartKey in the starter switch to position 0 and remove. Do not park this vehicle in areas where combustible materials such as grass, hay or leaves can come into contact with the hot exhaust system, as these materials could be ignited and cause a vehicle fire. 앫 Take the SmartKey with you and lock vehicle when leaving. Warning! To reduce the risk of personal injury or damage to the vehicle drivetrain as a result of vehicle movement, before turning off the engine and leaving the vehicle always: 앫 Keep right foot on brake pedal. 앫 Pull the parking brake lever up as many notches as possible. 앫 Manual transmission: Move the gearshift lever into first or reverse gear. 앫 Automatic transmission*: Move the gear selector lever to position P. 앫 Slowly release brake pedal. 앫 When parked on an incline, turn front wheels towards the road curb. Parking brake Warning! G Engaging the parking brake while the vehicle is in motion can cause the rear wheels to lock up. You could lose control of the vehicle and cause an accident. In addition, the vehicle’s brake lights do not light up when the parking brake is engaged. 59 Getting started Parking and locking Warning! 1 Parking brake lever 왘 Pull up parking brake lever 1 firmly. When the ignition is switched on or the engine is running, the brake warning lamp ; (USA only) or 3 (Canada only) in the speedometer dial comes on. 60 G Getting out of your vehicle with the gear selector lever* not fully engaged in position P (manual transmission: first or reverse gear) is dangerous. Also, when parked on an incline, position P (manual transmission: first or reverse gear) alone may not prevent your vehicle from moving, possibly hitting people or objects. Always set the parking brake in addition to shifting to position P (manual transmission: first or reverse gear). When parked on an incline, also turn the front wheels towards the road curb. Warning! G When leaving the vehicle, always remove the SmartKey from the starter switch, take it with you, and lock the vehicle. Do not leave children unattended in the vehicle, or with access to an unlocked vehicle. Children could release the parking brake and/or move the gear selector lever* from position P (manual transmission: into Neutral), either of which could result in an accident and/or serious personal injury. Getting started Parking and locking Switching off headlamps Turning off engine Releasing seat belts 왘 왘 Manual transmission: Move the gearshift lever into first or reverse gear. 왘 왘 Automatic transmission*: Place the gear selector lever in position P. 왘 Apply the parking brake (컄 page 59). Turn the exterior lamp switch to M (컄 page 109). For more information, see “Lighting” (컄 page 109). i Always set the parking brake in addition to shifting into first or reverse gear (automatic transmission*: gear selector lever in position P). When parked on an incline, also turn the front wheels towards the road curb. 왘 Turn the SmartKey in the starter switch to position 0 and remove the SmartKey from the starter switch. Press the seat belt release button (컄 page 49). Allow the retractor to completely rewind the seat belt by guiding the latch plate. ! Make sure the seat belt retracts fully so that the seat belt and/or latch plate cannot get caught or pinched in the door or in the seat mechanism. This can damage the seat belt and impair the effectiveness of the seat belt, and/or cause damage to the door and/or door trim panel. Such damage is not covered by the Mercedes-Benz Limited Warranty. Damaged seat belts must be replaced. Contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. The immobilizer is activated. i Vehicles with automatic transmission*: The SmartKey can only be removed from the starter switch with the gear selector lever in position P. 61 Getting started Parking and locking 왘 Locking Warning! G To prevent possible personal injury, always keep hands and fingers away from the door openings when closing the doors. Be especially careful when small children are around. Before closing doors, make sure there is no possibility of someone getting caught in a door during closing. Warning! G When leaving the vehicle, always remove the SmartKey from the starter switch, take it with you, and lock the vehicle. Do not leave children unattended in the vehicle, or with access to an unlocked vehicle. A child’s unsupervised access to a vehicle could result in an accident and/or serious personal injury. 62 Exit the vehicle and close all doors. i If you hear a warning signal, you have forgot- 왘 Press the lock button ‹ on the SmartKey (컄 page 36). ten to switch off the headlamps before opening the driver’s door. 앫 All turn signal lamps flash three times. In addition, the message Turn off lights appears in the multifunction display. 앫 An acoustic warning sounds three times (if equipped and feature activated). For more information, see “Factory setting” (컄 page 96). 앫 The locking knobs in the doors move down. 앫 The anti-theft alarm system is armed. Switch off the headlamps. ! Failure to switch off the headlamps when leaving the vehicle may result in a discharged battery. ! Opening a door causes the windows on that side of the car to open slightly. They will return to the up position when the door is closed. The side windows will not open or close if the battery is discharged or the windows are impeded by ice. As a result, you may no longer be able to properly close the door. Do not attempt to force the door shut. Doing so may damage the door or the side window. Correct the condition that prevents the windows from operating before attempting to close the door. i Without the antenna on the left rear side of the vehicle installed, the SmartKey signaling range is considerably reduced. Hold the SmartKey in close proximity towards the antenna base when locking or unlocking the vehicle. For more information, see “Locking and unlocking” (컄 page 94). Safety and Security Occupant safety Panic alarm Driving safety systems Anti-theft systems 63 Safety and Security Occupant safety In this section you will learn the most important facts about the restraint system components of the vehicle. 앫 Seat belts (컄 page 76) 앫 Child restraints (컄 page 80) Additional protection potential provided by 앫 Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) with 앫 Air bags (컄 page 66) 앫 Air bag control unit (with crash sensors) 앫 Emergency Tensioning Device (ETD) for seat belts (컄 page 79) 64 Air bag system components with 앫 Front passenger front air bag off indicator lamp (컄 page 74) 앫 Passenger seat with Occupant Classification System (OCS) (컄 page 71) Although independent systems, their protective functions work in conjunction with each other. i For information on infants and children traveling with you in the vehicle and restraint systems for infants and children, see “Children in the vehicle” (컄 page 79). The SRS system conducts a self-test when the ignition is switched on and in regular intervals while the engine is running. This facilitates detection of malfunctions. The 1 indicator lamp in the instrument cluster comes on when the ignition is switched on and goes out no later than a few seconds after the engine has been started. The SRS components are in operational readiness if the 1 indicator lamp is not lit when the engine is running. A malfunction in the system has been detected if the 1 indicator lamp: 앫 fails to go out after approximately 4 seconds after the engine was started 앫 does not come on at all 앫 comes on after the engine was started or while driving Safety and Security Occupant safety Warning! G Modifications to or work improperly conducted on restraint systems (such as seat belts and anchors, emergency tensioning devices, seat belt force limiters or air bags) or their wiring, as well as tampering with interconnected electronic systems, can lead to the restraint systems no longer functioning as intended. Air bags or emergency tensioning devices, for example, could deploy inadvertently or fail to deploy in accidents although the deceleration threshold for air bag deployment is exceeded. Therefore, never modify the restraint systems. Do not tamper with electronic components or their software. Warning! G In the event that the 1 indicator lamp comes on during driving or does not come on at all, the SRS self-check has detected a malfunction. For your safety, we strongly recommend that you contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center immediately to have the system checked; otherwise the SRS may not deploy when needed in an accident, which could result in serious or fatal injury, or it might deploy unexpectedly and unnecessarily which could also result in injury. If it is necessary to modify an air bag system to accommodate a person with disabilities, contact your local authorized Mercedes-Benz Center or call our Customer Assistance Center at 1-800-FOR-MERCedes (1-800-367-6372) for details. In addition, improper repair work on the SRS creates a risk of rendering the SRS inoperative or causing unintended air bag deployment. Work on the SRS must therefore only be performed by qualified technicians. Contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. 65 Safety and Security Occupant safety Air bags Warning! Warning! G Air bags are designed to reduce the potential of injury in certain frontal impacts (front air bags, knee bags), or side impacts (head-thorax air bags) which may cause significant injuries. However, no system available today can completely eliminate injuries and fatalities. The deployment of the air bags temporarily releases a small amount of dust from the air bags. This dust, however, is neither injurious to your health, nor does it indicate a fire in the vehicle. The dust might cause some temporary breathing difficulty for people with asthma or other breathing trouble. To avoid this, you may wish to get out of the vehicle as soon as it is safe to do so. If you have any breathing difficulty but cannot get out of the vehicle after the air bag inflates, then get fresh air by opening a window or door. 66 G 앫 Adjust the driver’s seat as far as possible rearward, still permitting proper operation of vehicle controls. The distance from the center of the driver’s breastbone to the center of the air bag cover on the steering wheel must be at least 10 inches (25 cm) or more. You should be able to accomplish this by a combination of adjustments to the seat and steering wheel. If you have any problems, please contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. 앫 Do not lean your head or chest close to the steering wheel or dashboard. 앫 Keep hands on the outside of the steering wheel rim. Placing hands and arms inside the rim can increase the risk and potential severity of hand/arm injury when the driver’s front air bag inflates. 앫 Adjust the passenger seat as far as possible rearward from the dashboard when the seat is occupied. To reduce the risk of injury when the front air bags inflate, it is very important for the driver and passenger to always be in a properly seated position and to wear their seat belts. For maximum protection in the event of a collision always be in normal seated position with your back against the backrest. Fasten your seat belt and ensure it is properly positioned on your body (컄 page 48). Since the air bag inflates with considerable speed and force, a proper seating and hands on steering wheel position will help to keep you at a safe distance from the air bag. Occupants who are unbelted, out of position or too close to the air bag can be seriously injured or killed by an air bag as it inflates with great force in the blink of an eye: 앫 Sit properly belted in a position that is as upright as possible with your back against the seat backrest. Safety and Security Occupant safety 앫 Occupants, especially children, should always sit as upright as possible, properly use the seat belts and use an appropriately sized infant restraint, toddler restraint, or booster seat recommended for the size and weight of the child. Failure to follow these instructions can result in severe injuries to you or other occupants. If you sell your vehicle, it is important that you make the buyer aware of this safety information. Be sure to give the buyer this Operator’s Manual. Warning! G There is a possibility of a head-thorax air bag related injury if occupants, especially children, are not properly seated or restrained when next to a head-thorax air bag which needs to deploy rapidly in a side impact in order to do its job. To help avoid the possibility of injury, please follow these guidelines: (1) Occupants, especially children, should never place their bodies or lean their heads in the area of the door where the head-thorax air bag inflates. This could result in serious injuries or death should the head-thorax air bag be deployed. If you believe that, even with the use of these guidelines, it would be safer for your passenger seat occupants to have the passenger side head-thorax air bag deactivated, then deactivation can be accomplished upon your written election to do so at an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center at an additional cost. Please contact your local authorized Mercedes-Benz Center or call the Customer Assistance Center (in the USA) at 1-800-FOR-MERCedes (1-800-367-6372), or Customer Service (in Canada) at 1-800-387-0100 for details. (2) Always sit as upright as possible, properly use the seat belts, and for all children 12 years old or under, use an appropriately sized infant restraint, toddler restraint, or booster seat recommended for the size and weight of the child. (3) Always wear seat belts properly. 67 Safety and Security Occupant safety i Air bags are designed to activate only in certain frontal impacts (front air bags, knee bags) and in side impacts (head-thorax air bags) which exceed preset thresholds. Only during these events will they provide their supplemental protection. The driver and passenger should always wear their seat belts. Otherwise it is not possible for the air bags to provide their supplemental protection. In case of other types of impacts and impacts below air bag deployment thresholds, air bags will not deploy. The driver and passenger will then be protected to the extent possible by a properly fastened seat belt. A properly fastened seat belt is also needed to provide the best possible protection in a rollover. We caution you not to rely on the presence of the air bags in order to avoid wearing your seat belt. It is important to your safety and that of your passenger that you replace deployed air bags and repair any malfunctioning air bags to make sure that the vehicle will continue to provide supplemental crash protection for occupants. 68 Safety guidelines for the seat belt, emergency tensioning device and air bag Warning! 앫 No modifications of any kind may be made to any components or wiring of the SRS. This includes changing or removing any component or part of the SRS, the installation of additional trim material, badges, etc. over the steering wheel hub, passenger front air bag cover, door frame trims, or door trim panels, and installation of additional electrical/electronic equipment on or near SRS components and wiring. Keep area between air bags and occupants free from objects (e.g. packages, purses, umbrellas, etc.). 앫 Do not bleach or dye seat belts as this may severely weaken them. In a crash, they may not be able to provide adequate protection. 앫 Air bag system components will be hot after an air bag has inflated. Do not touch. 앫 Never place your feet on the instrument panel, dashboard, or on the seat. Always keep both feet on the floor in front of the seat. G 앫 Damaged seat belts or seat belts that were highly stressed in an accident must be replaced and their anchoring points must also be checked. Only use seat belts installed or supplied by an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. 앫 Air bags and Emergency Tensioning Devices (ETDs) are designed to function on a one-time-only basis. An air bag or ETD that has deployed must be replaced. 앫 Do not pass seat belts over sharp edges. They could tear. 앫 Do not make any modification that could change the effectiveness of the seat belts. Safety and Security Occupant safety 앫 앫 앫 In addition, improper repair work on the SRS creates a risk of rendering the SRS inoperative or causing unintended air bag deployment. Work on the SRS must therefore only be performed by qualified technicians. Contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. For your protection and the protection of others, when scrapping the air bag unit or emergency tensioning device, our safety instructions must be followed. These instructions are available from your authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. Given the considerable deployment speed, required inflation volume, and the textile structure of the air bags, there is the possibility of abrasions or other, potentially more serious injuries resulting from air bag deployment. Warning! G Front air bags Only use seat covers which have been tested and approved by Mercedes-Benz for your vehicle model. Using other seat covers may interfere with or prevent the deployment of the head-thorax air bags. Contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center for availability. When you sell your vehicle, we strongly urge you to give notice to the subsequent owner that it is equipped with an SRS by alerting them to the applicable section in the Operator’s Manual. 1 Driver air bag 2 Passenger air bag 3 Knee bag (passenger side) 4 Knee bag (driver’s side) Driver and passenger air bags and knee bags are deployed 앫 in the event of certain frontal impacts 앫 if impact exceeds a preset deployment threshold 앫 independently of the head-thorax air bags 69 Safety and Security Occupant safety i The front air bags in this vehicle have been designed to inflate in two stages. This allows the air bag to have different rates of inflation that are based on the rate of relevant vehicle deceleration as assessed by the air bag control unit. On the passenger side, the front air bag deployment is additionally influenced by the passenger’s weight category as identified by the Occupant Classification System (OCS) (컄 page 71). The lighter the passenger side occupant, the higher the vehicle deceleration rate required for the second stage inflation of the air bag. The air bags will not deploy in impacts which do not exceed the system’s deployment thresholds. You will then be protected by the fastened seat belts. 70 The passenger air bag will only be deployed if 앫 the system, based on OCS weight sensor readings, senses that the front passenger seat is occupied 앫 the 75 indicator lamp in the center console is not lit (컄 page 74) 앫 the impact exceeds a preset deployment threshold Head-thorax air bags 1 Head-thorax air bag Knee bags The head-thorax air bags are deployed The driver-side knee bag is located on the driver’s side lower instrument panel. The passenger-side knee bag is located on the passenger side below the glove box. They are designed to operate together with the front air bags in certain frontal impacts exceeding a preset threshold. The knee bags operate best in conjunction with properly positioned and fastened seat belts. 앫 in impacts exceeding a preset deployment threshold 앫 on the impacted side of the vehicle 앫 independently of the front air bags The head-thorax air bags are not deployed in impacts which do not exceed the system’s deployment threshold. Safety and Security Occupant safety Warning! G Only use seat covers which have been tested and approved by Mercedes-Benz for your vehicle model. Using other seat covers may interfere with or prevent the deployment of the head-thorax air bags. Contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center for availability. Occupant Classification System The Occupant Classification System (OCS) automatically turns the passenger front air bag and passenger-side knee bag on or off based on the classified occupant weight category determined by weight sensor readings from the passenger seat. i The system does not deactivate the head-thorax air bag and the emergency tensioning device. i If the seat, including the trim cover and cushion needs to be serviced in any way, take the vehicle to an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. Only seat accessories approved by Mercedes-Benz may be used. Both driver and the passenger should always use the 75 indicator lamp as an indication of whether or not the passenger is properly positioned (컄 page 76). Occupants must sit properly belted in a position that is as upright as possible with their back against the seat backrest and feet on the floor to be correctly classified. If the occupant's weight is transferred to another object in the vehicle (e.g. by leaning on armrests), the OCS may not be able to properly approximate the occupant’s weight category. 71 Safety and Security Occupant safety Warning! G If the 75 indicator lamp illuminates when an adult or someone larger than a small individual is in the passenger seat, have the passenger re-position himself or herself in the seat until the 75 indicator lamp goes out. More information about air bag display messages (컄 page 361). In the event of a collision, the air bag control unit will not allow passenger front air bag deployment when the OCS classified the passenger seat occupant as being up to or less than the weight of a typical 12-month-old child in a standard child restraint or if the passenger seat is sensed as being empty. 72 When the OCS senses that the passenger seat occupant is classified as being up to or less than the weight of a typical 12-month-old child in a standard child restraint, the 75 indicator lamp will illuminate when the engine is started and remain illuminated, indicating that the passenger front air bag is deactivated. When the OCS senses that the passenger seat is classified as being empty, the 75 indicator lamp will illuminate when the engine is started and remain illuminated, indicating that the passenger front air bag is deactivated. When the OCS senses that the passenger seat occupant is classified as being heavier than the weight of a typical 12-month-old child seated in a standard child restraint or as being a small individual (such as a young teenager or a small adult), the 75 indicator lamp will illuminate for approximately 6 seconds when the engine is started and then, depending on occupant weight sensor readings from the seat, remain illuminated or go out. With the 75 indicator lamp illuminated, the passenger front air bag is deactivated. With the 75 indicator lamp out, the passenger front air bag is activated. When the OCS senses that the passenger seat occupant is classified as an adult or someone larger than a small individual, the 75 indicator lamp will illuminate for approximately 6 seconds when the engine is started and then go out, indicating that the passenger front air bag is activated. Safety and Security Occupant safety If the 75 indicator lamp is illuminated, the passenger front air bag is deactivated and will not be deployed. If the 75 indicator lamp is not illuminated, the passenger front air bag is activated and will be deployed: 앫 in the event of certain frontal impacts 앫 if impact exceeds a preset deployment threshold 앫 independently of the head-thorax air bags Warning! G 앫 A child in a rear-facing child restraint on the passenger seat will be seriously injured or even killed if the passenger front air bag inflates in a collision which could occur under some circumstances, even with the air bag technology installed in your vehicle. 앫 If you install a rear-facing child restraint on the passenger seat, make sure that the 75 indicator lamp is illuminated, indicating that the passenger front air bag is deactivated. Should the 75 indicator lamp not illuminate or go out while the restraint is installed, please check installation. Periodically check the 75 indicator lamp while driving to make sure the 75 indicator lamp is illuminated. If the 75 indicator lamp goes out or remains out, do not transport a child on the passenger seat until the system has been repaired. A child in a rear-facing child restraint on the passenger seat will be seriously injured or even killed if the passenger 컄컄 front air bag inflates. Children 12 years old and under must be seated and properly secured in an appropriate infant or child restraint recommended for the size and weight of the child. The infant or child restraint must be properly secured with the vehicle’s seat belt fully in accordance with the child seat manufacturer's instructions. If the passenger front air bag is deployed, the rate of inflation will be influenced by: Children can be killed or seriously injured by an inflating air bag. Note the following important information: 앫 the rate of relevant vehicle deceleration as assessed by the air bag control unit 앫 앫 passenger’s weight category as identified by the Occupant Classification System (OCS) Your vehicle is equipped with air bag technology designed to turn off the passenger front air bag in your vehicle when the system senses the weight of a typical 12-month-old child or less along with the weight of a standard appropriate child restraint on the passenger seat. 73 Safety and Security Occupant safety 컄컄 앫 74 If you place a child in a forward-facing child restraint on the passenger seat, move the seat as far back as possible, use the proper child restraint recommended for the age, size and weight of the child, and secure child restraint with the vehicle’s seat belt according to the child seat manufacturer’s instructions. For children larger than the typical 12-month-old child, the passenger front air bag may or may not be activated (컄 page 72). i Deployment of the driver front air bag does not mean that the passenger front air bag also should have deployed. The 75 indicator lamp is located in the center console. The Occupant Classification System (컄 page 71) may have determined: 앫 that the seat was empty or occupied by the weight up to or less than that of a typical 12-month-old child seated in a standard child restraint – both instances where the system suppresses deployment of the passenger front air bag even though the impact met the criteria and was of sufficient severity to deploy the driver front air bag. 앫 that the seat was occupied by a small individual (such as a young teenager or a small adult) or a child weighing more than the weight of a typical 12-month-old child in a standard child restraint – instances where the system may suppress deployment of the passenger front air bag even though the impact met the criteria and was of sufficient severity to deploy the driver front air bag. 1 Passenger front air bag off indicator lamp The 75 indicator lamp 1 will be illuminated, except with the SmartKey removed or in starter switch position 0. Safety and Security Occupant safety Warning! G If the 1 indicator lamp and the 75 indicator lamp are lit at the same time, there is a malfunction in the Occupant Classification System. The passenger front air bag will be deactivated in this case. In order to ensure proper operation of the air bag system and OCS: 앫 Have the system checked as soon as possible by qualified technicians. Contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. 앫 Sit properly belted in a position that is as upright as possible with your back against the seat backrest. 앫 Do not lean on the armrests or lift yourself from the seat by using the handle over the door as this may cause the OCS to be unable to correctly approximate the occupant weight category. 앫 Only have the seat repaired or replaced by an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. 앫 Read and observe all warnings in this chapter. Self-test Occupant Classification System After turning the SmartKey in the starter switch to position 1 or 2, the 75 indicator lamp located in the center console illuminates. If an adult occupant is properly sitting on the passenger seat and the system senses the occupant as being an adult, the 75 indicator lamp will illuminate and go out after approximately 6 seconds. If the seat is not occupied and the system senses the passenger seat as being empty, the 75 indicator lamp will illuminate and not go out. Warning! G If the 75 indicator lamp should not illuminate, the system is not functioning. You must contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center before seating any child on the passenger seat. More information can be found in the “Practical hints” section (컄 page 354). Warning! G Never place anything between seat cushion and child seat (e.g. pillow), since it reduces the effectiveness of the Occupant Classification System. The bottom of the child seat must make full contact with the passenger seat cushion. An incorrectly mounted child seat could cause injuries to the child in case of an accident, instead of increasing protection for the child. Follow the manufacturer’s instructions for installation of child seats. 75 Safety and Security Occupant safety Seat belts Warning! The use of seat belts and infant and child restraint systems is required by law in all 50 states, the District of Columbia, the U.S. territories and all Canadian provinces. Even where this is not the case, all vehicle occupants should have their seat belts fastened whenever the vehicle is in motion. For information on fastening seat belts, see “Fastening the seat belts” (컄 page 48). i For information on infants and children traveling with you in the vehicle and restraint systems for infants and children, see “Children in the vehicle” (컄 page 79). G Always fasten your seat belt before driving off. Always make sure your passenger is properly restrained. Failure to wear and properly fasten and position your seat belt greatly increases your risk of injuries and their likely severity in an accident. You and your passenger should always wear seat belts. If you are ever in an accident, your injuries can be considerably more severe without your seat belt properly buckled. Without your seat belt buckled, you are much more likely to hit the interior of the vehicle or be ejected from it. You can be seriously injured or killed. In the same crash, the possibility of injury or death is lessened if you are properly wearing your seat belt. Air bags can only protect as they are designed if the occupants are properly wearing their seat belts. 76 Warning! G Never ride in a moving vehicle with the seat backrest in an excessively reclined position as this can be dangerous. You could slide under the seat belt in a collision. If you slide under it, the seat belt would apply force at the abdomen or neck. This could cause serious or even fatal injuries. The seat backrest and seat belt provide the best restraint when the wearer is in a position that is as upright as possible and the seat belt is properly positioned on the body. Warning! G Never let more people ride in the vehicle than there are seat belts available. Be sure everyone riding in the vehicle is correctly restrained with a separate seat belt. Never use a seat belt for more than one person at a time. Safety and Security Occupant safety Warning! G Damaged seat belts or seat belts that were highly stressed in an accident must be replaced and their anchoring points must also be checked. Warning! Do not bleach or dye seat belts as this may severely weaken them. In a crash, they may not be able to provide adequate protection. Have all work carried out only by qualified technicians. Contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. 앫 Never wear the shoulder belt under your arm, against your neck or off your shoulder. In a frontal crash, your body would move too far forward. That would increase the chance of head and neck injuries. The belt would also apply too much force to the ribs or abdomen, which could severely injure internal organs such as your liver or spleen. 앫 Never wear sear belts over rigid or breakable objects in or on your clothing, such as eyeglasses, pens, keys, etc., as these might cause injuries. 앫 Position the lap belt as low as possible on your hips and not across the abdomen. If the belt is positioned across your abdomen, it could cause serious injuries in a crash. 앫 Never use a seat belt for more than one person at a time. Do not fasten a seat belt around a person and another 컄컄 person or other objects. USE SEAT BELTS PROPERLY 앫 Seat belts can only work when used properly. Never wear seat belts in any other way than as described in this section, as that could result in serious injuries in case of an accident. 앫 Each occupant should wear their seat belt at all times, because seat belts help reduce the likelihood of and potential severity of injuries in accidents, including rollovers. The integrated restraint system includes SRS (driver air bag, knee bags, passenger front air bag, head-thorax air bags) and ETD (seat belt emergency tensioning device). The system is designed to enhance the protection offered to properly belted occupants in certain frontal (front air bags, knee bags and ETD) and side (head-thorax air bags and ETD) impacts which exceed preset deployment thresholds. Only use seat belts which have been approved by Mercedes-Benz. Do not make any modifications to the seat belts. This can lead to unintended activation of the ETDs or to their failure to activate when necessary. G 77 Safety and Security Occupant safety 컄컄 앫 Seat belts should not be worn twisted. In a crash, you would not have the full width of the seat belt to manage impact forces. The twisted seat belt against your body could cause injuries. 앫 Pregnant women should also always use a lap-shoulder belt. The lap belt portion should be positioned as low as possible on the hips to avoid any possible pressure on the abdomen. 앫 Never place your feet on the instrument panel, dashboard or on the seat. Always keep both feet on the floor in front of the seat. 앫 78 When using a seat belt to secure infant or toddler restraints or children in booster seats, always follow the child seat manufacturer’s instructions. Enhanced seat belt reminder system When the engine is started, the seat belt telltale < will always illuminate for 6 seconds to remind you and your passenger to fasten your seat belts. If the driver’s seat belt is not fastened when the engine is started, an additional warning chime will also sound for a maximum of 6 seconds or until the driver’s seat belt is fastened. If after these 6 seconds, the driver’s or the passenger’s seat belt (with the passenger seat occupied) are not fastened with both doors closed, 앫 the seat belt telltale < remains illuminated for as long as either the driver’s or passenger’s seat belt is not fastened. 앫 and if the vehicle speed once exceeds 15 mph (25 km/h), the seat belt telltale < starts flashing and a warning chime sounds with increasing intensity for a maximum of 60 seconds or until both the driver’s and passenger’s seat belt are fastened. If the driver’s or the passenger’s seat belt remains unfastened after 60 seconds, the warning chime stops sounding. The seat belt telltale < stops flashing but continues to be illuminated. The seat belt telltale < will only go out if both the driver’s and the passenger’s seat belt (with the passenger seat occupied) are fastened, or the vehicle is standing still and a door is opened. For more information, see the “Practical hints” section (컄 page 351). Safety and Security Occupant safety Emergency tensioning device (ETD), seat belt force limiter The seat belts are equipped with emergency tensioning devices and seat belt force limiters. The ETD is designed to activate in the following cases: 앫 in frontal or rear-end impacts exceeding the system deployment threshold 앫 if the restraint systems are operational and functioning correctly, see 1 indicator lamp (컄 page 64) 앫 in certain vehicle rollovers if the system determines an additional degree of protection i The ETDs will only activate if the seat belts are fastened (latch plate properly inserted into buckle). When activated, emergency tensioning devices remove slack from the seat belts in such a way that the seat belts fit more snugly against the body. Seat belt force limiters reduce the force exerted by the seat belts on occupants during a crash. Warning! G Children in the vehicle If an infant or child is traveling with you in the vehicle: 왘 Secure the child using an infant or child restraint appropriate to the age and size of the child. 왘 Make sure the infant or child is properly secured at all times while the vehicle is in motion. An emergency tensioning device (ETD) that was activated must be replaced. When disposing of the emergency tensioning device, our safety instructions must be followed. These are available at your authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. Warning! G Do not leave children unattended in the vehicle, even if they are secured in a child restraint system. The children could 앫 injure themselves on parts of the vehicle 앫 be seriously or fatally injured through excessive exposure to extreme heat or cold 79 컄컄 Safety and Security Occupant safety 컄컄 Do not expose the child restraint system to direct sunlight. The child restraint system’s metal parts, for example, could become very hot, and the child could be burned on these parts. If children open a door, they could 앫 앫 injure other persons get out of the car and injure themselves or be injured by following traffic Do not carry heavy or hard objects in the passenger compartment unless they are firmly secured in place. For more information, please refer to the “Useful features” section (컄 page 252) through (컄 page 254). Unsecured or improperly positioned cargo increases a child’s risk of injury in the event of 앫 strong braking maneuvers 앫 sudden changes of direction 앫 an accident 80 Infant and child restraint systems We recommend all infants and children be properly restrained at all times while the vehicle is in motion. The passenger lap-shoulder belt has a special seat belt retractor for secure fastening of child restraints. To fasten a child restraint follow child restraint instructions for mounting. Then pull the shoulder belt out completely and let it retract. During seat belt retraction, a ratcheting sound can be heard to indicate that the special seat belt retractor is activated. The seat belt is now locked. Push down on child restraint to take up any slack. To deactivate, release seat belt buckle and let seat belt retract completely. The seat belt can again be used in the usual manner. Warning! G Never release the seat belt buckle while the vehicle is in motion, since the special seat belt retractor will be deactivated. The use of infant or child restraints is required by law in all 50 states, the District of Columbia, the U.S. territories, and all Canadian provinces. Infants and small children should be seated in an appropriate infant or child restraint system which is properly secured by a lap-shoulder belt and that complies with U.S. Federal Motor Vehicle Safety Standards 213 and 255 and Canadian Motor Vehicle Safety Standards 213 and 210.2. Safety and Security Occupant safety A statement by the child restraint manufacturer of compliance with these standards can be found on the instruction label on the restraint and in the instruction manual provided with the restraint. When using any infant, or toddler restraint, or booster seat, be sure to carefully read and follow all manufacturer’s instructions for installation and use. Please read and observe warning labels affixed to inside of the vehicle and to infant or child restraints. Warning! G Children 12 years old and under must be seated and properly secured in an appropriate infant or child restraint recommended for the size and weight of the child. The infant or child restraint must be properly secured with the vehicle’s seat belt fully in accordance with the child seat manufacturer’s instructions. Occupants, especially children, should never place their bodies or lean their heads in the area of the door where the head-thorax air bag inflates. This could result in serious injuries or death should the head-thorax air bag be triggered. Always sit as upright as possible, properly use the seat belt and use an appropriately sized infant restraint, toddler restraint, or booster seat recommended for the size and weight of the child. Children can be killed or seriously injured by an inflating air bag. Note the following important information when you place a child in the passenger seat: 앫 Your vehicle is equipped with air bag technology designed to turn off the passenger front air bag in your vehicle when the OCS senses the weight of a typical 12-month-old child or less along with the weight of a standard appropriate child restraint on the front passenger seat. 앫 A child in a rear-facing child restraint on the passenger seat will be seriously injured or even killed if the passenger front air bag inflates in a collision which could occur under some circumstances, even with the air bag technology installed in your vehicle. 앫 If you install a rear-facing child restraint on the passenger seat, make sure that the 75 indicator lamp is illuminated, indicating that the passenger front air bag is deactivated. Should the 75 indicator lamp not illuminate or go out while the restraint is installed, please check installation. Periodically check the 75 indicator lamp while driving to make sure the 75 indicator lamp is illuminated. If the 75 indicator lamp goes out or remains out, do not transport a child on the passenger seat until the system has been repaired. A child in a rear-facing child restraint on the passenger seat will be seriously injured or even killed if the 컄컄 passenger front air bag inflates. 81 Safety and Security Occupant safety 컄컄 앫 If you place a child in a forward-facing child restraint on the passenger seat, move the seat as far back as possible, use the proper child restraint recommended for the age, size and weight of the child, and secure child restraint with the vehicle’s seat belt according to the child seat manufacturer’s instructions. For children larger than the typical 12-month-old child, the passenger front air bag may or may not be activated (컄 page 72). Warning! G Infants and small children should never share a seat belt with another occupant. During an accident, they could be crushed between the occupant and seat belt. A child’s risk of serious or fatal injuries is significantly increased if the child restraints are not properly secured in the vehicle and/or the child is not properly secured in the child restraint. Warning! G Children too big for a toddler restraint must ride in seats using regular seat belts. Position the shoulder belt across chest and shoulder, not face or neck. A booster seat may be necessary to achieve proper seat belt positioning for children over 41 lbs until they reach a height where a lap/shoulder belt fits properly without a booster. When the child restraint is not in use, remove it from the vehicle or secure it with the seat belt to prevent the child restraint from becoming a projectile in the event of an accident. Do not leave children unattended in the vehicle, even if the children are secured in a child restraint system. Unsupervised children in a child restraint system may use vehicle equipment and may cause an accident and/or serious personal injury. 82 Safety and Security Panic alarm 왔 Panic alarm i USA only: Activating This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: 왘 (1) This device may not cause harmful interference, and (2) this device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation. 1  button Any unauthorized modification to this device could void the user’s authority to operate the equipment. Press and hold button 1 for at least 1 second. An audible alarm and flashing exterior lamps will operate briefly. i Without the antenna on the left rear side of the vehicle installed, the SmartKey signaling range for the panic alarm is considerably reduced. The panic alarm then only functions if the SmartKey is held in close proximity towards the antenna base. i Canada only: This device complies with RSS-210 of Industry Canada. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: Deactivating (1) This device may not cause interference, and or (2) this device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation of the device. 왘 왘 Press button 1 again. Insert the SmartKey in the starter switch. Any unauthorized modification to this device could void the user’s authority to operate the equipment. 83 Safety and Security Driving safety systems In this section you will find information on the following driving safety systems: Warning! G ABS 앫 ABS (Antilock Brake System) BAS (Brake Assist System) The following factors increase the risk of accidents: Warning! 앫 앫 ESP® (Electronic Stability Program) 앫 Excessive speed, especially in turns 앫 Wet and slippery road surfaces 앫 Following another vehicle too closely Do not pump the brake pedal. Use firm, steady brake pedal pressure instead. Pumping the brake pedal defeats the purpose of the ABS and significantly reduces braking effectiveness. The driving systems described in this section cannot reduce these risks or prevent the natural laws of physics from acting on the vehicle. Always adjust your driving style to the prevailing road and weather conditions and keep a safe distance to other road users and objects on the street. i In winter operation, the maximum effectiveness of the ABS, the BAS, and the ESP® is only achieved with winter tires (컄 page 332) or snow chains as required. 84 G The Antilock Brake System (ABS) regulates the brake pressure so that the wheels do not lock during braking. This allows you to maintain the ability to steer your vehicle. The ABS is functional above a speed of approximately 5 mph (8 km/h) independent of road surface conditions. On slippery road surfaces, the ABS will respond even to light brake pressure. The - indicator lamp in the instrument cluster (컄 page 26) comes on when you switch on the ignition. It goes out when the engine is running. Safety and Security Driving safety systems Braking Emergency brake maneuver At the instant one of the wheels is about to lock up, a slight pulsation can be felt in the brake pedal, indicating that the ABS is in the regulating mode. 왘 왘 Keep firm and steady pressure on the brake pedal while experiencing the pulsation. Continuous, steady brake pedal pressure yields the advantages provided by the ABS, namely braking power and the ability to steer the vehicle. The pulsating brake pedal can be an indication of hazardous road conditions and functions as a reminder to take extra care while driving. Keep continuous full pressure on the brake pedal. Warning! G When the ABS is malfunctioning, the BAS and the ESP® are also switched off. The basic driving and braking functions are still available. When the ABS is malfunctioning, the wheels may lock during hard braking, reducing steering capability and extending the braking distance. Warning! G The ABS cannot prevent the natural laws of physics from acting on the vehicle, nor can it increase braking or steering efficiency beyond that afforded by the condition of the vehicle brakes and tires or the traction afforded. The ABS cannot prevent accidents, including those resulting from excessive speed in turns, following another vehicle too closely, or hydroplaning. Only a safe, attentive, and skillful driver can prevent accidents. The capabilities of an ABS equipped vehicle must never be exploited in a reckless or dangerous manner which could jeopardize the user’s safety or the safety of others. For more information, see “Practical hints” (컄 page 346). 85 Safety and Security Driving safety systems BAS Warning! The Brake Assist System (BAS) operates in emergency situations. If you apply the brakes very quickly, the BAS automatically provides full brake boost, thereby potentially reducing braking distance. 왘 Apply continuous full braking pressure until the emergency braking situation is over. The ABS will prevent the wheels from locking. When you release the brake pedal, the brakes function again as normal. The BAS is then deactivated. Warning! G If the BAS is malfunctioning, the brake system is still functioning normally, but without the additional brake boost available that BAS would normally provide in an emergency braking maneuver. Therefore, the braking distance may increase. 86 G The BAS cannot prevent the natural laws of physics from acting on the vehicle, nor can it increase braking efficiency beyond that afforded by the condition of the vehicle brakes and tires or the traction afforded. The BAS cannot prevent accidents, including those resulting from excessive speed in turns, following another vehicle too closely, or hydroplaning. Only a safe, attentive, and skillful driver can prevent accidents. The capabilities of a BAS equipped vehicle must never be exploited in a reckless or dangerous manner which could jeopardize the user’s safety or the safety of others. ESP® The Electronic Stability Program (ESP®) is operational as soon as the engine is running and monitors the vehicle’s traction (force of adhesive friction between the tires and the road surface) and handling. The ESP® recognizes when a wheel is spinning or if the vehicle starts to skid. By applying the brakes to the appropriate wheel and by limiting the engine output, the ESP® works to stabilize the vehicle. The ESP® is especially useful while driving off and on wet or slippery road surfaces. The ESP® also stabilizes the vehicle during braking and steering maneuvers. The ESP® warning lamp v in the instrument cluster flashes when the ESP® is engaged. The ESP® warning lamp v in the instrument cluster comes on when you switch on the ignition. It goes out when the engine is running. Safety and Security Driving safety systems Warning! G Never switch off the ESP® when you see the ESP® warning lamp v flashing in the instrument cluster. In this case, proceed as follows: 앫 While driving off, apply as little throttle as possible. 앫 While driving, ease up on the accelerator. 앫 Adapt your speed and driving style to the prevailing road conditions. Failure to observe these guidelines could cause the vehicle to skid. Warning! G The ESP® cannot prevent the natural laws of physics from acting on the vehicle, nor can it increase the traction afforded. The ESP® cannot prevent accidents, including those resulting from excessive speed in turns, or hydroplaning. Only a safe, attentive, and skillful driver can prevent accidents. The capabilities of an ESP® equipped vehicle must never be exploited in a reckless or dangerous manner which could jeopardize the user’s safety or the safety of others. ! Because the ESP® operates automatically, the engine must be turned off (SmartKey in starter switch position 0 or 1) when 앫 the parking brake is being tested on a brake test dynamometer 앫 the vehicle is being towed with the front axle raised Active braking action through the ESP® may otherwise seriously damage the brake system. i The ESP® will only function properly if you use wheels of the recommended tire size (컄 page 434). For more information, see the “Practical hints” section (컄 page 350) and (컄 page 359). The ESP® cannot prevent accidents resulting from excessive speed. 87 Safety and Security Driving safety systems Switching off the ESP® Electronic traction system Warning! The electronic traction system is a component of ESP®. Warning! The electronic traction system improves the vehicle’s ability to utilize available traction, especially under slippery road conditions by applying the brakes to a spinning wheel. The ESP® should not be switched off during normal driving other than in the circumstances described below. Disabling of the system will reduce vehicle stability in standard driving maneuvers. When you switch off the ESP®, the electronic traction system is still enabled. Warning! G If you are driving too fast, the electronic traction system cannot reduce the risk of an accident. The electronic traction system cannot prevent the natural laws of physics from acting on the vehicle. 88 G Do not switch off the ESP® when a spare wheel is mounted. To improve the vehicle’s traction, turn off the ESP® in driving situations where it would be advantageous to have the drive wheels spin and thus cut into surfaces for better grip such as: G Switch on the ESP® immediately if the aforementioned circumstances do not apply anymore. Otherwise the ESP® will not stabilize the vehicle when it is starting to skid or a wheel is spinning. When you switch off the ESP® 앫 the ESP® does not stabilize the vehicle 앫 the engine output is not limited, which allows the drive wheels to spin and thus cut into surfaces for a better grip 앫 the traction control will still apply the brakes to a spinning wheel 앫 the ESP® continues to operate when you are braking 앫 when driving with snow chains 앫 in deep snow 앫 you cannot activate the cruise control 앫 in sand or gravel 앫 the cruise control switches off if currently activated Safety and Security Driving safety systems i When the ESP® is switched off and one or more drive wheels are spinning, the ESP® warning lamp v in the instrument cluster flashes. However, the ESP® will then not stabilize the vehicle. The ESP® switch is located on the upper part of the center console. Warning! G When the ESP® warning lamp v is illuminated continuously, the ESP® is switched off or is not operational due to a malfunction. Vehicle stability in standard driving maneuvers reduces. Switching on the ESP® 왘 Press ESP® switch 1 until the ESP® warning lamp v in the instrument cluster goes out. You are now again in normal driving mode with the ESP® switched on. Adapt your speed and driving to the prevailing road conditions and to the non-operating status of the ESP®. ! Avoid spinning of a drive wheel for an extended period with the ESP® switched off. This may cause serious damage to the drivetrain which is not covered by the Mercedes-Benz Limited Warranty. 1 ESP® switch 왘 With the engine running, press ESP® switch 1 until the ESP® warning lamp v in the instrument cluster comes on. The ESP® is switched off. 89 Safety and Security Anti-theft systems Immobilizer Anti-theft alarm system The immobilizer prevents unauthorized persons from starting your vehicle. Once the alarm system has been armed, a visual and audible alarm is triggered when someone opens Activating 왘 Remove the SmartKey from the starter switch. 앫 a door 앫 the trunk lid 앫 the hood Deactivating 앫 the glove box 왘 앫 the storage/telephone* compartment in the center console Switch on the ignition (컄 page 37). i Starting the engine will also deactivate the immobilizer. In case the engine cannot be started (yet the vehicle’s battery is charged), the system is not operational. Contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center or call 1-800-FOR-MERCedes (in the USA), or 1-800-387-0100 (in Canada). 90 The alarm system will also be triggered when 앫 someone attempts to raise the vehicle 앫 opening the vehicle with the mechanical key 앫 someone opens a door from the inside 앫 someone opens the trunk lid with the emergency release button i The alarm will stay on, even if the activating element (e.g. a door) is immediately closed. i If the alarm stays on for more than 30 seconds, a call to the Response Center is initiated automatically by the Tele Aid* system (컄 page 261), provided Tele Aid* service was subscribed to and properly activated, and that necessary cellular service and GPS coverage are available (컄 page 261). Safety and Security Anti-theft systems Arming the alarm system Disarming the alarm system 왘 왘 Lock your vehicle with the SmartKey. The turn signal lamps flash three times and an acoustic warning sounds three times (if equipped and feature activated) to indicate that the alarm system is armed. The indicator lamp in the central locking switch starts flashing (컄 page 103). i If the turn signal lamps do not flash three times and no acoustic warning sounds three times (though equipped and feature activated), a door or the trunk lid may not be properly closed: Close the respective element and lock the vehicle again. Unlock your vehicle with the SmartKey. The turn signal lamps flash once and an acoustic warning sounds once (if equipped and feature activated) to indicate that the alarm system is disarmed. Canceling the alarm To cancel the alarm: 왘 Press the Œ or ‹ button on the SmartKey. Tow-away alarm Once the tow-away alarm is armed, a visual and audible alarm will be triggered when someone attempts to raise the vehicle. i The tow-away protection alarm is triggered, for example, if the vehicle is lifted on one side. If the alarm stays on for more than 30 seconds, a call to the Response Center is initiated automatically by the Tele Aid* system (컄 page 261), provided Tele Aid* service was subscribed to and properly activated, and that necessary cellular service and GPS coverage are available (컄 page 261). or 왘 Insert the SmartKey in the starter switch. 91 Safety and Security Anti-theft systems Arming tow-away alarm 왘 Lock your vehicle with the SmartKey. The switch is located on the lower part of the center console. 왘 Indicator lamp 1 in the tow-away alarm deactivation switch comes on briefly. The tow-away alarm is automatically armed after about 30 seconds. i When you unlock your vehicle, the tow-away protection disarms automatically. The tow-away alarm remains disarmed until you lock the vehicle again. 1 Indicator lamp 2 Tow-away alarm deactivation switch Exit your vehicle. 왘 Lock your vehicle with the SmartKey. Canceling tow-away alarm To cancel the alarm: 왘 Switch off the ignition (컄 page 37). 왘 왘 Remove the SmartKey from the starter switch. or i You cannot disarm the tow-away alarm while 왘 the ignition is switched on. 92 왘 The tow-away alarm remains disarmed until you lock your vehicle again. Disarming tow-away alarm To prevent triggering the tow-away alarm, switch off the tow-away alarm feature before towing the vehicle, or when parking on a surface subject to movement, such as a ferry or auto train. Press tow-away alarm deactivation switch 2. Press the Œ or ‹ button on the SmartKey. Insert the SmartKey in the starter switch. Controls in detail Locking and unlocking Seats Memory function* Lighting Instrument cluster Control system Manual transmission Automatic transmission* Good visibility Climate control Automatic climate control* Audio system Power windows Retractable hardtop Driving systems Loading Useful features 93 Controls in detail Locking and unlocking In the “Controls in detail” section you will find detailed information on how to operate the equipment installed in your vehicle. If you are already familiar with the basic functions of your vehicle, this section will be of particular interest to you. To quickly familiarize yourself with the basic functions of the vehicle, refer to the “Getting started” section of this manual. The corresponding page numbers are given at the beginning of each segment. For more information on unlocking and locking, see (컄 page 36) and (컄 page 59). SmartKey Your vehicle comes supplied with two SmartKeys, each with remote control and a removable mechanical key. The locking tabs for the mechanical key portion of the two SmartKeys are a different color to help distinguish each SmartKey unit. The SmartKey provides an extended operating range. To prevent theft, however, it is advisable to only unlock the vehicle when you are in close proximity to it. The SmartKey centrally locks and unlocks: 94 앫 the doors 앫 the trunk 앫 the fuel filler flap 앫 the glove box 앫 the storage/telephone* compartment under the armrest SmartKey with remote control 1 ‹ Lock button 2 Š Unlock button for the trunk (컄 page 100) 3 Mechanical key locking tab 4 Œ Unlock button 5 Battery check lamp 6  Panic button (컄 page 83) Controls in detail Locking and unlocking Warning! G When leaving the vehicle, always remove the SmartKey from the starter switch, take it with you, and lock the vehicle. Do not leave children unattended in the vehicle, or with access to an unlocked vehicle. A child’s unsupervised access to a vehicle could result in an accident and/or serious personal injury. ! Opening a door causes the windows on that side of the car to open slightly. They will return to the up position when the door is closed. The side windows will not open or close if the battery is discharged or the windows are impeded by ice. As a result, you may no longer be able to properly close the door. Do not attempt to force the door shut. Doing so may damage the door or the side window. Correct the condition that prevents the windows from operating before attempting to close the door. ! To prevent possible malfunction, avoid exposing the SmartKey to high levels of electromagnetic radiation. ! If you can no longer lock or unlock the vehicle with the SmartKey, the batteries in the SmartKey are discharged, the SmartKey is malfunctioning, or the vehicle battery is drained. i USA only: 앫 Check the batteries in the SmartKey and replace them if necessary (컄 page 391). (1) This device may not cause harmful interference, and 앫 Use the mechanical key to unlock the driver’s door (컄 page 387) and the trunk (컄 page 388). (2) this device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation. 앫 Use the mechanical key to lock the vehicle (컄 page 388). 앫 Have the vehicle battery and the battery connections checked (컄 page 415). Any unauthorized modification to this device could void the user’s authority to operate the equipment. This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: i Canada only: If the SmartKey is malfunctioning, contact Roadside Assistance or an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. This device complies with RSS-210 of Industry Canada. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: i Without the antenna on the left rear side of (1) This device may not cause interference, and the vehicle installed, the SmartKey signaling range is considerably reduced. Hold the SmartKey in close proximity towards the antenna base when locking or unlocking the vehicle. (2) this device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation of the device. i You can also open and close the retractable Any unauthorized modification to this device could void the user’s authority to operate the equipment. hardtop using the SmartKey* (컄 page 244). 95 Controls in detail Locking and unlocking Factory setting Global unlocking Global locking i Your vehicle may be equipped with an 왘 왘 acoustic lock and unlock confirmation signal feature. If your vehicle is equipped with this feature and the feature is activated, an acoustic signal will sound when the vehicle is locked or unlocked using the SmartKey. To determine whether or not your vehicle is equipped with this feature, contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. If equipped and you wish to activate or deactivate, or adjust its signal volume, also contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. Press button Œ. 앫 All turn signal lamps flash once. With all doors and the trunk closed: 앫 An acoustic warning sounds once (if equipped and feature activated). For more information, see “Factory setting” (컄 page 96). 앫 All turn signal lamps flash three times. 앫 An acoustic warning sounds three times (if equipped and feature activated). For more information, see “Factory setting” (컄 page 96). 앫 The locking knobs in the doors move down. 앫 The anti-theft alarm system is armed. 앫 The locking knobs in the doors move up. 앫 The anti-theft alarm system is disarmed. The vehicle will lock again automatically and rearm the anti-theft alarm system within approximately 40 seconds of unlocking if: 96 Press button ‹. 앫 neither door nor trunk is opened 앫 the SmartKey is not inserted in the starter switch 앫 the central locking switch is not activated Controls in detail Locking and unlocking Selective setting If you frequently travel alone, you may wish to reprogram the SmartKey so that pressing button Œ only unlocks the driver’s door, the storage/telephone* compartment under the armrest, the glove box, and the fuel filler flap. 왘 Press and hold buttons Œ and ‹ simultaneously for about 5 seconds until battery check lamp 5 (컄 page 94) flashes twice. The SmartKey will then function as follows: Unlocking driver’s door and fuel filler flap 왘 Press button Œ once. 앫 All turn signal lamps flash once. 앫 An acoustic warning sounds once (if equipped and feature activated). For more information, see “Factory setting” (컄 page 96). 앫 The locking knob in the driver’s door moves up. 앫 The anti-theft alarm system is disarmed. Global unlocking 왘 Press button Œ twice. 앫 All turn signal lamps flash once. 앫 An acoustic warning sounds once (if equipped and feature activated). For more information, see “Factory setting” (컄 page 96). 앫 The locking knobs in the doors move up. 앫 The anti-theft alarm system is disarmed. 97 Controls in detail Locking and unlocking Global locking Restoring to factory setting Loss of SmartKey or mechanical key 왘 왘 If you lose a SmartKey or mechanical key, you should do the following: Press button ‹. With all doors and the trunk closed: 앫 All turn signal lamps flash three times. 앫 An acoustic warning sounds three times (if equipped and feature activated). For more information, see “Factory setting” (컄 page 96). 앫 앫 The locking knobs in the doors move down. The anti-theft alarm system is armed. Press and hold buttons Œ and ‹ simultaneously for about 5 seconds until battery check lamp 5 (컄 page 94) flashes twice. Checking the batteries 왘 i If the battery check lamp (컄 page 94) does not come on briefly during check, the SmartKey batteries are discharged. Replace the batteries (컄 page 391). You can obtain the required batteries at any authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. i If the batteries are checked within signal range of the vehicle, pressing button ‹ or Œ will lock or unlock the vehicle accordingly. 98 Have the SmartKey deactivated by an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. 왘 Report the loss of the SmartKey or the mechanical key to your car insurance company immediately. 왘 If necessary have the mechanical lock replaced. Press button ‹ or Œ. The battery check lamp (컄 page 94) comes on briefly to indicate that the SmartKey batteries are in order. 앫 왘 Your authorized Mercedes-Benz Center will be glad to supply you with a replacement. Controls in detail Locking and unlocking Opening the doors from the inside You can open a locked door from the inside. Open door only when conditions are safe to do so. i If you hear a warning signal, you have forgot- ! Opening a door causes the windows on that ten to switch off the headlamps before opening the driver’s door. side of the car to open slightly. They will return to the up position when the door is closed. In addition, the message Turn off lights appears in the multifunction display. The side windows will not open or close if the battery is discharged or the windows are impeded by ice. As a result, you may no longer be able to properly close the door. Do not attempt to force the door shut. Doing so may damage the door or the side window. Correct the condition that prevents the windows from operating before attempting to close the door. Switch off the headlamps. ! Failure to switch off the headlamps when leaving the vehicle may result in a discharged battery. i If the vehicle has previously been centrally locked with the SmartKey, opening a door from the inside will trigger the anti-theft alarm system. To cancel the alarm, do one of the following: 1 Inside door handle 2 Locking knob 왘 앫 Press button Œ or ‹ on the SmartKey. 앫 Insert the SmartKey in the starter switch. Pull on door handle 1 on the respective door. If the door was locked, locking knob 2 will move up. 99 Controls in detail Locking and unlocking 왘 Opening the trunk Warning! G Make sure the trunk is closed when the engine is running and while driving. Among other dangers, deadly carbon monoxide (CO) gases may enter vehicle interior resulting in unconsciousness and death. Press and hold button Š on the SmartKey. The trunk is unlocked. 왘 Pull on the handle. 왘 Lift the trunk lid. ! When the trunk lid is lifted slightly, it swings open upwards automatically. Always make sure there is sufficient overhead clearance. i The vehicle or trunk must be unlocked Closing the trunk Warning! G Make sure the trunk is closed when the engine is running and while driving. Among other dangers, deadly carbon monoxide (CO) gases may enter vehicle interior resulting in unconsciousness and death. before the trunk lid can be opened. You can open the trunk when if vehicle is stationary. A minimum height clearance of 5.78 ft (1.76 m) is required to open the trunk lid. The trunk lid can only be opened when the vehicle is not in motion and the retractable hardtop is fully opened or closed. i Do not place the SmartKey in the open trunk. You may lock yourself out. The trunk lid can also be opened from the inside in an emergency, see “Trunk lid emergency release” (컄 page 101). 1 Handle 100 Controls in detail Locking and unlocking 왘 왘 Lower the trunk lid using handle 1. Close the trunk lid with hands placed flat on the trunk lid. i If the vehicle was previously centrally locked, the trunk lid will lock automatically when closed. The turn signal lamps will flash three times to confirm locking. Warning! G To prevent possible personal injury, always keep hands and fingers away from the trunk lid opening when closing the trunk lid. Be especially careful when small children are around. Warning! G When leaving the vehicle, always remove the SmartKey from the starter switch, take it with you, and lock the vehicle. Do not leave children unattended in the vehicle, or with access to an unlocked vehicle. A child’s unsupervised access to a vehicle could result in an accident and/or serious personal injury. Trunk lid emergency release With the emergency release button, the trunk can be opened from inside the trunk. 1 Emergency release button 왘 Briefly press emergency release button 1. The trunk lid unlocks and opens slightly. 왘 Push up the trunk lid to fully open. 101 Controls in detail Locking and unlocking i The emergency release button unlocks the trunk while the vehicle is standing still or in motion. Illumination of the emergency release button: 앫 The button flashes for 30 minutes after opening the trunk. 앫 The button flashes for 60 minutes after closing the trunk. i The emergency release button does not unlock the trunk if the vehicle battery is discharged or disconnected. i If the vehicle has previously been centrally locked with the SmartKey, opening the trunk from the inside will trigger the anti-theft alarm system. To cancel the alarm, do one of the following: 앫 Press button Œ or ‹ on the SmartKey. 앫 Insert the SmartKey in the starter switch. 102 Automatic central locking The doors and the trunk automatically lock when the vehicle is set into motion. i You can open a locked door from the inside. Open door only when conditions are safe to do so. i The doors unlock automatically after an accident if the force of the impact exceeds a preset threshold. The vehicle locks automatically when the ignition is switched on and the wheels are turning at a vehicle speed of approximately 9 mph (15 km/h) or more. You could therefore lock yourself out when the vehicle 앫 is pushed or towed 앫 is on a test stand You can deactivate the automatic locking using the control system, see “Setting automatic locking” (컄 page 146). Locking and unlocking from the inside Warning! G When leaving the vehicle, always remove the SmartKey from the starter switch, take it with you, and lock the vehicle. Do not leave children unattended in the vehicle, or with access to an unlocked vehicle. A child’s unsupervised access to a vehicle could result in an accident and/or serious personal injury. You can lock or unlock the doors and the trunk from the inside using the central locking or unlocking switch. This can be useful, for example, if you want to lock the vehicle before starting to drive. The fuel filler flap will not be locked or unlocked with the central locking or unlocking switch, respectively. Controls in detail Locking and unlocking Locking 왘 Press central locking switch 1. If all doors are closed, the vehicle locks. Unlocking 왘 Press central unlocking switch 2. The vehicle unlocks. 1 Central locking switch 2 Central unlocking switch i You can open a locked door from the inside. Open door only when conditions are safe to do so. If the vehicle was previously centrally locked using the SmartKey, it will not unlock using the central unlocking switch. If the vehicle was previously locked with the central locking switch 앫 and the SmartKey is set to factory settings, the complete vehicle is unlocked when a door is opened from the inside 앫 and the SmartKey is set to selective settings, only the door opened from inside is unlocked 103 Controls in detail Seats For information on seat adjustment, see “Adjusting” (컄 page 39). Red indicator lamps 2 on seat heating switch 1 show which heating level you have selected: Switching on seat heating 왘 Seat heating* One or more red indicator lamps 2 show the selected heating level. Level 3 Three indicator lamps on (highest level). After approximately 5 minutes, seat heating is automatically switched to level 2. 2 1 Seat heating switch 2 Indicator lamps Two indicator lamps on. After approximately 10 minutes, seat heating is automatically switched to level 1. 1 One indicator lamp on (lowest level). After approximately 20 minutes, seat heating is automatically switched to off. off 왘 104 No indicator lamp on. Switch on the ignition (컄 page 37). Press switch 1 repeatedly until the desired heating level is set. Switching off seat heating 왘 Press switch 1 repeatedly until all indicator lamps 2 go out. i If one or more indicator lamps 2 on the seat heating switch are flashing, there is insufficient voltage available since too many electrical consumers are turned on. The seat heating switches off automatically. The seat heating will switch back on again automatically as soon as sufficient voltage is available. Controls in detail Seats AIRSCARF neck-level heating* Warning! The AIRSCARF neck-level heating provides the area surrounding the occupants’ necks with a heated air stream flowing from openings in the head restraints. G When switching on the AIRSCARF neck-level heating, the air streaming from the openings may be very hot. When in close proximity to the openings, you could be seriously burned. To help avoid serious personal injuries, switch the AIRSCARF to a lower heating level. Red indicator lamps 2 on AIRSCARF switch 1 show which heating level you have selected: Level 3 Three indicator lamps on (highest level). 2 Two indicator lamps on. 1 One indicator lamp on (lowest level). off No indicator lamp on. 왘 Switch on the ignition (컄 page 37). 1 AIRSCARF switch 2 Indicator lamps 105 Controls in detail Seats Switching on Switching off 왘 왘 Press the AIRSCARF switch 1 for the desired side. All three indicator lamps 2 on respective AIRSCARF switch 1 come on. After a preheating time of approximately 7 seconds, the blower starts. 왘 Press AIRSCARF switch 1 repeatedly until the desired AIRSCARF heating level for the corresponding seat is reached. Press AIRSCARF switch 1 repeatedly until all indicator lamps 2 on AIRSCARF switch 1 go out. i After switching off the AIRSCARF neck-level heating, the AIRSCARF fan continues to operate for approximately 10 seconds to cool down the heater elements. i If one or more indicator lamps 2 on AIRSCARF switch 1 are flashing, there is insufficient voltage available since too many electrical consumers are turned on. The AIRSCARF neck-level heating switches off automatically. The AIRSCARF neck-level heating will switch back on again automatically as soon as sufficient voltage is available. 106 Controls in detail Memory function* 왔 Memory function* Prior to operating the vehicle, the driver should check and adjust the seat height, seat position fore and aft, and seat backrest angle if necessary, to ensure adequate control, reach and comfort. The head restraint should also be adjusted for proper height. See also the section on air bags (컄 page 66) for proper seat positioning. In addition, adjust the steering wheel to ensure adequate control, reach, operation and comfort. Both the interior and exterior rear view mirrors should be adjusted for adequate rear vision. Fasten seat belts. Infants and small children should be seated in an appropriate infant or child restraint system which is properly secured by a lap-shoulder belt and that complies with U.S. Federal Motor Vehicle Safety Standards 213 and 255 and Canadian Motor Vehicle Safety Standards 213 and 210.2. With the memory function you can store up to three different configurations. Each store position on the driver’s side includes the following settings: 앫 Seat position 앫 Steering wheel position 앫 Exterior rear view mirrors’ position Warning! G Do not activate the memory function while driving. Activating the memory function while driving could cause the driver to lose control of the vehicle. Each store position on the passenger side includes the following setting: 앫 The memory button and memory position switch are located on the outer side of each seat. 1 Memory button M 2 Memory position switch 왘 Switch on the ignition (컄 page 37). or 왘 Open the respective door. Seat position 107 Controls in detail Memory function* Storing positions into memory Recalling positions from memory 왘 Adjust the seat, on the driver’s side also the steering wheel and exterior rear view mirrors, to the desired positions (컄 page 39). ! Do not operate the power seats using the memory position switches if the seat backrest is in an excessively reclined position. Doing so could cause damage to the seats. 왘 Press memory button M. 왘 왘 Release memory button M and press a memory position switch 2 within 3 seconds. All settings are stored to the selected position. Press and hold desired memory position switch 2 until the seat, on the driver’s side also the steering wheel and exterior rear view mirrors, have completely moved to the stored positions. i Releasing the memory position switches immediately stops movement to the stored positions. 108 Controls in detail Lighting 왔 Lighting For information on how to switch on the headlamps and use the turn signals, see “Switching on headlamps” (컄 page 55) and “Turn signals” (컄 page 55). Exterior lamp switch 6 B Low beam headlamps or high beam headlamps when the combination switch is pushed forward. The tail lamps, license plate lamps, side marker lamps, parking lamps and instrument panel lamps also come on. i If you drive in countries where vehicles drive on the other side of the road than the country in which the vehicle is registered, you must have the headlamps modified for symmetrical low beams. Relevant information can be obtained at your authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. i Vehicles with active Bi-Xenon* headlamps: The active Bi-Xenon* headlamps monitor the vehicle’s steering angle and speed, then automatically shift their beams to either side to better follow the curvature of the road ahead, increasing usable illumination over conventional headlamps. 5 C Parking lamps (also side marker lamps, tail lamps, license plate lamps, instrument panel lamps) Exterior lamp switch 1 ‚ Standing lamps, left (turn left two stops) 7 ‡ Front fog lamps 8 † Rear fog lamp i If you hear a warning signal, you have forgot- 2 ˆ Standing lamps, right (turn left one stop) ten to switch off the headlamps before opening the driver’s door. 3 M Off In addition, the message Turn off lights appears in the multifunction display. Daytime running lamp mode (컄 page 111) 4 U Automatic headlamp mode Daytime running lamp mode (컄 page 111) Switch off the headlamps. ! Failure to switch off the headlamps when leaving the vehicle may result in a discharged battery. 109 Controls in detail Lighting Manual headlamp mode The low beam headlamps and the parking lamps can be switched on and off with the exterior lamp switch. 왘 Turn the exterior lamp switch to position B. Automatic headlamp mode The following lamps switch on and off automatically depending on the brightness of the ambient light: 앫 Low beam headlamps 앫 Tail and parking lamps 앫 License plate lamps 앫 Side marker lamps 110 Warning! G If the exterior lamp switch is set to U 앫 앫 the headlamps may switch off unexpectedly when the system senses bright ambient light, for example light from oncoming traffic. the headlamps will not be automatically switched on under foggy conditions. To minimize risk to you and to others, activate headlamps by turning exterior lamp switch to B when driving or when traffic and/or ambient lighting conditions require you to do so. In low ambient lighting conditions, only switch from position U to B with the vehicle at a standstill in a safe location. Switching from U to B will briefly switch off the headlamps. Doing so while driving in low ambient lighting conditions may result in an accident. The automatic headlamp feature is only an aid to the driver. The driver is responsible for the operation of the vehicle’s lights at all times. 왘 Turn the exterior lamp switch to position U. With the SmartKey in starter switch position 1, only the parking lamps and the side marker lamps will switch on and off automatically. When the engine is running, the low beam headlamps, the tail and parking lamps, the license plate lamps, and the side marker lamps will switch on and off automatically. i USA only: With the automatic headlamp mode activated you can switch on the high beam headlamps in low ambient lighting conditions. Controls in detail Lighting Daytime running lamp mode Canada only: When the engine is running, and you 왘 The daytime running lamp mode is mandatory and therefore in a constant mode. 앫 turn the exterior lamp switch to position C, the parking lamps and the side marker lamps switch on additionally. 앫 turn the exterior lamp switch to position B, the manual headlamp mode has priority over the daytime running lamp mode. Turn the exterior lamp switch to position M or U. When the engine is running, the low beam headlamps are switched on. In low ambient light conditions, the following lamps will switch on additionally: 앫 Tail and parking lamps 앫 License plate lamps 앫 Side marker lamps For nighttime driving you should turn the exterior lamp switch to position B to permit activation of the high beam headlamps. i With the daytime running lamp mode activated and the engine running, the low beam headlamps cannot be switched off manually. i With the exterior lamp switch in position M or U you cannot switch on the high beam headlamps. The high beam flasher is available at all times. For nighttime driving you should turn the exterior lamp switch to position B to permit activation of the high beam headlamps. Vehicles with automatic transmission*: When the engine is running, and you shift from a driving position to position N or P, the low beam headlamps will switch off with a three-minute delay. The corresponding exterior lamps switch on (컄 page 109). USA only: By default, the daytime running lamp mode is deactivated. Activate the daytime running lamp mode using the control system, see “Setting daytime running lamp mode” (컄 page 143). 111 Controls in detail Lighting i With the daytime running lamp mode activat- Fog lamps ed and the exterior lamp switch in position M, you cannot switch on the high beam headlamps. The high beam flasher is available at all times. For nighttime driving, turn the exterior lamp switch in position B or U to permit activation of the high beam headlamps. When the engine is running, and you turn the exterior lamp switch to position C or B, the manual headlamp mode has priority over the daytime running lamp mode. The corresponding exterior lamps switch on (컄 page 109). Locator lighting and night security illumination The locator lighting and the night security illumination are described in the “Control system” section, see “Setting locator lighting” (컄 page 144) and “Setting night security illumination” (컄 page 144). 112 Warning! Front fog lamps G In low ambient lighting or foggy conditions, only switch from position U to B with the vehicle at a standstill in a safe location. Switching from U to B will briefly switch off the headlamps. Doing so while driving in low ambient lighting conditions may result in an accident. 왘 Switch on the low beam headlamps B (컄 page 109). 왘 Pull out the exterior lamp switch to first stop. The front fog lamps switch on. The green indicator lamp ‡ in the exterior lamp switch comes on (컄 page 109). 왘 Push in the exterior lamp switch. i Fog lamps will operate with the parking The front fog lamps switch off. lamps and/or low beam headlamps on. Fog lamps should only be used in conjunction with low beam headlamps. Consult your State or Province Motor Vehicle Regulations regarding allowable lamp operation. The green indicator lamp ‡ in the exterior lamp switch goes out. i Fog lamps cannot be switched on with the exterior lamp switch in position U. To switch on the fog lamps, turn the exterior lamp switch to position B first. Controls in detail Lighting Rear fog lamp (driver’s side only) Combination switch High beam 왘 Switch on the low beam headlamps B (컄 page 112). 왘 Turn the exterior lamp switch to position B (컄 page 109). 왘 Pull out the exterior lamp switch to second stop. 왘 Push the combination switch in direction of arrow 1 to switch on the high beam. The front fog lamps and the rear fog lamp switch on. The high beam headlamp indicator lamp A in the instrument cluster comes on (컄 page 26). The yellow indicator lamp † in the exterior lamp switch comes on (컄 page 109). 왘 Push in the exterior lamp switch to first stop. 왘 1 High beam 2 High beam flasher The high beam headlamp indicator lamp A in the instrument cluster goes out. The rear fog lamp switches off. The yellow indicator lamp † in the exterior lamp switch goes out. The front fog lamps remain lit. Pull the combination switch in direction of arrow 2 to its original position to switch off the high beam. High beam flasher 왘 Pull the combination switch briefly in direction of arrow 2. 113 Controls in detail Lighting Corner-illuminating front fog lamps* i With automatic headlamp mode activated: i Corner-illuminating front fog lamps are not Corner-illuminating front fog lamps will only come on in low ambient lighting conditions. available for the following models: 앫 SLK 280 and SLK 350 without Bi-Xenon* headlamps 앫 SLK 280 and SLK 350 with Sport Package* 앫 SLK 55 AMG The corner-illuminating front fog lamps improve illumination of the area in the direction into which you are turning. The corner-illuminating front fog lamps will operate with the engine running and with 앫 i If you are driving faster than 25 mph (40 km/h) or have the front fog lamps switched on, the corner-illuminating front fog lamps function is not available. Driving forward Switching on corner-illuminating front fog lamps 왘 the exterior lamp switch in position B (컄 page 109) The respective front fog lamp comes on and illuminates the area in the direction into which you are turning. or 앫 앫 the exterior lamp switch in position U (컄 page 109) or or 왘 the daytime running lamp mode activated (컄 page 111) 114 Switch on the left or right turn signal (컄 page 55), depending on whether you are turning left or right. Turn the steering wheel in the desired direction. The front fog lamp on the side of your steering direction comes on. i If you have switched on the turn signal for one side but turn the steering wheel in the opposite direction, the corner-illuminating front fog lamp the corner-illuminating lamp comes on for the side indicated by the turn signal. The corner-illuminating front fog lamp remains lit for a maximum of 3 minutes. Afterwards, it goes out even if the turn signal is still switched on. i The corner-illuminating front fog lamps temporarily come on on both sides of the vehicle if you turn the steering wheel in one direction and then again in the other direction shortly thereafter. i The corner-illuminating front fog lamps will come on automatically depending on the steering angle, even if you did not switch on either turn signal. If the corner-illuminating front fog lamps came on automatically, they will also go out automatically depending on the steering angle. Controls in detail Lighting Switching off corner-illuminating front fog lamps The combination switch for the turn signal resets automatically after major steering wheel movements. This will switch off the corner-illuminating front fog lamps if they where activated by switching on the left or right turn signal. If the turn signal should stay on after making the turn, the turn signal and corner-illuminating front fog lamp can be switched off by returning the combination switch to its original position. i There may be a brief delay before the corner-illuminating front fog lamps switch off. Driving in reverse Hazard warning flasher Switching on corner-illuminating front fog lamps The hazard warning flasher can be switched on at all times, even with the SmartKey removed from the starter switch. 왘 Place the gearshift lever (automatic transmission*: gear selector lever) in position R. The front fog lamp opposite to your steering direction comes on. Switching off corner-illuminating front fog lamps 왘 The hazard warning flasher switches on automatically when an air bag deploys. The hazard warning flasher switch is located on the upper part of the center console. Place the gearshift lever (automatic transmission*: gear selector lever) out of position R. The respective front fog lamp goes out. 1 Hazard warning flasher switch 115 Controls in detail Lighting Switching on hazard warning flasher 왘 Press hazard warning flasher switch 1. Interior lighting The controls are located in the overhead control panel. All turn signal lamps are flashing. Automatic control i The interior lighting is factory-set to automatic mode. Deactivating i With the hazard warning flasher activated 왘 and the combination switch set for either left or right turn, only the respective turn signals will operate when the ignition is switched on. Press automatic control switch 2 until it engages at a deeper position than the other switches. Switching off hazard warning flasher The interior lighting remains switched off in darkness, even when you 왘 앫 unlock the vehicle 앫 remove the SmartKey from the starter switch 앫 open a door Press hazard warning flasher switch 1 again. i If the hazard warning flasher has been activated automatically, press hazard warning flasher switch 1 once to switch it off. 1 Interior lighting on/off 2 Automatic control on/off 3 Right reading lamp on/off 4 Left reading lamp on/off ! An interior lamp switched on manually does not go out automatically. Leaving an interior lamp switch in the ON position for extended periods of time with the engine turned off could result in a discharged battery. 116 i When you open the trunk, the trunk lighting switches on automatically. Controls in detail Lighting Activating 왘 Press automatic control switch 2 until it is flush to the other switches. The interior lighting switches on in darkness, when you 앫 unlock the vehicle 앫 remove the SmartKey from the starter switch 앫 open a door The interior lighting switches off automatically following a preset time delay. For more information, see “Setting interior lighting delayed shut-off” (컄 page 145). i If the door remains open, the interior lighting switches off automatically after approximately 5 minutes. Manual control Door entry lamps Switching interior lighting on and off For better orientation in the dark, the corresponding door entry lamps will switch on in darkness when you open a door and the automatic control is activated. 왘 Press interior lighting switch 1. The interior lighting switches on. 왘 Press interior lighting switch 1 again. The interior lighting switches off. i The footwell lighting* is switched on and off simultaneously with the manual control. Switching reading lamps on and off The door entry lamps switch off when the corresponding door is closed. i If you turn the SmartKey in the starter switch to position 0 and switch off the exterior headlamps, the door entry lamps will remain lit for approximately 5 minutes. The standard reading lamps are located to the left and right of the overhead control panel. Reading lamps as part of the interior lighting package* are located on the lower edge of the interior rear view mirror. 왘 Press reading lamp switch 3 or 4 to switch on the desired reading lamp. 왘 Press reading lamp switch 3 or 4 again to switch off the respective reading lamp. 117 Controls in detail Instrument cluster A full view illustration of the instrument cluster can be found in the “At a glance” section (컄 page 26). i Opening a door or pressing the reset button J without switching on the ignition or the exterior lighting activates the multifunction display illumination only for 30 seconds. For information on changing the instrument cluster settings, e.g. the language, see “Instrument cluster submenu” (컄 page 139). Warning! 1 To brighten instrument cluster illumination (knob +) 2 To dim instrument cluster illumination (knob -) 3 Reset button J The instrument cluster is activated when you 앫 open a door 앫 switch on the ignition (컄 page 37) 앫 press reset button J 앫 switch on the exterior lamps 118 G No messages will be displayed if either the instrument cluster or the multifunction display is inoperative. As a result, you will not be able to see information about your driving conditions, such as speed or outside temperature, warning/indicator lamps, malfunction/warning messages or the failure of any systems. Driving characteristics may be impaired. If you must continue to drive, do so with added caution. Contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center as soon as possible. Adjusting instrument cluster illumination Adjusting Use knobs 1 or 2 to adjust the illumination brightness of the instrument cluster. i The instrument cluster illumination automatically adjusts to the ambient light. You can only adjust the brightness of the instrument cluster illumination when it is dark outside. i With the exterior lighting switched on, the brightness of the switches in the center console will also be adjusted when using knob 1 or 2. To brighten illumination 왘 Press knob 1 briefly. The instrument cluster illumination brightens. To dim illumination 왘 Press knob 2 briefly. The instrument cluster illumination dims. Controls in detail Instrument cluster Tachometer The red marking on the tachometer (컄 page 26) denotes excessive engine speed. ! Avoid driving at excessive engine speeds, as it may result in serious engine damage that is not covered by the Mercedes-Benz Limited Warranty. To help protect the engine, the fuel supply is interrupted if the engine is operated within the red marking. Outside temperature indicator Warning! G The outside temperature indicator is not designed to serve as an ice-warning device and is therefore unsuitable for that purpose. Indicated temperatures just above the freezing point do not guarantee that the road surface is free of ice. The road may still be icy, especially in wooded areas or on bridges. The outside temperature is displayed in the multifunction display (컄 page 128). The temperature sensor is located in the front bumper area. Due to its location, the sensor can be affected by road or engine heat during idling or slow driving. Therefore, the accuracy of the displayed temperature can only be verified by comparison to a thermometer placed next the sensor, not by comparison to external displays, e.g. bank signs, etc. When moving the vehicle into colder ambient temperatures (e.g. when leaving your garage), you will notice a delay before the lower temperature is displayed. A delay also occurs when ambient temperatures rise. This prevents inaccurate temperature displays caused by heat radiated from the engine during idling or slow driving. 119 Controls in detail Instrument cluster Resetting trip odometer Clock 왘 Make sure you are viewing the standard display menu (컄 page 127). 왘 If it is not displayed, press button è or ÿ repeatedly until the standard display appears in the multifunction display. 왘 Press and hold reset button J until the trip odometer is reset. Vehicles with COMAND*: The clock in the instrument cluster can be synchronized with the time set in COMAND using the time synchronization with head unit feature (컄 page 141), or set independently from COMAND using the control system (컄 page 141) with the time synchronization with head unit feature set to Off. For setting the time in COMAND, see separate COMAND operating instructions. For setting the time with audio system, (컄 page 141). 120 Controls in detail Control system 왔 Control system The control system is activated as soon as the SmartKey in the starter switch is turned to position 1. The control system enables you to 앫 call up information about your vehicle 앫 change vehicle settings For example, you can use the control system to find out when your vehicle is next due for service, to set the language for messages in the instrument cluster display, and much more. i The displays for the audio systems (radio, CD player) will appear in English, regardless of the language selected. Warning! G Multifunction display A driver’s attention to the road and traffic conditions must always be his/her primary focus when driving. For your safety and the safety of others, selecting features through the multifunction steering wheel should only be done by the driver when traffic and road conditions permit it to be done safely. Bear in mind that at a speed of just 30 mph (approximately 50 km/h), your vehicle is covering a distance of 44 feet (approximately 14 m) every second. The control system relays information to the multifunction display. 1 Main odometer 2 Trip odometer 3 Current program mode (automatic transmission* only) 4 Status indicator (outside temperature/digital speedometer) 5 Current gear selector lever position/gear range (automatic transmission* only) 121 Controls in detail Control system Multifunction steering wheel The displays in the multifunction display and the settings in the control system are controlled by the buttons on the multifunction steering wheel. 1 Multifunction display Operating the control system 2 Selecting the submenu or setting the volume: Press button æ up/to increase ç down/to decrease 3 Telephone*: Press button s to take a call to dial to redial t to end a call to reject an incoming call 4 Moving within a menu: Press button j for next display k for previous display 5 Menu systems: Press button è for next menu ÿ for previous menu Depending on the selected menu, pressing the buttons on the multifunction steering wheel will alter what appears in the multifunction display. The information available in the multifunction display are arranged in menus, each containing a number of functions or submenus. The individual functions are then found within the relevant menu (radio or CD operations under Audio, for example). These functions serve to call up relevant information or to customize the settings for your vehicle. 122 Controls in detail Control system It is helpful to think of the menus, and the functions within each menu, as being arranged in a circular pattern. 앫 If you press button è or ÿ repeatedly, you will pass through each menu one after the other. 앫 If you press button j or k repeatedly, you will pass through each function display, one after the other, in the current menu. i The headings used in the menus table are designed to facilitate navigation within the system and are not necessarily identical to those shown in the control system displays. The first function displayed in each menu will automatically show you which part of the system you are in. i SLK 55 AMG: The steering wheel in this vehicle will vary from steering wheel shown. However, multifunction steering wheel symbols and feature description apply to AMG vehicles as well. In the Settings... menu, you will find a number of submenus instead of functions for calling up and changing settings. For instructions on using these submenus, see “Settings menu” (컄 page 136). The number of menus available in the system depends on which optional equipment is installed in your vehicle. 123 Controls in detail Control system Menus 124 This is what you will see when you scroll through the menus. The table below provides an overview of the individual menus. Controls in detail Control system Menus, submenus and functions Commands/submenus Menu 1 1 Menu 2 1 Menu 3 Menu 4 Standard display AMG AUDIO NAV* (컄 page 127) (컄 page 128) (컄 page 133) (컄 page 135) Run Flat Indicator* Engine oil temperature Selecting radio station Show route guidance instructions, current direction traveled Checking coolant temperature Vehicle supply voltage Selecting satellite radio station* (USA only) Digital speedometer/outside temperature RACETIMER Operating the CD player Calling up maintenance service indicator Overall analysis Checking engine oil level (SLK 55 AMG only) Lap analysis AMG vehicles only. Table continued on next page. 125 Controls in detail Control system Commands/submenus Menus, submenus and functions Menu 5 Menu 6 Menu 7 Menu 8 Vehicle status message memory1 Settings Trip computer TEL* (컄 page 135) (컄 page 136) (컄 page 148) (컄 page 149) Calling up vehicle malfunction, Resetting to factory settings warning and system status messages stored in memory Fuel consumption statistics since start Loading phone book Instrument cluster submenu Fuel consumption statistics since last reset Searching for name in phone book Time/Date submenu Resetting fuel consumption statistics Redialing Lighting submenu Distance to empty Vehicle submenu Convenience* submenu 1 The vehicle status message memory menu is only displayed if there is a message stored. 126 Controls in detail Control system Standard display menu The following functions are available: The multifunction display shows the main odometer and trip odometer. This default setting is referred to as the standard display. Function Page Run Flat Indicator* 315 Checking coolant temperature 127 Displaying digital speedometer or outside temperature 128 Calling up maintenance service indicator 334 Checking engine oil level (SLK 55 AMG only) 296 1 Main odometer 2 Trip odometer If another display is shown instead of the standard display: 왘 Press button è or ÿ repeatedly until the standard display appears in the multifunction display. 왘 Press button k or j to select the functions in the standard display menu. Checking coolant temperature Warning! G 앫 Driving when your engine is overheated can cause some fluids which may have leaked into the engine compartment to catch fire. You could be seriously burned. 앫 Steam from an overheated engine can cause serious burns and can occur just by opening the hood. Stay away from the engine if you see or hear steam coming from it. Stop the vehicle in a safe location away from other traffic. Turn off the engine, get out of the vehicle and do not stand near the vehicle until the engine has cooled down. 127 Controls in detail Control system ! Excessive coolant temperature triggers a warning message in the multifunction display (컄 page 368). The engine should not be operated with a coolant temperature above 248°F (120°C). Doing so may cause serious engine damage which is not covered by the Mercedes-Benz Limited Warranty. i During severe operating conditions, e.g. Displaying digital speedometer or outside temperature 왘 Press button j or k repeatedly until the digital speedometer appears in the multifunction display. The current vehicle speed or the outside temperature is appears in the multifunction display. stop-and-go city traffic, the coolant temperature may rise close to 248°F (120°C). 왘 AMG menu i This function is only available in AMG vehicles. The main screen of the AMG menu shows you the gear currently engaged as well as the engine oil temperature. 왘 Press button è or ÿ repeatedly until the AMG menu appears in the multifunction display. When in the standard display menu, press button j or k repeatedly until the coolant temperature appears in the multifunction display. Example illustration for selected vehicle speed i You can select to either display the digital speedometer or the outside temperature indicator (컄 page 140). 128 1 Gear indicator 2 Engine oil temperature Controls in detail Control system i The engine oil temperature symbol Vehicle supply voltage flashes if the engine oil temperature has not yet reached 80°C. During this time, avoid driving at full engine speed. 왘 왘 Use buttons k or j to select the following functions in the AMG menu: Function Page Vehicle supply voltage 129 RACETIMER 129 Overall analysis 132 Lap analysis 132 i If the engine reaches the overspeed range in the manual shift program (컄 page 165), the menu will be shown in red. In addition, you will see UP next to gear indicator 1 as a reminder to upshift. 왘 Press button è or ÿ repeatedly until you see the AMG menu. Press button j repeatedly until the vehicle supply voltage appears in the multifunction display. 1 Gear indicator 2 Vehicle supply voltage RACETIMER Warning! G The RACETIMER feature is only for use on roads and in conditions where high speed driving is permitted. Racing on public roads is prohibited under all circumstances and the driver is and must always remain responsible for following posted speed limits. The RACETIMER allows you to time and save driving stretches in hours, minutes and seconds. 왘 Press button è or ÿ repeatedly until the AMG menu appears in the multifunction display. 컄컄 129 Controls in detail Control system 컄컄 왘 Press button j repeatedly until the RACETIMER appears in the multifunction display. Starting the RACETIMER Stopping the RACETIMER 왘 왘 Press button æ. The timer starts. Displaying intermediate time 왘 1 Gear indicator 2 RACETIMER 3 Lap number i You can start the RACETIMER when the engine is running or the starter switch is in position 2 (컄 page 37). i While the RACETIMER is being displayed, you cannot adjust the audio volume using buttons æ or ç. 130 Press button ç while the timer is running. The intermediate time is shown for 5 seconds. Press button æ. The timer stops. i When you stop the vehicle and turn the SmartKey to position 1 (컄 page 37), the RACETIMER stops timing. Timing is resumed when you switch the ignition back on (컄 page 37) or restart the engine (컄 page 51) and then press the æ button. Controls in detail Control system Saving lap time and starting a new lap Resetting current lap Deleting all laps i You can save up to nine laps. 왘 i It is not possible to delete a single saved lap. 왘 Press button ç while the timer is running. The intermediate time will be shown for 5 seconds. 왘 왘 Press button æ while the timer is running. 왘 The timer stops. Press button æ while the timer is running. Press button ç. The timer stops. The lap time is reset to “0”. 왘 Press the reset button twice (컄 page 26). 왘 Press button æ. Press button ç within 5 seconds. The intermediate time shown will be saved as a lap time. The RACETIMER begins timing the new lap. The new lap begins to be timed as soon as the intermediate time is called up. The timer starts. The saved laps are deleted. i When you turn off the engine, the RACETIMER will be reset to “0” after 30 seconds. All laps are deleted. 1 Gear indicator 2 RACETIMER 3 Best lap time 4 Lap number 131 Controls in detail Control system Overall analysis Lap analysis 왘 i These functions are only available if you have saved at least one lap and have stopped the RACETIMER. i These functions are only available if you have saved at least two laps and have stopped the RACETIMER. i Each lap is shown in its own submenu. The fastest lap is indicated by flashing symbol 1. 왘 Press button è or ÿ repeatedly until the AMG menu appears in the multifunction display. 왘 Press button è or ÿ repeatedly until the AMG menu appears in the multifunction display. 왘 Press button j repeatedly until the overall analysis appears in the multifunction display. 왘 Press button j repeatedly until the lap analysis appears in the multifunction display. 1 Overall analysis of RACETIMER 2 Overall driving time 3 Maximum speed 4 Overall distance driven 5 Average speed 132 1 Lap number 2 Lap time 3 Maximum speed 4 Lap length 5 Average speed during lap Press button j or k to see other lap analyses. Controls in detail Control system Selecting radio station AUDIO menu The functions in the AUDIO menu operate the audio equipment which you currently have turned on. If no audio equipment is currently switched on, the message AUDIO off appears in the multifunction display. The following functions are available: Function Page Selecting radio station 133 Selecting satellite radio station* (USA only) 134 Operating the CD player 134 왘 Switch on the radio (컄 page 199). Vehicles with COMAND*: Refer to the separate operating instructions. 왘 Press button è or ÿ repeatedly until the currently tuned station appears in the multifunction display. 왘 Press button j or k repeatedly until the desired station is found. The station search depends on the selected setting in the Vehicle submenu of the control system (컄 page 146). Pressing button k or j will either start a frequency scan or select the next stored radio station. i You can only store new stations using the corresponding feature on the radio (컄 page 201). Vehicles with COMAND*: Refer to the separate operating instructions. 1 Waveband setting or stored memory position (FM1 through FM9) 2 Tuned station 133 Controls in detail Control system Selecting satellite radio station* (USA only) Operating the CD player 왘 The Sirius satellite radio is treated as a radio application. 왘 Select satellite radio with the corresponding soft key (SAT) in the radio menu. Switch on the radio and select the CD player (컄 page 212). Vehicles with COMAND*: Refer to the separate operating instructions. 왘 Press button è or ÿ repeatedly until the settings for the CD currently being played appear in the multifunction display. 1 SAT mode and preset number 2 Channel name or number 왘 Press button j or k repeatedly until the desired channel is found. i For more information on satellite radio operation, see “Introduction to satellite radio* (USA only)” (컄 page 203). Vehicles with COMAND*: Refer to separate operating instructions. 134 1 Current CD (CD0 for single CD drive in head unit, CD1 through CD6 for CD in CD changer*) 2 Current track 왘 Press button j or k repeatedly until the desired track is selected. i To select a CD from the magazine, press a number on the audio system or the COMAND* system key pad located in the center dashboard. Controls in detail Control system NAV* menu The NAV menu contains the functions needed to operate your navigation system. 왘 Press button è or ÿ repeatedly until you see the message NAV in the multifunction display. 앫 앫 앫 If the COMAND* system is switched off, the message NAV off appears in the multifunction display. With COMAND* switched on but route guidance not activated, the direction of travel and, if available, the name of the street currently traveled on appear in the multifunction display. With COMAND* switched on and route guidance activated, the direction of travel and maneuver instructions appear in the multifunction display. Please refer to the COMAND* manual for instructions on how to activate the route guidance system. Vehicle status message memory menu Use the vehicle status message memory menu to scan malfunction and warning messages that may be stored in the system. Such messages appear in the multifunction display and are based on conditions or system status the vehicle’s system has recorded. The vehicle status message memory menu only appears if there are any messages stored in the system. Warning! and/or driver’s responsibility to maintain the vehicle’s operating safety by having all required maintenance and safety checks performed on the vehicle and by bringing the vehicle to an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center to address the malfunction and warning messages (컄 page 356). 왘 Press button è or ÿ repeatedly until the vehicle status message memory menu appears in the multifunction display. If the vehicle status message memory menu does not appear, no messages have been stored. 컄컄 G Malfunction and warning messages are only indicated for certain systems and are intentionally not very detailed. The malfunction and warning messages are simply a reminder with respect to the operation of certain systems and do not replace the owner’s 135 Controls in detail Control system 컄컄 If conditions have occurred causing status messages to be recorded, the number of messages appears in the multifunction display: i The vehicle status message memory will be cleared when you turn the SmartKey in the starter switch to position 1 or 2. You will then only see high-priority messages in the multifunction display (컄 page 356). The following settings and submenus are available in the Settings... menu: Function Page Resetting all settings 136 Submenus in the Settings menu 137 Settings menu In the Settings... menu are two functions: 1 Number of recorded status messages 왘 Should the vehicle’s system record any conditions while driving, the number of messages will reappear in the multifunction display when the SmartKey in the starter switch is turned to position 0 or removed from the starter switch: 136 139 Time/date submenu 139 Lighting submenu 143 The function To reset: Push reset button for 3 seconds for resetting all settings to factory standard. Vehicle submenu 146 Convenience* submenu 147 앫 A collection of submenus for performing individual settings for your vehicle. Resetting all settings 왘 Press button è or ÿ repeatedly until the Settings... menu appears in the multifunction display. 앫 Press button j or k. The stored messages will now be displayed in the order in which they have occurred. For malfunction and warning messages, see “Vehicle status messages in the multifunction display” (컄 page 356). Instrument cluster submenu You can reset all the functions of most of the submenus to the factory settings. For safety reasons, the function Headlamp mode in the Lighting submenu cannot be reset while driving. 왘 Press button è or ÿ repeatedly until the Settings... menu appears in the multifunction display. Controls in detail Control system 왘 Press the reset button J on the instrument cluster (컄 page 26) for approximately 3 seconds. The request to press the reset button J once more to confirm appears in the multifunction display. 왘 Submenus in the Settings menu 왘 Press button è or ÿ repeatedly until the Settings... menu appears in the multifunction display. 왘 Press button j. In the multifunction display you see the collection of the submenus. There are more submenus than can be simultaneously displayed. Press the reset button J once more. The functions of all submenus will be reset to the factory settings. The message Reset to factory settings appears in the multifunction display. i Your individual settings will not be reset unless you confirm the action by pressing the reset button J again. After 5 seconds the Settings... menu reappears in the multifunction display. 왘 왘 With the selection marker on the desired submenu, use the j button to access the individual functions within that submenu. 왘 Once within the submenu, use the j button to move to the next function or the k button to move to the previous function within that submenu. 왘 Use buttons æ or ç to change the settings of the respective function. Press button ç. The selection marker moves to the next submenu. 왘 Scroll up with button æ, and scroll down with button ç. 137 Controls in detail Control system The table below shows what settings can be changed within the various submenus. Detailed instructions on making individual settings can be found on the following pages. Instrument cluster Time/Date Lighting Vehicle Convenience* (컄 page 139) (컄 page 141) (컄 page 143) (컄 page 146) (컄 page 147) Selecting digital speedometer display mode Synchronizing time and date with head unit* Setting daytime running lamp mode (USA only) Selecting audio search function Activating easy-entry/exit feature* Selecting language Setting the time Setting locator lighting Setting automatic locking Selecting display (speed Setting the date display or outside temperature) for status indicator Setting night security illumination Setting interior lighting delayed shut-off 138 Controls in detail Control system Instrument cluster submenu Access the Instr. cluster submenu via the Settings... menu. Use the Instr. cluster submenu to change the instrument cluster display settings. Selecting digital speedometer display mode 왘 Move the selection marker with button æ or ç to the Instr. cluster submenu. 왘 Function Page Selecting speedometer display mode 139 Press button j or k repeatedly until the message Display unit Digital speedometer appears in the multifunction display. Selecting language 139 The selection marker is on the current setting. The following functions are available: Selecting language 왘 Move the selection marker with button æ or ç to the Instr. cluster submenu. 왘 Press button j or k repeatedly until the message Language appears in the multifunction display. The selection marker is on the current setting. Selecting display (speed display 140 or outside temperature) for status indicator 왘 왘 Press button æ or ç to set the speedometer unit to km or miles. Press button æ or ç to select the desired language to be used for the multifunction display messages. 139 Controls in detail Control system Available languages: 앫 German 앫 English 앫 French 앫 Italian 앫 Spanish 앫 Dutch 앫 Danish 앫 Swedish 앫 Portuguese 앫 Turkish Selecting display (speed display or outside temperature) for status indicator 왘 Move the selection marker with button æ or ç to the Instr. cluster submenu. 왘 Press button j or k repeatedly until the message Select display appears in the multifunction display. The selection marker is on the current setting. 왘 Press button æ or ç to select the desired setting. The selected display is then shown continuously in the lower display. The other display now appears in the menu of the standard display: 앫 Digital speedometer or 앫 140 Outside temperature Controls in detail Control system Time/Date submenu Access the Time/Date submenu via the Settings... menu. Use the Time/Date submenu to change the instrument cluster display settings. Time and date synchronization with head unit* This function is only available in vehicles with COMAND* and navigation module*. 왘 The following functions are available: Function Page Time and date synchronization with head unit* 141 Setting the time 141 Setting the date 142 왘 Move the selection marker with button æ or ç to the Time/Date submenu. Press button j or k repeatedly until the message Time synchronization with Head Unit appears in the multifunction display. Setting the time This function is only available in vehicles with audio system, or in vehicles with COMAND* and navigation module*, if the time and date synchronization with head unit* feature was set to Off (컄 page 141). i Vehicles with COMAND*: For information on setting the time in COMAND, refer to the separate COMAND operating instructions. The selection marker is on the current setting. 왘 Press button æ or ç to select the desired setting. 141 Controls in detail Control system 왘 왘 Move the selection marker with button æ or ç to the Time/Date submenu. Press button j or k repeatedly until the message Time, hours Press R to confirm or Time, minute(s) Press R to confirm appears in the multifunction display. Setting the date 왘 This function is only available in vehicles with audio system, or in vehicles with COMAND* and navigation module*, if the time and date synchronization with head unit* feature was set to Off (컄 page 141). Move the selection marker with button æ or ç to the Time/Date submenu. 왘 Press button j or k repeatedly until the message Set date Month, Set date Day, or Set date Year appears in the multifunction display. i Vehicles with COMAND*: For information on setting the time in COMAND, refer to the separate COMAND operating instructions. Example illustration for setting the month Example illustration for setting the hour 왘 Press button æ or ç to set the hours or minute(s). 왘 Press reset button J to confirm. 142 왘 Press button æ or ç to set the month, day, or year. Controls in detail Control system Lighting submenu Access the Lighting submenu via the Settings... menu. Use the Lighting submenu to change the lamp and lighting settings on your vehicle. The following functions are available: Function Page Setting daytime running lamp mode (USA only) 143 Setting locator lighting 144 Setting night security illumination 144 Setting daytime running lamp mode (USA only) i This function is not available in countries where the daytime running lamp mode is mandatory and therefore in a constant mode. 왘 왘 Move the selection marker with button æ or ç to the Lighting submenu. Press button j or k repeatedly until the message Headlamp mode appears in the multifunction display. The selection marker is on the current setting. Setting interior lighting delayed 145 shut-off With daytime running lamp mode activated and the exterior lamp switch at position M or U, the low beam headlamps are switched on when the engine is running. In low ambient light conditions the following lamps will switch on additionally: 앫 Parking lamps 앫 Tail lamps 앫 License plate lamps 앫 Side marker lamps For more information on the daytime running lamp mode, see “Lighting” (컄 page 109). i For safety reasons, resetting all the functions of all submenus to the factory settings while driving (컄 page 136) will not deactivate the daytime running lamp mode. 왘 Press button æ or ç to select manual operation (Manual) or daytime running lamp mode (Constant). The following message appears in the multifunction display: Lighting Cannot be completely reset to factory settings while driving. 143 Controls in detail Control system Setting locator lighting 왘 With the locator lighting feature activated and the exterior lamp switch in position U, the following lamps will switch on during darkness when the vehicle is unlocked with the SmartKey: Move the selection marker with button æ or ç to the Lighting submenu. 왘 Press button j or k repeatedly until the message Function Surround lighting appears in the multifunction display. 앫 Parking lamps 앫 Tail lamps 앫 License plate lamps 앫 Side marker lamps 앫 Front fog lamps The selection marker is on the current setting. The locator lighting switches off when the driver’s door is opened. If you do not open a door after unlocking the vehicle with the SmartKey, the lamps will switch off automatically after approximately 40 seconds. 왘 왘 Press button æ or ç to switch the locator lighting function On or Off. Turn the exterior lamp switch to position U when exiting the vehicle (컄 page 55). The locator lighting feature is activated. 144 Setting night security illumination (Headlamps delayed shut-off) Use this function to set whether you would like the exterior lamps to remain on for 15 seconds during darkness after exiting the vehicle and closing all doors. With the headlamps delayed shut-off feature activated and the exterior lamp switch in position U before the engine is turned off, the following lamps will switch on when the engine is turned off: 앫 Parking lamps 앫 Tail lamps 앫 License plate lamps 앫 Side marker lamps 앫 Front fog lamps Controls in detail Control system If after turning off the engine you do not open a door or do not close an opened door, the lamps will automatically switch off after 60 seconds. 왘 왘 Move the selection marker with button æ or ç to the Lighting submenu. Press button j or k repeatedly until the message Headlamps delayed shut-off appears in the multifunction display. The selection marker is on the current setting. 왘 Turn the exterior lamp switch to position U before turning off the engine (컄 page 55). The headlamps delayed shut-off feature is activated. You can temporarily deactivate the delayed shut-off feature: 왘 왘 Before exiting the vehicle, turn the SmartKey in the starter switch to position 0. Setting interior lighting delayed shut-off Use this function to set whether you would like the interior lighting to remain on for 10 seconds during darkness after you have removed the SmartKey from the starter switch. 왘 Move the selection marker with button æ or ç to the Lighting submenu. 왘 Press button j or k repeatedly until the message Interior lighting delayed shut-off appears in the multifunction display. Then turn it to position 2 and back to position 0. The delayed shut-off feature is deactivated. It will reactivate as soon as you reinsert the SmartKey in the starter switch. 왘 Press button æ or ç to switch the headlamps delayed shut-off feature On or Off. The selection marker is on the current setting. 왘 Press button æ or ç to switch the interior delayed shut-off feature On or Off. 145 Controls in detail Control system Vehicle submenu Selecting audio search function Setting automatic locking Access the Vehicle submenu via the Settings... menu. Use the Vehicle submenu to make general vehicle settings. Use of the Audio search function to select a radio station (컄 page 133) will enable you to start a frequency scan (Frequency) or select a radio station stored in memory (Memory). Use this function to activate or deactivate the automatic locking system. With the automatic locking system activated, the vehicle is centrally locked at vehicle speeds of approximately 9 mph (15 km/h). The following functions are available: Function Page 왘 Selecting audio search function 146 Setting automatic locking 146 왘 For additional information on central locking, see “Automatic central locking” (컄 page 102). Move the selection marker with button æ or ç to the Vehicle submenu. Press button j or k repeatedly until the message Audio Search function appears in the multifunction display. 왘 Move the selection marker with button æ or ç to the Vehicle submenu. 왘 Press button j or k repeatedly until the message Automatic door lock appears in the multifunction display. The selection marker is on the current setting. 왘 146 Press button æ or ç to select Frequency or Memory. The selection marker is on the current setting. 왘 Press button æ or ç to set the automatic central locking to On or Off. Controls in detail Control system Convenience* submenu Activating easy-entry/exit feature* 왘 Access the Convenience submenu via the Settings... menu. Use the Convenience submenu to change the settings for a number of convenience features. Use this function to activate and deactivate the easy-entry/exit feature (컄 page 44). Move the selection marker with button æ or ç to the Convenience submenu. 왘 Press button j or k repeatedly until the message Easy-entry function appears in the multifunction display. G The following function is available: Warning! Function Page Activating easy-entry/exit feature* 147 You must make sure no one can become trapped or injured by the moving steering wheel when the easy-entry/exit feature is activated. The selection marker is on the current setting. To cancel steering wheel movement, do one of the following: 앫 Move steering wheel adjustment stalk* (컄 page 44). 앫 Press one of the memory position buttons* or the memory button M* (컄 page 107). 왘 Press button æ or ç to switch the easy-entry function On or Off. Do not leave children unattended in the vehicle, or with access to an unlocked vehicle. Children could open the driver’s door and unintentionally activate the easy-entry/exit feature, which could result in an accident and/or serious personal injury. 147 Controls in detail Control system Trip computer menu Use the trip computer menu to call up statistical data on your vehicle. Fuel consumption statistics since start Fuel consumption since last reset 왘 왘 Press button è or ÿ repeatedly until the message From start appears in the multifunction display. 왘 Press button j or k repeatedly until the message Since reset appears in the multifunction display. Press button è or ÿ repeatedly until the message From start appears in the multifunction display. The following information is available: Function Page Fuel consumption statistics since start 148 Fuel consumption statistics since last reset 148 Resetting fuel consumption statistics 149 Calling up range (distance to empty) 149 1 Statistics called up: since start 2 Time elapsed since start 3 Average fuel consumption since start 4 Average speed since start 5 Distance driven since start i All statistics stored since the last engine start will be reset approximately four hours after the SmartKey in the starter switch is turned to position 0 or removed from the starter switch. Resetting will not occur if you turn the SmartKey back to position 1 or 2 within this time period. 148 1 Statistics called up: since last reset 2 Time elapsed since last reset 3 Average fuel consumption since last reset 4 Average speed since last reset 5 Distance driven since last reset Controls in detail Control system Resetting fuel consumption statistics 왘 Press and hold reset button J until the values of the statistics are reset to 0. i The fuel consumption statistics reset automatically to 0 when either of the following values is exceeded: 앫 distance covered: 100000 miles (100000 km) 앫 time elapsed: 10000 hours Calling up range (distance to empty) 왘 왘 Press button è or ÿ repeatedly until the message From start appears in the multifunction display. Press button j or k repeatedly until the message Range: appears in the multifunction display. The calculated remaining driving range based on the current fuel tank level appears in the multifunction display. i If only very little fuel is left in the tank, a vehicle at the fuel pump is shown instead of the range. TEL* menu Warning! G A driver’s attention to the road must always be his/her primary focus when driving. For your safety and the safety of others, we recommend that you pull over to a safe location and stop before placing or taking a telephone call. If you choose to use the telephone while driving, please use the hands-free device and only use the telephone when weather, road, and traffic conditions permit. Some jurisdictions prohibit the driver from using a cellular telephone while driving a vehicle. Bear in mind that at a speed of just 30 mph (approximately 50 km/h), your vehicle is covering a distance of 44 feet (approximately 14 m) every second. 컄컄 149 Controls in detail Control system 컄컄 Never operate radio transmitters equipped with a built-in or attached antenna (i.e. without being connected to an external antenna) from inside the vehicle while the engine is running. Doing so could lead to a malfunction of the vehicle’s electronic system, possibly resulting in an accident and/or personal injury. You can use the functions in the TEL menu to operate your telephone, provided it is connected to a hands-free system and switched on. 왘 Switch on the telephone and Audio or COMAND*. Which messages will appear in the multifunction display depends on whether your telephone is switched on or off: 앫 If the telephone is switched off, the message in the multifunction display is: PHONE OFF. 앫 If the telephone is switched on: Answering a call When your telephone is ready to receive calls, you can answer a call at any time. In the multifunction display you will see the message, or if available, the caller ID (name and number): The telephone will then search for a network. During this time the multifunction display is empty. As soon as the telephone has found a network, Ready is indicated in the multifunction display. Audio system See separate operating instructions. 왘 Press button è or ÿ repeatedly until the TEL menu appears in the multifunction display. COMAND* This standby message indicates that your telephone is ready for use and you can operate it using the control system. 왘 Press button s. You have answered the call. The duration of the call appears in the multifunction display. 150 Controls in detail Control system Ending a call or rejecting an incoming call 왘 Press button t. Dialing a number from the phone book If your telephone is ready to receive calls, you may select and dial a number from the phone book at any time. 왘 Press button è or ÿ repeatedly until the TEL menu and the standby message appear in the multifunction display. 왘 Press button j or k. The control system reads the phone book which is stored in the telephone. This may take up to 30 seconds. In the multifunction display you will see the message Please wait. When the message Please wait disappears, the phone book has been loaded. 왘 Press button j or k repeatedly until the desired name appears in the multifunction display. 왘 Press button s. The control system dials the selected phone number. The stored names are displayed in ascending or descending alphabetical order. 앫 If the connection is successful, the name of the party you called and the duration of the call will appear in the display. 앫 If no connection is made, the control system stores the dialed number in the redial memory. 1 Selected name from phone book i If you press and hold button j or k for longer than 1 second, the system scrolls rapidly through the list of names until you release the button again. Cancel the quick search mode by pressing button t. or 왘 Cancel the call you have intended to make by pressing button t. 151 Controls in detail Control system Redialing The control system stores the most recently dialed phone numbers. This eliminates the need to search through your entire phone book. 왘 왘 왘 Press button j or k repeatedly until the desired number or name appears in the multifunction display. 왘 Press button s. The control system dials the selected phone number. Press button è or ÿ repeatedly until the TEL menu and the standby message appear in the multifunction display. If the connection is successful, the duration of the call will appear in the multifunction display, and Press button s. 앫 In the multifunction display you will see the first number in the redial memory. the name of the party if stored in the phone book or 앫 instead of it the dialed number or 왘 152 Cancel the call you have intended to make by pressing button t. Controls in detail Manual transmission 왔 Manual transmission Manual transmission is standard equipment on select models and not available on all models. Warning! For information on driving with a manual transmission, see “Manual transmission” (컄 page 51). For vehicles equipped with a manual transmission, getting out of your vehicle with the gearshift lever not engaged in first or reverse gear and the parking brake not engaged is dangerous. G Also, when parked on an incline, an engaged first or reverse gear alone may not prevent your vehicle from moving, possibly hitting people or objects. Warning! G When leaving the vehicle, always remove the SmartKey from the starter switch, take it with you, and lock the vehicle. Do not leave children unattended in the vehicle, or with access to an unlocked vehicle. Children could move the gearshift lever, which could result in an accident and/or serious personal injury. G Always set the parking brake in addition to engaging first or reverse gear (컄 page 59). Warning! When parked on an incline, turn front wheels towards the road curb. On slippery road surfaces, never downshift in order to obtain braking action. Do not park this vehicle in areas where combustible materials such as grass, hay or leaves can come into contact with the hot exhaust system, as these materials could be ignited and cause a vehicle fire. This could result in drive wheel slip and reduced vehicle control. Your vehicle’s ABS will not prevent this type of loss of control. 153 Controls in detail Manual transmission ! When you are shifting into the 5th or 6th Shifting into reverse gear, make sure that you press the gearshift lever to the right. Otherwise, you could accidentally shift into the 3rd or 4th gear and damage the transmission. ! Only shift into reverse gear R when the Downshifting gears leading to overrevving the engine can result in engine damage that is not covered by the Mercedes-Benz Limited Warranty. Gearshift pattern for manual transmission Never hold the vehicle stopped on a hill by using the clutch pedal. The clutch may be damaged which is not covered by the Mercedes-Benz Limited Warranty. Do not exceed the engine speed limits. Refer to tachometer (컄 page 119) for engine speeds. 154 vehicle is stationary, as the transmission could otherwise be damaged. 왘 Stop the vehicle completely. 왘 Fully depress the clutch pedal. 왘 Move the gearshift lever to the neutral position (no gear selected). 왘 Move the gearshift lever to the left until you feel a certain resistance. 왘 Push the gearshift lever past this resistance. 왘 Then move the gearshift lever forward into position R. Controls in detail Automatic transmission* 왔 Automatic transmission* For more information on driving with an automatic transmission, see “Automatic transmission*” (컄 page 52). Your vehicle’s transmission adapts its gear shifting process to your individual driving style by continually adjusting the shift points up or down. These shift point adjustments are performed based on current operating and driving conditions. If the operating conditions change, the automatic transmission reacts by adjusting its shift program. i During the brief warm-up, transmission upshifting is delayed. This allows the catalytic converter to heat up more quickly to operating temperature. Warning! G Make sure that absolutely no objects are obstructing the pedals’ range of movement. Keep the driver’s footwell clear of all obstacles. If there are any floormats or carpets in the footwell, make sure that the pedals still have sufficient clearance. Gear selector lever The gear selector lever is located on the lower part of the center console. During sudden driving or braking maneuvers the objects could get caught between the pedals. You could then no longer brake or accelerate. This could lead to accidents and injury. Gearshift pattern for automatic transmission P Park position R Reverse gear N Neutral D Drive position i The current gear selector lever position P, R, N or D appears in the multifunction display (컄 page 157). 155 Controls in detail Automatic transmission* Warning! G It is dangerous to shift the gear selector lever out of park position P or neutral position N if the engine speed is higher than idle speed. If your foot is not firmly on the brake pedal, the vehicle could accelerate quickly forward or reverse. You could lose control of the vehicle and hit someone or something. Only shift into gear when the engine is idling normally and when your right foot is firmly on the brake pedal. There are additional indicators on the cover of the shifting gate showing the current gear selector lever position. The indicators come on when you insert the SmartKey into the starter switch, and go out when you remove the SmartKey from the starter switch. 156 Shifting procedure The automatic transmission selects individual gears automatically, depending on: 앫 앫 gear selector lever position D (컄 page 157) with gear ranges (컄 page 160) the selected program mode: (C/S) (컄 page 161) or (M/C/S)* (컄 page 165) 앫 the position of the accelerator pedal (컄 page 159) 앫 the vehicle speed ! Allow engine to warm up under low load use. Do not place full load on the engine until the operating temperature has been reached. Shift into reverse gear R or park position P only when the vehicle is stopped. Avoid spinning of a drive wheel for an extended period when driving off on slippery road surfaces. This may cause serious damage to the drivetrain which is not covered by the Mercedes-Benz Limited Warranty. When the gear selector lever is in drive position D, you can influence transmission shifting by: 앫 limiting the gear range 앫 changing gears manually Controls in detail Automatic transmission* Gear selector lever positions The current gear selector lever position appears in the multifunction display. 1 Current gear selector lever position Effect ì Park position Gear selector lever position when the vehicle is parked. Place gear selector lever in park position P only when vehicle is stopped. The park position is not intended to serve as a brake when the vehicle is parked. Rather, the driver should always set the parking brake in addition to placing the gear selector lever in park position P to secure the vehicle. Effect The SmartKey can only be removed from the starter switch with the gear selector lever in park position P. With the SmartKey removed, the gear selector lever is locked in park position P. If the vehicle’s electrical system is malfunctioning, the gear selector lever could remain locked in park position P (컄 page 389). í Reverse gear Place gear selector lever in position R only when vehicle is stopped. 157 Controls in detail Automatic transmission* Effect ë Neutral No power is transmitted from the engine to the drive axle. When the brakes are released, the vehicle can be moved freely (pushed or towed). To avoid damage to the transmission, never engage neutral position N while driving. If the ESP® is deactivated or malfunctioning: Move gear selector lever to neutral position N only if the vehicle is in danger of skidding, e.g. on icy roads. ê Drive The transmission shifts automatically. All forward gears are available. 158 ! Coasting the vehicle, or driving for any other reason with gear selector lever in neutral position N can result in transmission damage that is not covered by the Mercedes-Benz Limited Warranty. Warning! G Getting out of your vehicle with the gear selector lever not fully engaged in park position P is dangerous. Also, park position P alone is not intended to or capable of preventing your vehicle from moving, possibly hitting people or objects. Always set the parking brake in addition to shifting to park position P (컄 page 59). When parked on an incline, turn the front wheels towards the road curb. Do not park this vehicle in areas where combustible materials such as grass, hay or leaves can come into contact with the hot exhaust system, as these materials could be ignited and cause a vehicle fire. Warning! G When leaving the vehicle, always remove the SmartKey from the starter switch, take it with you, and lock the vehicle. Do not leave children unattended in the vehicle, or with access to an unlocked vehicle. Children could move the gear selector lever from park position P, which could result in an accident and/or serious personal injury. Controls in detail Automatic transmission* Driving tips Stopping Maneuvering When you stop briefly, e.g. at traffic lights: When you maneuver in tight areas, e.g. when pulling into a parking space: Accelerator position 왘 Leave the transmission in gear. Your driving style influences the transmission’s shifting behavior: 왘 Hold the vehicle with the brake. Less throttle Earlier upshifting When you stop for a longer period of time with the engine idling and/or on a hill: More throttle Later upshifting Kickdown Use kickdown when you want maximum acceleration. 왘 Press the accelerator past the point of resistance. Depending on the engine speed the transmission shifts into a lower gear. 왘 왘 Set the parking brake. 왘 Move the gear selector lever to park position P. 왘 Control the vehicle speed by gradually releasing the brakes. 왘 Accelerate gently. 왘 Never abruptly step on the accelerator. Working on the vehicle Warning! G When working on the vehicle, set the parking brake and move gear selector lever to park position P. Otherwise the vehicle could roll away. Ease on the accelerator when you have reached the desired speed. The transmission shifts up again. 159 Controls in detail Automatic transmission* Gear ranges The selected gear range appears in the multifunction display. With the gear selector lever in drive position D and driving in program mode C or S, you can select a gear range for the automatic transmission to operate within. With this selection you can use the braking effect of the engine. ç The transmission shifts through second gear only. Allows the use of engine’s braking power when driving 1 Current gear range Effect ï The transmission shifts through sixth gear only. î The transmission shifts through fifth gear only. é The transmission shifts through fourth gear only. 160 è The transmission shifts through third gear only. Gear selector lever (컄 page 162): You can limit the gear range by pressing the gear selector lever to the left (D-), and reverse the gear range limit by pressing the gear selector lever to the right (D+). Steering wheel gearshift control* (컄 page 163): You can limit the gear range by pulling the left gearshift paddle on the steering wheel gearshift control, and reverse the gear range limit by pulling the right gearshift paddle on the steering wheel gearshift control. Effect 앫 on steep downgrades 앫 in mountainous regions 앫 under extreme operating conditions æ The transmission operates in first gear only. For maximum use of engine’s braking effect on very steep or lengthy downgrades. Controls in detail Automatic transmission* Automatic shift program The selected program mode appears in the multifunction display. The program mode selector switch is located on the lower part of the center console. Program mode selector switch on vehicles with AMG-Sport Package* and SLK 55 AMG only M Manual Program mode selector switch C Comfort For comfort driving S Sport For standard driving For manual gear shifting (컄 page 165) C Comfort For comfort driving S Sport For standard driving 1 Current program mode ! Never change the program mode when the gear selector lever is out of park position P. This could result in a change of driving characteristics for which you may not be prepared. i The last selected program mode (C or S) is switched on when the engine is restarted. 161 Controls in detail Automatic transmission* 왘 Press program mode selector switch repeatedly until the letter of the desired program mode appears in the multifunction display. Select C for comfort driving: 앫 The vehicle starts out in second gear (both forward and reverse) for gentler starts. This does not apply if full throttle is applied or gear range 1 is selected. 앫 Traction and driving stability are improved on icy roads. 앫 Upshifts occur earlier even when you give more gas. The engine then operates at lower rpms and the wheels are less likely to spin. Select S for standard driving: 앫 The vehicle starts out in first gear. 앫 Upshifts occur later. Gear selector lever one-touch gearshifting With the gear selector lever in drive position D and driving in program mode C or S, you can limit or extend the gear range. If your vehicle is equipped with manual shift program M, you can use the gear selector lever to manually shift the gears. i For information on using the gear selector lever in program mode M, see “Manual shift program*” (컄 page 165). ! Allow engine to warm up under low load use. Do not place full load on the engine until the operating temperature has been reached. Shift into reverse gear R or park position P only when the vehicle is stopped. Avoid spinning of a drive wheel for an extended period when driving off on slippery road surfaces. This may cause serious damage to the drivetrain which is not covered by the Mercedes-Benz Limited Warranty. The following instructions describe operation of the gear selector lever when driving in the automatic program mode C or S. 162 Limiting gear range Warning! G On slippery road surfaces, never downshift in order to obtain braking action. This could result in drive wheel slip and reduced vehicle control. Your vehicle’s ABS will not prevent this type of loss of control. 왘 Briefly press the gear selector lever to the left in the D- direction. The transmission will shift to the next lower gear as permitted by the shift program. This action simultaneously limits the gear range of the transmission (컄 page 160). i To avoid overrevving the engine when downshifting, the transmission will not shift to a lower gear if the engine’s max. speed would be exceeded. Controls in detail Automatic transmission* Extending gear range Canceling gear range limit 왘 왘 Briefly press the gear selector lever to the right in the D+ direction. The transmission will shift to the next higher gear as permitted by the shift program. This action simultaneously extends the gear range of the transmission. i If you press on the accelerator when the engine has reached its rpm limit, the transmission will upshift beyond any gear range limit selected. Press and hold the gear selector lever in the D+ direction until D reappears in the multifunction display (컄 page 157). The transmission will shift from the current gear range directly to gear range D. Shifting into optimal gear range 왘 Press and hold the gear selector lever in the D- direction. The transmission will automatically select the gear range suited for optimal acceleration and deceleration. This will involve shifting down one or more gears. Steering wheel gearshift control one-touch gearshifting* With the gear selector lever in drive position D and driving in program mode C or S, you can limit or extend the gear range. If your vehicle is equipped with manual shift program M, you can use the steering wheel gearshift control to manually shift the gears. i For information on using the steering wheel gearshift control in program mode M, see “Manual shift program*” (컄 page 165). ! Allow engine to warm up under low load use. Do not place full load on the engine until the operating temperature has been reached. Shift into reverse gear R or park position P only when the vehicle is stopped. Avoid spinning of a drive wheel for an extended period when driving off on slippery road surfaces. This may cause serious damage to the drivetrain which is not covered by the Mercedes-Benz Limited Warranty. 163 Controls in detail Automatic transmission* Limiting gear range Warning! Extending gear range G On slippery road surfaces, never downshift in order to obtain braking action. This could result in drive wheel slip and reduced vehicle control. Your vehicle’s ABS will not prevent this type of loss of control. Gearshift paddles (example illustration vehicles with AMG-Sport Package*) 1 Left shift paddle: limiting gear range or downshift (in program mode M) 2 Right shift paddle: extending gear range or upshift (in program mode M) i You cannot shift with the steering wheel gearshift paddles when the gear selector lever is in position P, N or R. The following instructions describe operation of the steering wheel gearshift control when driving in the automatic program mode C or S. 164 왘 Briefly pull left shift paddle 1. The transmission will shift to the next lower gear as permitted by the shift program. This action simultaneously limits the gear range of the transmission (컄 page 160). i To avoid overrevving the engine when downshifting, the transmission will not shift to a lower gear if the engine’s max. speed would be exceeded. 왘 Briefly pull right shift paddle 2. The transmission will shift to the next higher gear as permitted by the shift program. This action simultaneously extends the gear range of the transmission. i If you press on the accelerator when the engine has reached its rpm limit, the transmission will upshift beyond any gear range limit selected. Controls in detail Automatic transmission* Canceling gear range limit 왘 Pull and hold right shift paddle 2 until D reappears in the multifunction display (컄 page 157). The transmission will shift from the current gear range directly to gear range D. Shifting into optimal gear range 왘 Pull and hold left shift paddle 1. The transmission will automatically select the gear range suited for optimal acceleration and deceleration. This will involve shifting down one or more gears. Manual shift program* Manual shift program is available on vehicles with AMG-Sport Package* and SLK 55 AMG only. The program mode selector switch is located on the lower part of the center console. In addition to the automatic shift program C or S, your vehicle is equipped with the manual shift program M. In the manual program mode M, system-controlled automatic gearshifting is switched off and you need to change the gears by manually upshifting or downshifting using the steering wheel gearshift paddles (컄 page 164) or the gear selector lever. ! Allow engine to warm up under low load use. Do not place full load on the engine until the operating temperature has been reached. Shift into reverse gear R or park position P only when the vehicle is stopped. Avoid spinning of a drive wheel for an extended period when driving off on slippery road surfaces. This may cause serious damage to the drivetrain which is not covered by the Mercedes-Benz Limited Warranty. Program mode selector switch M Manual For manual gear shifting C Comfort For comfort driving S Sport For standard driving The selected program mode appears in the multifunction display (컄 page 161). i For information on automatic program modes C or S, see “Automatic shift program” (컄 page 161), “Gear selector lever one-touch gearshifting” (컄 page 162), and “Steering wheel gearshift control one-touch gearshifting*” (컄 page 163). 165 Controls in detail Automatic transmission* Activating manual shift program Upshifting 왘 ! In the manual program mode M, the trans- Press program mode selector switch repeatedly until the M for manual program mode M appears in the multifunction display. The transmission switches to the manual program mode M. Automatic shifting is switched off. The gear range is not limited. You can change the gears manually when the gear selector lever is in drive position D. You can upshift or downshift through the gears in succession. i The manual program mode M will not be stored. When the engine is turned off with the manual program mode M selected, the transmission will go to the automatic program mode (C or S) when the engine is restarted. 166 mission will not upshift, even if the engine has reached its overrevving range. Shift up to the next gear before the engine has reached its overrevving range. Make absolutely certain that the engine speed does not reach the red marking on the tachometer (컄 page 26). Otherwise the engine could be damaged which is not covered by the Mercedes-Benz Limited Warranty. 왘 If you have selected the AMG menu in the control system and you are driving in the manual program mode M, upshift indicator 2 in the multifunction display advises you to upshift before the engine reaches the overspeed range. Thus you can drive at the maximum engine speed for each gear without overrevving the engine. Briefly press the gear selector lever to the right in the D+ direction. or 왘 Briefly pull right shift paddle 2 (컄 page 164). The transmission shifts to the next higher gear. If, instead of the manual program mode symbol M, the p symbol appears in the multifunction display (컄 page 161), shift to the next higher gear. The fuel supply will otherwise be interrupted to prevent the engine from overrevving. 1 Gear indicator 2 Upshift indicator 왘 Shift to the next higher gear. The fuel supply will otherwise be interrupted to prevent the engine from overrevving. Controls in detail Automatic transmission* Kickdown Downshifting Warning! G On slippery road surfaces, never downshift in order to obtain braking action. This could result in drive wheel slip and reduced vehicle control. Your vehicle’s ABS will not prevent this type of loss of control. 왘 Briefly press the gear selector lever to the left in the D- direction. or 왘 Briefly pull left shift paddle 1 (컄 page 164). The transmission shifts to the next lower gear. Using the kickdown when driving in the manual program mode M is not possible. Deactivating manual shift program 왘 Press the program mode selector switch (컄 page 165) repeatedly until C or S appears in the multifunction display. or 왘 Emergency operation (Limp-Home Mode) If vehicle acceleration becomes less responsive or sluggish or the transmission no longer shifts, the transmission is most likely operating in limp-home (emergency operation) mode. In this mode only second gear and reverse gear can be selected. 왘 Stop the vehicle in a safe location. 왘 Move the gear selector lever to park position P. 왘 Turn off the engine. 왘 Wait at least 10 seconds before restarting. 왘 Restart the engine. 왘 Move the gear selector lever to position D (for second gear) or position R. 왘 Have the transmission checked at an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center as soon as possible. Restart the engine. The transmission will go to the automatic program mode (C or S). The manual program mode M is not stored. i When you brake or stop, the transmission shifts down to a gear from which you can easily accelerate or take off. 167 Controls in detail Good visibility For information on the windshield wipers, see “Windshield wipers” (컄 page 56). Headlamp cleaning system* The button is located on the left side of the dashboard. i The headlamps will automatically be Rear view mirrors cleaned when you have 앫 switched on the headlamps and 앫 operated the windshield wipers with windshield washer fluid fifteen times For more information on setting the rear view mirrors, see “Mirrors” (컄 page 46). Interior rear view mirror, antiglare position When you switch off the ignition, the counter resets. For information on filling up the washer reservoir, see “Windshield washer system and headlamp cleaning system*” (컄 page 302). 1 Headlamp cleaning button 왘 Switch on the ignition (컄 page 37). 왘 Press button 1. The headlamps are cleaned with a high-pressure water jet. 168 왘 Tilt the mirror to the antiglare night position by moving the lever towards the windshield. The interior rear view mirror is dimmed. Controls in detail Good visibility Auto-dimming rear view mirrors* The reflection brightness of the exterior rear view mirrors and the interior rear view mirror will respond automatically to glare when 앫 ignition is switched on and 앫 incoming light from headlamps falls on the sensor in the interior rear view mirror The rear view mirrors will not react if 앫 reverse gear R is engaged 앫 interior lighting is switched on Warning! G The auto-dimming function does not react if incoming light is not aimed directly at sensors in the interior rear view mirror. The interior rear view mirror and the exterior rear view mirror on the driver’s side do not react, for example, if the wind screen* is installed. Warning! G Exercise care when using the passenger-side exterior rear view mirror. The mirror surface is convex (outwardly curved surface for a wider field of view). Objects in mirror are closer than they appear. Check your interior rear view mirror or glance over your shoulder before changing lanes. Light hitting the mirror(s) at certain angles (incident light) could blind you. As a result, you may not be able to observe traffic conditions and could cause an accident. 169 Controls in detail Good visibility Sun visors Warning! The sun visors protect you from sun glare while driving. G Do not use the vanity mirror while driving. Keep the mirrors in the sun visors closed while vehicle is in motion. Reflected glare can endanger you and others. 1 Mirror lamp* 2 Mounting 3 Mirror cover 4 Sun visor 왘 Swing sun visors down when you experience glare. 왘 To use mirror and switch on mirror lamp*, lift up mirror cover 3. i Vehicles with interior lighting package*: If sunlight enters through a side window, disengage sun visor from mounting 2 and pivot it to the side. You then can slide the sun visor along the pivot arm to a different position if so desired. Mirror lamp* 1 will switch off as soon as sun visor is disengaged from mounting 2. ! Vehicles with interior lighting package*: Close mirror cover 3 if open before you disengage the sun visor 4 from mounting 2 and pivot it to the side. 170 Rear window defroster The rear window defroster uses a large amount of power. To keep the battery drain to a minimum, switch off the defroster as soon as the rear window is clear. The defroster is automatically deactivated after approximately 6 to 17 minutes of operation depending on the outside temperature. Warning! G Any accumulation of snow and ice should be removed from the rear window before driving. Visibility could otherwise be impaired, endangering you and others. Controls in detail Good visibility Switching on Switching off 왘 왘 Press the rear window defroster switch F in the control panel of the climate control (컄 page 174) or the automatic climate control* (컄 page 184). The indicator lamp on the rear window defroster switch F comes on. ! The rear window defroster cannot be switched on when the retractable hardtop is open. The indicator lamp starts flashing if the hardtop is open. 앫 Close the retractable hardtop first. The rear window defroster can be switched on again. Press the rear window defroster switch F again in the control panel of the climate control or the automatic climate control*. The indicator lamp on the rear window defroster switch F goes out. ! If the rear window defroster switches off too soon and the indicator lamp starts flashing, this means that too many electrical consumers are operating simultaneously and there is insufficient voltage in the battery. The system responds automatically by deactivating the rear window defroster. As soon as the battery has sufficient voltage, the rear window defroster automatically turns itself back on. 171 Controls in detail Climate control 172 Controls in detail Climate control Item Item 1 Right center air vent, adjustable 8 Left center air vent, fixed 2 Thumbwheel for air volume control for fixed/adjustable right center air vents 9 Thumbwheel for air volume control for fixed/adjustable left center air vents 3 Right center air vent, fixed a Left center air vent, adjustable 4 Right side defroster air vent, fixed b Thumbwheel for air volume control for adjustable left side air vent 5 Right side air vent, adjustable 6 Thumbwheel for air volume control for adjustable right side air vent 7 Climate control panel c Left side air vent, adjustable d Left side defroster air vent, fixed i For draft-free ventilation, move the sliders for center air vents and side air vents to the middle position. 173 Controls in detail Climate control The climate control is operational whenever the engine is running. The system cools or heats the interior depending on the selected interior temperature and the current outside temperature. Warning! Climate control panel Item 1 Temperature control, left side 2 Air volume control, climate control on/off 3 Air distribution control 4 Temperature control, right side 5 Rear window defroster (컄 page 170) 6 Front defroster 7 AC cooling on/off, Residual heat/ventilation 8 Air recirculation 174 G When operating the climate control, the air that enters the passenger compartment through the air vents can be very hot or very cold (depending on the set temperature). This may cause burns or frostbite to unprotected skin in the immediate area of the air vents. Always keep sufficient distance between unprotected parts of the body and the air vents. If necessary, use the air distribution controls (컄 page 174) to direct the air to air vents in the vehicle interior that are not in the immediate area of unprotected skin. Nearly all dust particles, pollutants and odors are filtered out before outside air enters the interior through the air distribution system. The air conditioning will not engage (no cooling) if the A/C mode is deactivated (컄 page 174). Warning! G Follow the recommended settings for heating and cooling given on the following pages. Otherwise the windows could fog up, impairing visibility and endangering you and others. Controls in detail Climate control i Severe conditions (e.g. strong air pollution) may require replacement of the filter before its scheduled interval. A clogged filter will reduce the air volume to the interior. If the vehicle interior is hot, ventilate the interior before driving off. The climate control will then adjust the interior temperature to the set value much faster. Keep the air intake grille in front of the windshield free of snow and debris. When the retractable hardtop is closed, do not obstruct air flow by placing objects on the air flow-through exhaust slots below the rear window. Switching climate control system on/off Warning! G When the climate control is switched off, the outside air supply and circulation are also switched off. Only choose this setting for a short time. Otherwise the windows could fog up, impairing visibility and endangering you and others. Setting the temperature Use temperature controls 1 and 4 (컄 page 174) to separately adjust the air temperature on each side of the passenger compartment. You should raise or lower the temperature setting in small increments, preferably starting at 72°F (22°C). The climate control will adjust to the set temperature as fast as possible. Increasing 왘 Switching off 왘 Set air volume control 2 (컄 page 174) to position 0. Switching on 왘 Switch on the ignition (컄 page 37). 왘 Set air volume control 2 to any speed (컄 page 174). Turn temperature control 1 and/or 4 (컄 page 174) slightly clockwise. The climate control system will correspondingly adjust the interior air temperature. The previous settings are once again in effect. 175 Controls in detail Climate control Decreasing Symbol Function Opening the center air vents 왘 a Directs air through the center and side air vents 왘 Z Directs air to the windshield and through the side air vents b Directs air into the entire vehicle interior Y Directs air to the footwells and through the side air vents Turn temperature control 1 and/or 4 (컄 page 174) slightly counterclockwise. The climate control system will correspondingly adjust the interior air temperature. Adjusting air distribution Use air distribution control 3 (컄 page 174) to adjust the air distribution. The following symbols are found on the control: 왘 Turn the air distribution control to the desired symbol (컄 page 174). The climate control system will correspondingly adjust the interior air distribution. i You can also turn the control to a position between two symbols. Turn thumbwheels 2 and 9 (컄 page 172) upward to the first stop. Center air vents 1, 3, 8 and a are open. 왘 Turn thumbwheels 2 and 9 (컄 page 172) upward all the way. Only center air vents 1 and a are open. Closing the center air vents 왘 Turn thumbwheels 2 and 9 (컄 page 172) downward all the way. Center air vents 1, 3, 8 and a are closed. Opening and closing side air vents 왘 Turn thumbwheels 6 and b (컄 page 172) in the required direction. Side air vents 5 and c are open or closed. 176 Controls in detail Climate control Adjusting air volume Ten blower speeds are available. 왘 Use air volume control 2 (컄 page 174) to adjust the air volume. Heating (summer) Activating 왘 왘 왘 Turn air volume control 2 (컄 page 174) to level 1 or higher. 왘 Turn air distribution control 3 (컄 page 174) to position a. 왘 Open the center and side air vents. Basic settings Heating (winter) 왘 Turn temperature controls 1 and 4 (컄 page 174) to the desired position. 왘 Turn air volume control 2 (컄 page 174) to level 2 or higher. Otherwise the windows may fog over. 왘 Turn air distribution control 3 (컄 page 174) to a position between b and Y. 왘 Open the side air vents if necessary. 왘 Close the center air vents. Turn air temperature control 1 and 4 (컄 page 174) to the desired position. Press button P (컄 page 174). The indicator lamp on the button comes on. The air conditioning switches automatically to the following functions: 앫 cooling on to dehumidify 앫 maximum blowing and heating power 앫 air flows onto the windshield and the front side windows Front defroster You can use this setting to defrost the windshield, for example if it is iced up. You can also defog the windshield and the side windows. i When you have activated the front defroster using button P, no other settings are possible. i Keep this setting selected only until the windshield or the side windows are clear again. 177 Controls in detail Climate control Deactivating 왘 Press button P (컄 page 174) again. The indicator lamp on the button goes out. The previous settings are once again in effect. Air recirculation mode i The air recirculation mode is activated automatically at high outside temperatures. Switch to air recirculation mode to prevent unpleasant odors from entering the vehicle from the outside (e.g. before driving through a tunnel). This setting cuts off the intake of outside air and recirculates the air in the interior. The indicator lamp on button , is not lit when the air recirculation mode is automatically switched on. i The cooling remains switched on. Windshield fogged on the outside 왘 Switch the windshield wipers on (컄 page 56). 왘 Turn air distribution control 3 to position a or Y (컄 page 174). Deactivating Warning! G Fogged windows impair visibility, endangering you and others. If the windows begin to fog on the inside, switching off the air recirculation mode immediately should clear interior window fogging. If interior window fogging persists, make sure the air conditioning (컄 page 180) is activated, or press button P. Activating 왘 Briefly press button , (컄 page 174). The indicator lamp on the button comes on. 178 A quantity of outside air is added after approximately 30 minutes. 왘 Press button , (컄 page 174) again. The indicator lamp on the button goes out. i The air recirculation mode is deactivated automatically: 앫 after 5 minutes if the outside temperature is below approximately 41°F (5°C) 앫 after 5 minutes if the air conditioning is turned off 앫 after 30 minutes if the outside temperature is above approximately 41°F (5°C) Controls in detail Climate control Air recirculation mode with convenience closing or opening feature Warning! G Never operate the side windows if there is the possibility of anyone being harmed by the closing procedure. When using the air recirculation mode with convenience closing feature, should the upward movement of a window be blocked by some obstruction including but not limited to arms, hands, fingers, etc., the automatic reversal feature will not operate. In the event that the closing procedure causes potential danger, the closing of the door windows can be immediately halted by releasing the , button or by pressing the respective power window switch. Convenience closing Convenience opening 왘 왘 Press and hold button , until the windows are closed or have reached the desired position. Press and hold button , until the windows are opened or have reached the desired position. The indicator lamp on the button comes on. The air recirculation mode is activated. The indicator lamp on the button goes out. The air recirculation mode is deactivated. i The closing of the windows can be immedi- i The opening of the windows can be immedi- ately halted by releasing button ,. ately halted by releasing button ,. A window will only return to its previous position if it has not been moved to another position using the respective window switch after it was closed with button ,. A window that has been moved will remain in its current position if button , is used to reopen the remaining windows. The closing of the rear side windows can be immediately halted by releasing the , button. 179 Controls in detail Climate control Air conditioning The cooling function, only operational when the engine is running, cools the vehicle interior down to the selected temperature. The cooling function also dehumidifies the air in the vehicle interior, thus preventing the windows from fogging up. Warning! G If you turn off the cooling function, the interior air is not dried. The windows can fog up more quickly. Window fogging may impair visibility and endanger you and others. Deactivating Maximum cooling It is possible to deactivate the air conditioning (cooling) function of the climate control system. The air in the vehicle will then no longer be cooled or dehumidified. 왘 왘 vehicle. This is normal and not an indication of a malfunction. 180 왘 For draft-free ventilation, move the sliders for the center air vents 1 and a (컄 page 172) to the middle position. 왘 Turn thumbwheels 6 and b (컄 page 172) for the adjustable side air vents 5 and c (컄 page 172) to the fully open position. 왘 Set air distribution control 3 (컄 page 176) to position a. Activating Moist air can fog up the windows. You can dehumidify the air with the air conditioning. 왘 i Condensation may drip from underneath the The fixed center air vents 3 and 8 (컄 page 172) and the adjustable air vents 1 and a (컄 page 172) are open. Press button 9 (컄 page 174). The indicator lamp on the button goes out. The cooling function switches off after a short delay. Press button 9 (컄 page 174) again. The indicator lamp on the button comes on. The air conditioning uses the refrigerant R134a. This refrigerant is free of CFCs which are harmful to the ozone layer. Turn thumbwheels 2 and 9 (컄 page 172) upwards to the first stop. The air distribution directs the air through the center and side air vents. Controls in detail Climate control 왘 Set air volume control 2 (컄 page 177) to position 5. The ventilation operates with maximum blower speed. 왘 Turn temperature controls 1 and 4 (컄 page 174) completely counterclockwise to their end stops. The lowest temperature for both sides is set. i When the vehicle’s interior has cooled down enough, reduce the air volume and increase the air temperature to comfortable settings if desired. Residual engine heat utilization With the engine switched off, it is possible to continue to heat or ventilate the interior for up to 30 minutes. This feature makes use of the residual heat produced by the engine. Deactivating 왘 Press button 9 (컄 page 174) again. The indicator lamp on the button goes out. i The residual heat is automatically turned off 앫 when the ignition is switched on (컄 page 37) Activating 앫 after about 30 minutes 왘 Switch off the ignition (컄 page 37). 앫 if the battery voltage drops 왘 Press button 9 (컄 page 174). The indicator lamp on the button comes on. i How long the system will provide heating depends on 앫 the coolant temperature 앫 the temperature set by the operator The blower will run at speed setting 1 regardless of the air distribution control setting. 181 Controls in detail Automatic climate control* 182 Controls in detail Automatic climate control* Item Item 1 Cockpit air vent 9 Automatic climate control panel 2 Thumbwheel for air volume control for cockpit air vent a Left center air vent, fixed 3 Right center air vent, adjustable 4 Thumbwheel for air volume control for fixed/adjustable right center air vents b Thumbwheel for air volume control for fixed/adjustable left center air vents c Left center air vent, adjustable 5 Right center air vent, fixed d Thumbwheel for air volume control for adjustable left side air vent 6 Right side defroster air vent, fixed e Left side air vent, adjustable 7 Right side air vent, adjustable f Left side defroster air vent, fixed 8 Thumbwheel for air volume control for adjustable right side air vent i For draft-free ventilation, move the sliders for center air vents and side air vents to the middle position. 183 Controls in detail Automatic climate control* Item 1 Air volume control, manual 2 Air distribution and air volume (automatic mode) 3 Front defroster 4 Temperature control, left, raising 5 Automatic climate control on/off (complete system) 6 Temperature control, right, raising 7 Rear window defroster 8 Air distribution control, manual 9 Residual heat/ventilation a AC cooling on/off b Temperature control, right, lowering c Temperature control, left, lowering d Air recirculation e Display 184 The automatic climate control is operational whenever the engine is running. You can operate the automatic climate control system in either the automatic or manual mode. The system cools or heats the interior depending on the selected interior temperature and the current outside temperature. Warning! G When operating the automatic climate control, the air that enters the passenger compartment through the air vents can be very hot or very cold (depending on the set temperature). This may cause burns or frostbite on unprotected skin in the immediate area of the air vents. Always keep sufficient distance between unprotected parts of the body and the air vents. If necessary, use the air distribution controls (컄 page 184) to direct the air to air vents in the vehicle interior that are not in the immediate area of unprotected skin. Controls in detail Automatic climate control* Nearly all dust particles, pollutants and odors are filtered out before outside air enters the interior through the air distribution system. The air conditioning will not engage (no cooling) if the A/C mode is deactivated (컄 page 184). Warning! G Follow the recommended settings for heating and cooling given on the following pages. Otherwise the windows could fog up, impairing visibility and endangering you and others. i Severe conditions (e.g. strong air pollution) may require replacement of the filter before its scheduled interval. A clogged filter will reduce the air volume to the interior. If the vehicle interior is hot, ventilate the interior before driving off. The automatic climate control will then adjust the interior temperature to the set value much faster. Keep the air intake grille in front of the windshield free of snow and debris. When the retractable hardtop is closed, do not obstruct air flow by placing objects on the air flow-through exhaust slots below the rear window. Deactivating the climate control system Warning! G When the automatic climate control is switched off, the outside air supply and circulation are also switched off. Only choose this setting for a short time. Otherwise the windows could fog up, impairing visibility and endangering you and others. Deactivating 왘 Press button ´ (컄 page 184). The indicator lamp on the button comes on. 185 Controls in detail Automatic climate control* Reactivating Activating 왘 Switch on the ignition (컄 page 37). 왘 왘 Press button ´ (컄 page 184) again. The indicator lamp on the button comes on. The air volume and air distribution are adjusted automatically. The previous settings are once again in effect. or 왘 Press button U (컄 page 184). Press button U (컄 page 184) while the engine is running. 왘 The indicator lamp on the button comes on. Air volume and air distribution are adjusted automatically. Use temperature controls 4 and 6 or b and c (컄 page 184) to separately adjust the air temperature on each side of the passenger compartment. The temperature of the vehicle interior is adjusted automatically. Operating the climate control system in automatic mode Deactivating i When operating the automatic climate control system in automatic mode, you will only rarely need to adjust the temperature, air volume and air distribution. In automatic mode, cooling with dehumidify is switched on. This function can be switched off if necessary. 186 왘 Press button U (컄 page 184) again. The indicator lamp on the button goes out. The air volume changes to level 2 and the air distribution changes to b. Automatic control of air volume and air distribution is switched off. Setting the temperature Use temperature controls 4 and c for the driver’s side or 6 and b for the passenger side (컄 page 184) to separately adjust the air temperature on each side of the passenger compartment. You should raise or lower the temperature setting in small increments, preferably starting at 72°F (22°C). The automatic climate control will adjust to the set temperature as fast as possible. Controls in detail Automatic climate control* Increasing 왘 Press temperature button(s) 4 and/or 6 (컄 page 184) until the desired temperature appears in the control panel display e (컄 page 184). The automatic climate control system will correspondingly adjust the interior air temperature. Decreasing 왘 Press temperature button(s) b and/or c (컄 page 184) until the desired temperature appears in the control panel display e (컄 page 184). The automatic climate control system will correspondingly adjust the interior air temperature. Adjusting air distribution 왘 Use air distribution control 8 (컄 page 184) to adjust the air distribution. The following symbols are found on the control: Symbol Function a Directs air through the center and side air vents Z Directs air to the windshield and through the side air vents b Y Directs air into the entire vehicle interior Turn air distribution control 8 (컄 page 184) to the desired position. The indicator lamp on the button U (컄 page 184) goes out. The automatic air distribution is switched off. The air distribution is controlled according to the selected control setting. i You can also turn the control to a position between two symbols. Opening the cockpit air vent and center air vents 왘 Directs air to the footwells and through the side air vents Turn thumbwheels 4 and b (컄 page 182) to the first stop and turn thumbwheel 2 (컄 page 182) upward all the way. The cockpit air vent 1 and the center air vents 3 , 5, a and c are open. 왘 Turn thumbwheels 4 and b (컄 page 182) upward all the way. Only center air vents 3 and c are open. 187 Controls in detail Automatic climate control* Closing the cockpit air vent and center air vents 왘 Turn thumbwheels 2, 4 and b (컄 page 182) downward. The cockpit air vent and the center air vents are closed. Opening and closing side air vents 왘 Turn thumbwheels 8 and d (컄 page 182) in the corresponding direction. Side air vents 7 and e are open or closed. Adjusting air volume Front defroster Use button U (컄 page 184) for automatic mode or air volume control 1 (컄 page 184) to adjust air volume manually. You can use this setting to defrost the windshield, for example if it is iced up. You can also defog the windshield and the side windows. Eleven blower speeds are available. i Keep this setting selected only until the windshield or the side windows are clear again. 왘 Turn air volume control 1 (컄 page 184) to the desired position. The indicator lamp on button U (컄 page 184) goes out. The automatic operation of air volume switches off. Activating 왘 Press button P (컄 page 184). The indicator lamp on the button comes on. The air conditioning switches automatically to the following functions: 앫 cooling on to dehumidify 앫 maximum blowing and heating power 앫 air flows onto the windshield and the front side windows i When you have activated the front defroster using button P, no other settings are possible. 188 Controls in detail Automatic climate control* Deactivating 왘 Press button P (컄 page 184) again. The indicator lamp on the button goes out. The previous settings are once again in effect. i The cooling remains switched on. Windows fogged on the outside i Keep this setting selected only until the windshield is clear again. 왘 Switch the windshield wipers on (컄 page 56). 왘 Press button U (컄 page 184). The indicator lamp on the button comes on. Air distribution and air volume are adjusted automatically. Maximum cooling MAX COOL Air recirculation mode When operating the automatic climate control system in automatic mode U and there is a high need for cooling, MAX COOL is activated. This provides the fastest possible cooling of the vehicle’s interior (when retractable hardtop is closed). Switch to air recirculation mode to prevent unpleasant odors from entering the vehicle from the outside (e.g. before driving through a tunnel). This setting cuts off the intake of outside air and recirculates the air in the interior. MAX COOL will appear in display e (컄 page 184). Warning! G Fogged windows impair visibility, endangering you and others. If the windows begin to fog on the inside, switching off the air recirculation mode immediately should clear interior window fogging. If interior window fogging persists, make sure the air conditioning (컄 page 180) is activated, or press button P. If the automatic air distribution and air volume are switched off: 왘 Turn air distribution control 8 to position a or Y (컄 page 184). 189 Controls in detail Automatic climate control* Activating Deactivating 왘 왘 Press button , (컄 page 184). The indicator lamp on the button comes on. Press button , (컄 page 184) again. The indicator lamp on the button goes out. i The air recirculation mode activates auto- i The air recirculation mode is deactivated matically at high outside temperatures. automatically: The indicator lamp on button , is not lit when the air recirculation mode is automatically switched on. 앫 after 5 minutes if the outside temperature is below approximately 41°F (5°C) 앫 after 5 minutes if the air conditioning is turned off (컄 page 191) 앫 after 30 minutes if the outside temperature is above approximately 41°F (5°C) A quantity of outside air is added after approximately 30 minutes. Air recirculation mode with convenience closing or opening feature Warning! G Never operate the side windows if there is the possibility of anyone being harmed by the closing procedure. When using the air recirculation mode with convenience closing feature, should the upward movement of a window be blocked by some obstruction including but not limited to arms, hands, fingers, etc., the automatic reversal feature will not operate. In the event that the closing procedure causes potential danger, the closing of the door windows can be immediately halted by releasing the , button or by pressing the respective power window switch. The closing of the rear side windows can be immediately halted by releasing the , button. 190 Controls in detail Automatic climate control* Convenience closing Convenience opening 왘 왘 Press and hold button , until the windows are closed or have reached the desired position. The indicator lamp on the button comes on. The air recirculation mode is activated. i The closing of the windows can be immediately halted by releasing button ,. Press and hold button , until the windows are opened or have reached the desired position. The indicator lamp on the button goes out. The air recirculation mode is deactivated. i The opening of the windows can be immediately halted by releasing button ,. A window will only return to its previous position if it has not been moved to another position using the respective window switch after it was closed with button ,. A window that has been moved will remain in its current position if button , is used to reopen the remaining windows. Air conditioning The cooling function, only operational when the engine is running, cools the vehicle interior down to the selected temperature. The cooling function also dehumidifies the air in the vehicle interior, thus preventing the windows from fogging up. The air conditioning uses the refrigerant R134a. This refrigerant is free of CFCs which are harmful to the ozone layer. Warning! G If you turn off the cooling function, the vehicle will not be cooled when weather conditions are warm. The windows can fog up more quickly. Window fogging may impair visibility and endanger you and others. i Condensation may drip from underneath the vehicle. This is normal and not an indication of a malfunction. 191 Controls in detail Automatic climate control* Deactivating It is possible to deactivate the air conditioning (cooling) function of the automatic climate control system. The air in the vehicle will then no longer be cooled or dehumidified. 왘 Press button œ (컄 page 184). The indicator lamp on the button goes out. Activating Moist air can fog up the windows. You can dehumidify the air with the air conditioning. 왘 Press button œ (컄 page 184). The indicator lamp on the button comes on. 192 Residual heat and ventilation With the engine switched off, it is possible to continue to heat or ventilate the interior for up to 30 minutes. This feature makes use of the residual heat produced by the engine. Activating 왘 Switch off the ignition (컄 page 37). 왘 Press button T (컄 page 184). The indicator lamp on the button comes on. The display in the automatic climate control panel remains switched off. i How long the system will provide heating depends on 앫 the coolant temperature Deactivating 앫 the temperature set by the operator 왘 The blower will run at speed setting 1 regardless of the air volume control setting. Press button T (컄 page 184) again. The indicator lamp on the button goes out. i The residual heat is automatically turned off: 앫 when the ignition is switched on (컄 page 37) 앫 after about 30 minutes 앫 if the battery voltage drops Controls in detail Audio system 왔 Audio system Audio and telephone*, operation Warning! These instructions are intended to help you become familiar with your Mercedes-Benz audio system. They contain useful tips and a detailed description of the user functions. G In order to avoid distraction which could lead to an accident, the driver should enter system settings with the vehicle at a standstill and operate the system only when road and traffic conditions permit. Always pay full attention to traffic conditions first before operating system controls while driving. Bear in mind that at a speed of just 30 mph (approximately 50 km/h), your vehicle is covering a distance of 44 feet (approximately 14 m) every second. Operating safety Warning! G Any alterations made to electronic components can cause malfunctions. The radio, amplifier, CD changer*, satellite radio* and telephone* are interconnected. When one of the components is not operational or has not been removed/replaced properly, the function of other components may be impaired. This condition might seriously impair the operating safety of your vehicle. We recommend that you have any service work on electronic components carried out by an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. 193 Controls in detail Audio system Operating and display elements 194 Controls in detail Audio system Item Page 1 CD changer mode selector 208 2 Single CD mode selector 212 Item Page 9 Speed dialing memory (telephone*) in descending order Item Page g Soft keys 196 h Volume 196 a Accepting a call (telephone*) 224 j Switching on/off 196 b Telephone* mode selector 219 k Manual tuning / seek tuning (radio) 201 c Speed dialing memory (telephone*) in ascending order 221 225 7 Display d Terminating a call (telephone*) 8 Alphanumeric keypad e CD slot 3 Radio mode selector 4 Mute function (radio) Pause (CD) 202 218 5 Volume distribution 198 6 Sound settings 197 f CD ejection Track search, reverse (CD) 217 l Manual tuning / seek tuning (radio) 201 Track search, fast forward (CD) 217 212 195 Controls in detail Audio system Button and soft key operation In these instructions, the alphanumeric keypad (right side of radio panel) and the function buttons (left side of radio panel) are referred to as “buttons”. The four keys below the display panel are referred to as “soft keys”. ! Do not press directly in the display face. Otherwise, the display will be damaged. Operation 왘 Switching the unit on/off Switching on 왘 Turn the SmartKey in the starter switch to position 1 or 2 (컄 page 37). 왘 If the audio system was on as you removed the SmartKey from the starter switch, the audio system will automatically come back on as you turn the SmartKey to position 1 or 2. 왘 Remove the SmartKey from the starter switch. or 왘 PressDbutton. i Should excessively high temperatures occur while the audio system is being operated, the display will dim. If temperatures continue to rise, HIGH TEMP will appear in the display, after which the audio system will be switched off for a cooling-down period. Adjusting the volume or PressDbutton. i If the radio is switched on without the SmartKey in the starter switch, it will automatically switch off again after approximately 30 minutes. If your vehicle is equipped with a mobile telephone*, the display may prompt you to enter your PIN (GSM network) or code (TDMA or CDMA network). 196 Switching off 왘 Turn rotary control ofEbutton. The volume will increase or decrease depending on the direction turned. i If your vehicle equipment includes a Mercedes-Benz specified mobile telephone*, you can adjust its volume separately from the volume of the audio system while the telephone is being used. Controls in detail Audio system Adjusting sound functions 왘 The bass and treble functions are called up by pressing the O button. or Settings for bass and treble are stored separately for the AM and FM wavebands, weather band, CD mode and telephone mode. Bass 왘 Press O button repeatedly until BASS appears in the display. 왘 Press + or – soft key to increase or decrease tone level accordingly. Adjusting treble 왘 Press O button repeatedly until TREBLE appears in the display. 왘 Press + or – soft key to increase or decrease tone level accordingly. Press RES soft key briefly to reset bass tones to their center level. The radio switches back to the standard radio menu 8 seconds after the last soft key is pressed. or 왘 Press RES soft key briefly to reset treble tones to their center level. The radio switches back to the standard radio menu 8 seconds after the last soft key is pressed. 197 Controls in detail Audio system Returning sound functions to factory settings 왘 Press O button to call up settings menu in the display. 왘 Press RES soft key briefly; the respective sound function is reset to its center level. 왘 Press P button. BALANCE appears in the display. 왘 Press X or Y soft key. Press and hold RES soft key until RESET appears in the display. The sound settings for bass and treble are returned to their center level and the volume is set to a predefined level. The radio switches back to the standard radio menu 4 seconds after the last soft key is pressed. 198 Returning volume distribution to factory settings 왘 Press P button to call up settings menu in the display. 왘 Press RES soft key briefly; the respective volume distribution is reset to its center (flat) level. The volume is distributed between the left and right sides of the vehicle. or or 왘 Adjusting balance 왘 or Press RES soft key briefly. The balance is reset to its center level. The radio switches back to the standard radio menu 8 seconds after the last button is pressed. 왘 Press and hold RES soft key until RESET appears in the display. The volume distribution settings for the balance is set to the center level. The radio switches back to the standard radio menu 4 seconds after the last soft key is pressed. Controls in detail Audio system Telephone* muting If your vehicle equipment includes a Mercedes-Benz specified mobile telephone*, you can adjust its volume separately from the volume of the audio system while the telephone* is being used. Radio operation Calling up wavebands for radios without SAT Selecting radio mode 왘 왘 Press b button. The FM and AM wavebands are called up one after another. Calling up wavebands You can choose from among the FM, AM and WB wavebands. Weather band (컄 page 202). i FM waveband: AM waveband: 87.7......107.9 MHz 530......1710 KHz Press FM or AM soft key to switch between FM and AM. or 왘 Press WB soft key. The weather band menu is called up. The waveband currently selected appears in the upper left-hand corner of the display. 199 Controls in detail Audio system Calling up wavebands for radios with SAT 왘 Press FM, AM or WB soft key repeatedly until desired waveband has been selected. The FM, AM and WB wavebands are called up one after another. The waveband currently selected appears in the upper left-hand corner of the display. Selecting a station Direct frequency input The following options are available for selecting a station: 왘 Select desired waveband. 왘 Press * button. 왘 Enter desired frequency with buttons 1 to R. 앫 Direct frequency input (컄 page 200) 앫 Manual tuning (컄 page 201) 앫 Automatic seek tuning (컄 page 201) 앫 Scan search (컄 page 201) 앫 Station memory (컄 page 201) 앫 Automatic station memory (Autostore) (컄 page 202) The station search proceeds in the following frequency increments: 200 앫 0.2 MHz in FM range 앫 10 kHz in AM range i You can only enter frequencies within the respective waveband. If a button is not pressed within 4 seconds, the radio will return to the last station tuned. Controls in detail Audio system Manual tuning Scan search Station memory 왘 Select desired waveband. 앫 왘 Press G or H button for approximately 3 seconds. You can store ten AM and ten FM stations in the memory. 왘 Starting scan search 왘 Select desired waveband. 앫 Press button repeatedly until the desired frequency has been reached. Step-by-step station tuning takes place in ascending or descending order. Each time the button is pressed, the radio tunes further by 0.2 MHz. During manual tuning, the radio is muted. 왘 왘 Select desired waveband. 왘 Press G or H button briefly. The radio will tune to the next highest or next lowest receivable frequency. i If no station is received after two consecutive scans of the complete frequency range, then the scan stops at the frequency from which it began. radio briefly (approximately 8 seconds) tunes in all receivable stations on the waveband selected. 앫 왘 Tune in desired station. 왘 Press and hold desired station button 1 to R until a brief signal tone is heard. The frequency is stored on the selected station button. Press SC soft key. SC will appear in the display. The Automatic seek tuning Storing stations 앫 Calling up stations 왘 Press desired station button 1 to R briefly. Ending scan search 왘 Press SC soft key or G or H. The station last played will be selected and SC disappears from the display. 201 Controls in detail Audio system Autostore – automatic station memory The Autostore memory function provides an additional memory level. The station memory for manually stored stations is not overwritten. 앫 Calling up Autostore memory level and storing stations 앫 Calling up stations 왘 앫 Press desired station button 1 to R. Leaving the Autostore memory level 왘 Press FM or AM soft key briefly. Interrupting radio mode The radio mode is interrupted by an incoming call on the telephone* (컄 page 224). 앫 Press AS soft key briefly. The radio switches to the Autostore memory level. AS and SEARCH appear in the display and the radio finds the ten stations with the strongest signals. These stations are stored on the station buttons 1 to R in order of signal strength. 202 앫 왘 Press WB soft key. The weather band station last received is tuned in. Mute on 왘 왘 Weather band Press F button. Selecting a weather band station directly The radio mode is interrupted and MUTED appears in the display. 왘 Mute off 왘 Press F button. The radio mode is again active. Select desired weather band station with buttons 1 to 7. If a station cannot be tuned in, a search is automatically started. Controls in detail Audio system Search Scan search 왘 앫 Press G or H button to tune in the next receivable weather band station. Starting scan search 왘 SC will appear in the display. The i If no weather band station is received after three consecutive scans of the complete frequency range, then the scan stops at the channel with which it began and NO WB FOUND appears in the display. If this happens, switch back to standard radio mode. Press SC soft key. radio briefly (approximately 8 seconds) tunes in all receivable weather band stations. 앫 Ending scan search 왘 Press SC soft key or G or H. The weather band station last played will be selected and SC disappears from the display. Introduction to satellite radio* (USA only) SIRIUS satellite radio provides 100 channels of digital-quality radio, among others music, sports, news, and entertainment, free of commercials. SIRIUS satellite radio uses a fleet of high-power satellites to broadcast 24 hours per day, coast to coast, in the contiguous U.S. This diverse, satellite-delivered programming is available for a monthly subscription fee. For more information and service availability, call the SIRIUS Service Center (컄 page 208), or contact www.sirius.com 203 Controls in detail Audio system i Additional satellite radio equipment and a i Satellite radio service may be unavailable Calling up the SAT main menu subscription to a satellite radio service provider are required for the satellite radio operation described here. or interrupted from time to time for a variety of reasons, such as environmental or topographic conditions and other things beyond the service provider’s or our control. Service might also not be available in certain places (e.g., in tunnels, parking garages, or within or next to buildings) or near other technologies. 왘 Contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center for details and availability for your vehicle. Note that categories and channels shown in illustrations are dependent on programming content delivered by the service provider. Programming content is subject to change. Therefore, channels and categories shown in illustrations and descriptions contained in this manual may differ from the channels and categories delivered by the service provider. Program categories The channels are categorized. Categories allow you to tune to stations broadcasting a certain type of program (category mode) (컄 page 206). Press SAT soft key. SAT is displayed in the upper left-hand corner of the display. Prior to activation of the satellite radio service (컄 page 204). After activation of satellite radio service (컄 page 205). Prior to activation of the satellite radio service The telephone number of the SIRIUS Service Center (888-539-7474) is displayed. 204 Controls in detail Audio system 왘 Press ESN soft key. i The system will tune to a default station if no Selecting a station The twelve-digit electronic serial number (ESN) of the SAT tuner* installed in your vehicle is displayed. station had been selected previously. The following options are available: This information is required to call the SIRIUS Service Center for an activation request. i Credit card information may also be required for your application. The activation process takes approximately 5 to 10 minutes after calling the SIRIUS Service Center. After activation of the satellite radio service The satellite radio main menu appears. The radio station selected last is audible, provided it can be received. The first channel 001 is called up and the PTY system changes to All categories. If no station can be received, ACQUIRING appears in the display. If the Satellite radio service is not activated, ACQUIRING will also appear in the radio display and NO SAT will appear in the multifunction display. 앫 Selecting a station using the selected category (컄 page 206). 앫 Tuning via station presets (컄 page 205). 앫 Tuning via scan search (컄 page 207). 앫 Tuning via manual channel input (컄 page 206). 앫 Tuning via the program category list (컄 page 206). Tuning via station presets Ten satellite radio station presets are available. You can access the presets via number keys. 205 Controls in detail Audio system Accessing via number keys 왘 왘 Input line appears in the main radio menu. Enter number of preset you wish to select, e.g. 1. The radio plays the station stored under this number and the PTY function changes to the category corresponding to the station. Tuning via manual channel input Press *. 왘 앫 Selecting a category 왘 Use number keys to enter desired channel within 8 seconds, e.g. 1 6. The system tunes to channel 16. The station you have selected begins to play. The current PTY category of the station is displayed. i You can only enter available channel numbers. Tuning via the program category list Example: tuning in channel 16 206 Press PTY soft key. The category list contains all currently receivable categories of programs. It is arranged alphabetically. 왘 Press <<< or >>> soft key. This switches between the individual categories. When changing the category, the channel selected last in the new category becomes audible. Controls in detail Audio system 앫 Tuning via scan search Obtaining additional text information Scan search is characterized as follows: Additional text information (artist, title) related to the current channel can be displayed. The system will automatically switch to a station of the selected category if the currently selected station is not of the selected category. Otherwise, the currently selected station remains tuned. 앫 Tuning a station within the selected category 앫 Scan search can be terminated manually. 왘 Press SC soft key. The channels identified for the currently selected category are arranged numerically. Only one entry is visible at a time. 왘 Press G or H button briefly. The next station within the category is started. Scan search plays a channel for approximately 8 seconds and then skips to the next channel within the current category. The search starts. SC appears in the display. 왘 왘 Press INF soft key. The title being played is displayed. 왘 Press INF soft key again. The name of the artist performing the title being played is displayed. i If a button is not pressed within 4 seconds, the radio will return to the standard display. Press SC soft key again. The search stops. or 왘 Press and hold G or H button for approximately 3 seconds until desired station has been reached. 207 Controls in detail Audio system Storing stations Calling up the ESN information menu 왘 Tune in desired station. 왘 Press INF soft key. 왘 Press and hold desired station button 1 to R until a brief signal tone is heard. 왘 Press ESN soft key. The frequency is stored on the selected station button. The radio saves the current station at the memory preset selected. The memory preset selected appears in the status line, e.g. S3. i There are ten presets available. An existing entry is overwritten in the memory list when a new entry is given. 208 The twelve-digit electronic serial number (ESN) of the SAT tuner* installed in your vehicle is displayed. 왘 Press RET soft key to exit the menu. CD mode Safety precautions Warning! G The single CD player and the CD changer* are Class 1 laser products. There is a danger of invisible laser radiation if the housing is opened or damaged. Do not open the housing. The single CD player and the CD changer* do not contain any parts that can be serviced by the user. For safety reasons, have any service work which may be necessary performed only by qualified personnel. Controls in detail Audio system Warning! G In order to avoid distraction which could lead to an accident, the driver should insert CDs with the vehicle at a standstill and operate the audio system only if permitted by road, weather and traffic conditions. Bear in mind that at a speed of just 30 mph (approximately 50 km/h), your vehicle is covering a distance of 44 feet (approximately 14 m) every second. General notes ! If you affix stickers to the CDs, they can become warped due to the heat that develops in the CD drive or CD changer. In certain situations, the CDs can then no longer be ejected and cause damage to the drive. Such damage is not covered by the Mercedes-Benz Limited Warranty. ! Your CD drive or CD changer has been designed to play CDs which correspond to the EN 60908 standard. You can therefore only use CDs with a maximum thickness of 1.3 mm. If you insert thicker data carriers, e.g. ones that have data on both sides (one side with DVD data, the other side with audio data), they cannot be ejected and will damage the drive. ! Do not use CDs with an 8 cm diameter, not even with a CD adapter. Attempting to play CDs with an 8 cm diameter or playing such CDs with an adapter may cause damage to the CD drive. Such damage is not covered by the Mercedes-Benz Limited Warranty. Should excessively high or low temperatures occur while in CD changer mode*, CD TEMP will appear in the display, and the CD will be muted until the temperature has reached an acceptable level for the system to continue operation. The single CD player and the CD changer* play audio CDs. The system may not be able to play audio CDs with copy protection. Playing copied CDs may cause malfunctions during playback. i The audio system plays both CD-Rs and CD-RWs with audio data. 209 Controls in detail Audio system Tips on handling CDs MP3 Compatible MP3 data carriers 앫 Handle CDs carefully to prevent interference during playback. The CD changer* can play audio CDs as well as CDs with MP3 files. The CD changer can read the following data carriers in MP3 mode: 앫 Avoid scratches, fingerprints and dust on the CDs. Information on MP3 data carriers 앫 Do not write on CDs or apply any labels or other material to them. 앫 Clean CDs from time to time with a commercially available cleaning cloth. Never wipe the CD in a circular motion; instead, wipe it in a straight line starting in the center and moving outward. Do not use solvents, anti-static sprays, etc. for cleaning. 앫 Replace the CD in its case after use. 앫 Protect CDs from heat and direct sunlight. 210 i CD media, CD burning software and CD writers are available in great variety. Due to this variety, it cannot be guaranteed that the CD changer will be able to play every user-written CD. The burning process can lead to data errors and aging of the medium may result in data loss. Therefore, the CD changer may be restricted in its ability to play MP3 data carriers; it may play them with reduced sound quality, or it may not be able to play them at all. Problems may be encountered during playback of user-written CDs with a storage capacity of more than 700 MB. These CDs do not meet valid standards as of this printing. 앫 CD-DA 앫 CD-R 앫 CD-RW Compatible file systems and compression methods Use Romeo or Joliet. Depending on file format used, up to 128 characters are possible. The following compression methods are compatible: 앫 MP3 앫 WMA 앫 WAV Controls in detail Audio system Compatible bit and sampling rates Information on copyright MP3 playback Fixed and variable bit rates of up to 320 kBit/s are possible. The music tracks that you create for use in MP3 mode or that you play in MP3 mode are subject to copyright laws under applicable international and national regulations. You can play an MP3 CD on the CD changer* as you would any standard audio CD. All of the functions described for the CD changer also apply for the playback of MP3 CDs. Keep in mind that the single CD player in the audio system unit is not able to read MP3 CDs. The following table lists possible sampling rates: MPEG1 Audio Layer3 44.1 KHz, 48 KHz, 32 KHZ MPEG2 Audio Layer3 22.5 KHz, 24 KHz, 16 KHz MPEG2.5 Audio Layer3 11.025 KHz, 12 KHz, 8 KHz WMA 32 KHz, 44.1 KHz, 48 KHz i Only use MP3 tracks with a bit rate of 128 kBit/s or higher and with the specified sampling rates. In many countries, the reproduction of copyrighted materials is not permitted, even if only for personal use, without the express prior consent of the copyright holder. Please check the current copyright laws for your country and comply with them. These restrictions do not apply, for example, to your own compositions and recordings, or for recordings for which authorization has been obtained from the copyright holder. The first 99 tracks on the CD, including tracks in subdirectories, are recognized and played. Any additional tracks will not be played. i Due to the branched data structure, playback of the first track may be delayed slightly. The use of rates other than those specified may lead to noticeably inferior sound quality. 211 Controls in detail Audio system Operating the single CD player in the audio system unit i If a CD has been inserted incorrectly or cannot be read, WRONG CD0 will appear in the display. Loading a CD The single CD player in the audio system unit has capacity for one CD. The CD slot for loading the drive is located underneath the soft keys. 왘 Make sure the system is switched on. 왘 Insert CD into CD slot. The label side of the CD must face upwards. The system automatically pulls the CD into the CD slot. The audio CD begins to play. ! If a CD is already loaded, it must be ejected before inserting a new CD. Inserting a second CD in the slot with another CD still loaded will cause damage to the CD drive not covered by the Mercedes-Benz Limited Warranty. Ejecting a CD 왘 Make sure the system is switched on. 왘 Press g button. Operational readiness of CD changer* If a CD changer has been installed in the vehicle, it can be operated from the front control panel of the audio system. The CD changer is located in the glove box. The system ejects the CD. Remove CD0 will appear in the display. 왘 Remove CD from slot. With the CD removed, NO CD will appear in the display. i If you do not take the CD out of the CD slot within approximately 15 seconds, the system automatically pulls the CD back in and plays it. If a CD is pulled back in, press g button, the CD will then be ejected. 1 CD loading slot 2 Magazine slot button A magazine is integrated into the CD changer as a fixed element. It holds a maximum of six CDs. The CD changer features six magazine slot buttons 2 for controlling the loading procedure. 212 Controls in detail Audio system A light-emitting diode in the buttons shows the status of the corresponding magazine slot. CD loading slot 1 is above buttons 2 and is used to load CDs. Loading the CD magazine 왘 i If a CD has been inserted incorrectly or cannot be read, WRONG CD0 will appear in the display. The light-emitting diode in the magazine slot button flashes in green. INSERT CD appears in the display along with the slot number. Loading one or more CDs interrupts the CD playback. LEDs no LED is lit Magazine slot is empty. Loading single CDs 왘 red LED is lit Magazine slot is in use. red LED flashes CD is being ejected. The flashing light indicates that the CD changer is ready to receive a CD. Open the glove box (컄 page 252). green LED flashes CD can be loaded. Briefly press button 2 for the empty magazine slot that you would like to use. 왘 Insert an audio CD into CD loading slot 1 within 5 seconds, label side up. The CD is pulled in and played. 왘 Close the glove box. 1 CD loading slot 2 Magazine slot button 213 Controls in detail Audio system Loading several CDs 왘 왘 왘 왘 Open the glove box. Repeat the previous step until all six magazine slots are loaded. Press button 2 of an empty magazine slot for more than 2 seconds. Once all magazine slots are loaded, the CD in the sixth magazine slot is played. The light-emitting diodes in all the magazine slot buttons light up several times in green, and ALL LOAD appears in the display. i If, for example, you only want to load maga- Wait until the light-emitting diode for the first magazine slot flashes in green. zine slots 1 - 4 instead of all six, simply do not insert a fifth CD into the CD loading slot. The CD changer will first try to load a CD but will then cancel the procedure, after which the radio will play the fourth CD. 왘 Ejecting CDs i The CD playback is interrupted while one or more CDs are being ejected. Ejecting single CDs 왘 Open the glove box. 왘 Briefly press desired magazine slot button. The light-emitting diode in the magazine slot button flashes in red. The corresponding CD is ejected. EJECTING CD appears in the display along with the magazine slot number. Close the glove box. The flashing light indicates that the CD changer is ready to receive a CD. 왘 Insert an audio CD into CD loading slot 1 within 5 seconds, label side up. The CD is pulled in and the light-emitting diode in the magazine slot button lights up in red. The magazine slot is loaded. The light-emitting diode in the next available magazine slot button flashes in green. The CD changer is ready to receive the next CD. 214 왘 Remove CD from CD loading slot within 15 seconds. If after removing a single CD no other CDs remain loaded in the magazine, MAG. EMPTY appears in the display. Controls in detail Audio system i If you do not take the CD from the CD load- Ejecting all loaded CDs i If you do not take the CD from the CD load- ing slot within 15 seconds, the CD changer will automatically pull the CD back in. The system will then play the CD. 왘 Open the glove box. 왘 Press the button of a loaded magazine slot for more than 2 seconds. ing slot within 15 seconds, the CD changer will automatically pull the CD back in. The system will then play the CD. If you are listening to a CD while ejecting another CD from the changer: The Audio system stops playing the CD while another CD is being ejected. Once the CD has been ejected, the Audio system will continue playing where it left off. 왘 The light-emitting diodes in all magazine slot buttons light up several times in red, and ALL EJECT appears in the display. Close the glove box. With all CDs ejected, press the b button to switch back to the radio mode. 왘 Close the glove box. The CD changer ejects the CDs one after another. The light-emitting diode for the magazine slot being emptied flashes in red. 왘 Take corresponding CD from CD loading slot within 15 seconds. The ejection procedure is finished once you have removed all CDs from the CD loading slot or if the CD changer cancels the procedure. With all CDs removed from the magazine, MAG. EMPTY appears in the display. 215 Controls in detail Audio system Playing CDs Single CD player in the audio unit 왘 Press i button. CD0 will appear in the upper left-hand corner of the display. The CD will resume playback at the point where it was switched off. CD changer* 왘 Press Q button. CD and the selected magazine slot number appear in the upper left-hand corner of the display. If you have not removed a CD since the last time the CD audio source was activated, the last CD listened to will begin to play at the point where it was switched off. After the last track on a CD has finished, the next CD is automatically played. 216 Playing tracks You have the following options: 앫 Audio system with CD changer*: selecting CDs 앫 Direct track entry 앫 Track skip forward/reverse 앫 Fast forward/reverse 앫 Scan 앫 Random tracks 앫 Repeat track Selecting CDs in the audio unit with CD changer* 왘 You can select from among the inserted CDs with buttons R to 6. R = CD player in the audio unit 1 to 6 = CDs in the CD changer* The magazine slot number of the selected CD appears next to CD in the display, and the number of the currently played track appears next to TRACK. i If there is no CD in the selected magazine slot, NO CD appears in the display with the corresponding slot number. Controls in detail Audio system Direct track entry Skipping tracks forward/backward Fast forward/reverse 앫 앫 Skipping tracks forward 왘 Fast forward 왘 Press H button briefly. The next track will be played. 앫 Skipping tracks backward 왘 You can make a direct selection from among the tracks on a CD. 왘 Press * button. 왘 Enter track number using buttons 1 to R. The number of the track being played appears next to TRACK in the display. You can only enter available track numbers. 앫 If the track has been playing for more than 10 seconds, the unit skips back to the beginning of the track currently playing. If less than 10 seconds have been played, the unit skips back to the beginning of the previous track. Reverse 왘 Press G button briefly. Press and hold H button until desired point has been reached. Press and hold G button until desired point has been reached. i The track number and the relative time of the track is shown in the display during the search. Scan 앫 Starting scan 왘 Pressing the G or H button repeatedly will result in multiple tracks being skipped. Press SC soft key. SC will appear in the display. Each track on the current CD will be played for approximately 8 seconds in ascending order. 앫 Ending scan 왘 Press SC soft key or G or H. 217 Controls in detail Audio system Random play Repeat Pause function The random function (RDM) plays the tracks of the current CD in random order. The track being played is repeated until the repeat function (RPT) is switched off. i When you start the RDM function, the RPT i When you start the RPT function, the RDM The CD changer mode is interrupted by an incoming call on the telephone* (컄 page 224). function is automatically switched off. function is automatically switched off. 앫 앫 Switching on random 왘 RDM appears in the display. A randomly selected track is played. 앫 Switching off random 왘 Switching on pause function Switching on repeat 왘 Press RDM soft key. 앫 Press RPT soft key. RPT appears in the display. 앫 Switching off repeat 왘 Press RPT soft key again. 왘 Press RDM soft key again. Press F button. The CD changer mode is interrupted and PAUSE appears in the display. 앫 Switching off pause function 왘 Press F button. The CD changer mode is active again. 218 Controls in detail Audio system Track and time display GSM network phones Warning! Using your Mercedes-Benz specified mobile telephone*, a number of functions and operating steps can be performed and displayed in the audio system display. 왘 A driver’s attention to the road must always be his/her primary focus when driving. For your safety and the safety of others, we recommend that you pull over to a safe location and stop before placing or taking a telephone call. If you choose to use the telephone1 while driving, please use the hands-free device and only use the telephone when weather, road, and traffic conditions permit. Press T soft key. The number of the track being played and the elapsed playing time appear in the display. 왘 Some jurisdictions prohibit the driver from using a cellular telephone while driving a vehicle. Press T soft key again. The total number of tracks and the total playing time of the CD appear in the display. 왘 Bear in mind that at a speed of just 30 mph (approximately 50 km/h), your vehicle is covering a distance of 44 feet (approximately 14 m) every second. Press T soft key. The standard CD playback menu appears in the display. G 1 Observe all legal requirements. 219 Controls in detail Audio system Further operating instructions not covered here can be found in the operating instructions for the multifunction steering wheel and the mobile telephone*. Switching on the telephone Switching on the telephone 왘 If your audio system is set up for telephone operation, the t symbol will appear in the display. When you insert your Mercedes-Benz specified mobile telephone* into the telephone cradle, you will be prompted to enter your PIN for 30 seconds (컄 page 220). This display disappears when you press any button. When your mobile telephone* is inserted into the telephone cradle, you will see the reception strength in the upper right-hand corner of the display. PIN entry Press h button. If the telephone was previously switched off, PROCESSING appears in the display and you will then be prompted to enter your PIN. 왘 Enter PIN number using buttons 1 to R. 왘 If necessary, correct number entered with the CLR soft key. Press soft key briefly to delete the last digit entered; press soft key and hold to delete the complete number. 왘 Press OK soft key after entering correct PIN. Switching off the telephone 왘 Press h button for approximately 3 seconds. PROCESSING appears in the display until the telephone is off. Afterward, PHONE OFF appears in the display. 왘 READY or ROAMING will appear in the display. i If the PIN is entered incorrectly three times, NEED PUK will appear in the display. Enter PUK via your telephone. Please refer to the separate telephone operating instructions for more information. 220 Controls in detail Audio system Adjusting the volume 왘 Turn rotary control of E button during a telephone call. Placing a call i The volume can be adjusted separately for telephone mode and audio mode. 왘 After correct telephone number has been entered, press s button. i If the telephone number has been saved together with a name in the telephone book, the name will appear in the display. Adjusting sound Adjust sound during a telephone call. Sound adjustment see “Adjusting sound functions” (컄 page 197). If necessary, correct number entered with the CLR soft key. Press soft key briefly to delete the last digit entered; press soft key and hold to delete the complete number. Entering a telephone number and starting the dialing process The volume will increase or decrease depending on the direction turned. 왘 왘 왘 Enter desired telephone number using buttons 1 to R. The number can have up to 32 digits, but only twelve of these are visible in the display. Phone book The numbers stored in the phone book of the telephone can be called up either by name or number. In addition, incoming calls are stored in the phone book. i This is only possible, however, when the call information transmitted includes the number of the person calling. If the telephone number is not transmitted, NO NUMBER will be stored in the phone book. 221 Controls in detail Audio system 앫 Searching and calling up telephone book entries by name 왘 You can access your mobile telephone’s phone book using the audio system. You can access both the main entries and the sub-entries of your phone book. The stored entries are selected according to the alphabetical order of the initial letters (e.g. for S -Schneider, press button 7 four times). 왘 왘 Press MEM soft key or press button ‚ or ƒ. Press desired numerical key 2 to 9. 왘 CEL = Mobile phone HOM = Home or WOR = Work Press and hold button ‚ or ƒ. FAX = Fax PAG = Pager The system jumps from one initial letter to the next in ascending or descending order. TEL = Main Press and hold button ‚ or ƒ until desired initial letter has been reached. or 왘 Press button ‚ or ƒ repeatedly until desired entry has been reached. The stored entries are selected in alphabetical order with the sub-entries. 222 i Several sub-entries can be stored for each main entry (name). These entries are marked by a corresponding abbreviation that appears in the upper left-hand corner of the display. The following abbreviations for sub-entries are possible: 왘 When you have selected a number, press s button. The call will be made. 앫 Viewing the telephone number of a telephone book entry 왘 Search for desired entry. 왘 Press NUM soft key. The telephone number of the phone book entry appears in the display. Controls in detail Audio system 앫 Returning calls received 왘 Select desired telephone number with button ‚ or ƒ. 앫 If you have stored telephone numbers as speed dial numbers in your telephone, you can also enter these with buttons 1 to R on the radio head unit. The letter R and the number of the memory position appear in the upper left-hand corner of the display. The numbers are stored in the order of the calls received. 왘 왘 왘 Press MEM soft key or press button ‚ or ƒ. Speed dial When you have selected a number, press s button. 왘 Press desired button 1 to R briefly. 왘 Press s button. The call will be made. The call will be made. Press RCV soft key (received calls). The number of received calls and then the call last received appear briefly in the display. 앫 Turbo dial If you have stored telephone numbers as turbo dial numbers in your telephone, you can also enter these with buttons 1 to R on the radio head unit. 왘 Press desired button 1 to R until the call is made. 223 Controls in detail Audio system Redial If the number you have dialed is busy, you can again place calls to the last ten telephone numbers dialed using the redial function. 왘 왘 i If you have activated the automatic redial Manual redial Accepting an incoming call The telephone number last dialed will appear in the display. If the telephone is active in the background (reception symbol is visible in the display), the audio source is muted when an incoming call is received. A ringing tone can be heard and the caller’s telephone number, or the name under which the telephone number has been saved in the phone book, appears in the display. If the caller’s number is not transmitted with the call, CALL will appear in the display. Select desired telephone number with button ‚ or ƒ. The letter L and the number of the memory position appears in the left-hand corner of the display. The numbers are stored in the order of the calls received. function on your telephone, the number of the person being called is automatically redialed after a short waiting period if there is a busy signal. Refer to the separate operating instructions for the mobile telephone. 앫 Press s button. 왘 When you have selected a number, press s button. The call will be made. 224 왘 Press s button. The call is accepted. Controls in detail Audio system Muting a call It is possible to mute a call; the caller is then no longer able to hear you. 앫 Mute on 왘 Press MUT soft key. 왘 MIC MUTE will 앫 appear in the display. Mute off 왘 Press MUT soft key again. Terminating a call 왘 Press t button. The current call is terminated and the muted audio source becomes active again. Talking with two callers at the same time If you wish to receive or place another call during an already active call, you can accept or place the second call and switch between the callers or combine them into one call. Note that the feature described here is dependent on availability from your mobile phone service provider. 앫 Placing/accepting a second call 왘 Place new call by entering telephone number manually. 왘 Press s button. You are connected to the second caller; the first caller is kept on hold. i You will be notified of the second call acoustically, but you will not see this in the display. You are connected with the second caller; the first caller is kept on hold. 앫 Switching between calls 왘 Press 2 and s buttons. This switches between the calls. The non-active call is kept on hold. 앫 Terminating a call 왘 Press t button. The current call is terminated. You are again connected with the caller previously placed on hold. or 왘 Press s button to accept a second call. 225 Controls in detail Audio system 앫 Combining two calls 왘 TDMA or CDMA network phones Press 3 and s buttons. The calls are combined into one call. 앫 Warning! A driver’s attention to the road must always be his/her primary focus when driving. For your safety and the safety of others, we recommend that you pull over to a safe location and stop before placing or taking a telephone call. If you choose to use the telephone1 while driving, please use the hands-free device and only use the telephone when weather, road, and traffic conditions permit. Terminating a combined call 왘 Press t button. The connection to both callers is terminated. 1 226 G Using your Mercedes-Benz specified mobile telephone*, a number of functions and operating steps can be performed and displayed in the audio system display. Further operating instructions not covered here can be found in the operating instructions for the multifunction steering wheel and the mobile telephone*. If your audio system is set up for telephone operation, the t symbol will appear in the display. Some jurisdictions prohibit the driver from using a cellular telephone while driving a vehicle. When you insert your Mercedes-Benz specified mobile telephone* into the telephone cradle, you will be prompted to enter your PIN for 30 seconds (컄 page 227). This display disappears when you press any button. Bear in mind that at a speed of just 30 mph (approximately 50 km/h), your vehicle is covering a distance of 44 feet (approximately 14 m) every second. When your mobile telephone* is inserted into the telephone cradle, you will see the reception strength in the upper right-hand corner of the display. Observe all legal requirements. Controls in detail Audio system Switching on the telephone 왘 Switching on the telephone 왘 Adjusting sound 왘 The telephone is unlocked. If you have entered an incorrect code, you must enter the correct code. Press h button. If you have programmed an unlock code for the telephone, you must now enter the code. Press OK soft key after entering correct code. Adjust sound during a telephone call. Sound adjustment see “Adjusting sound functions” (컄 page 197). Placing a call Switching off the telephone 왘 Press h button for approximately 3 seconds. Entering a telephone number and starting the dialing process PROCESSING appears in the display until the telephone is off. Afterward, PHONE OFF appears in the display. Adjusting the volume 왘 Enter code using buttons 1 to R. 왘 If necessary, correct number entered with the CLR soft key. Press soft key briefly to delete the last digit entered; press soft key and hold to delete the complete number. 왘 Turn rotary control ofEbutton during a telephone call. The volume will increase or decrease depending on the direction turned. i The volume can be adjusted separately for telephone mode and audio mode. 왘 Enter desired telephone number using buttons 1 to R. The number can have up to 32 digits, but only twelve of these are visible in the display. 컄컄 227 Controls in detail Audio system 컄컄 왘 왘 If necessary, correct number entered with the CLR soft key. Press soft key briefly to delete the last digit entered; press soft key and hold to delete the complete number. After correct telephone number has been entered, press s button. 앫 Searching and calling up phone book entries by name 왘 You can access your mobile telephone’s phone book with the audio system. You can access both the main entries and the sub-entries of your phone book. The stored entries are selected according to the alphabetical order of the initial letters (e.g. for S -Schneider, press button 7 four times). or i If the telephone number has been saved together with a name in the phone book, the name will appear in the display. 왘 In addition, incoming calls are stored in the phone book. i This is only possible, however, when the call information transmitted includes the number of the person calling. If the telephone number is not transmitted, NO NUMBER will be stored in the phone book. 228 Press and hold button ‚ or ƒ. The system jumps from one initial letter to the next in ascending or descending order. Phone book The numbers stored in the phone book of the mobile telephone can be called up either by name or number. Press desired numerical key 2 to 9. 왘 Press MEM soft key or press button ‚ or ƒ. Controls in detail Audio system 왘 or 왘 왘 Press and hold button ‚ or ƒ until desired initial letter has been reached. 앫 Press button ‚ or ƒ repeatedly until desired entry has been reached. The stored entries are selected in alphabetical order with the sub-entries. i Several sub-entries can be stored for each main entry (name). These entries are marked by a corresponding abbreviation that appears in the upper left-hand corner of the display. The following abbreviations for sub-entries are possible: CEL = Mobile phone HOM = Home WOR = Work FAX = Fax PAG = Pager TEL = Main When you have selected a number, press s button. 왘 Press MEM soft key or press button ‚ or ƒ. The call will be made. 왘 Press RCV soft key (received calls). The number of received calls and then the call last received appear briefly in the display. Viewing the telephone number of a phone book entry 왘 Search for desired entry. 왘 Press NUM soft key. 왘 The telephone number of the phone book entry appears in the display. 앫 Select desired telephone number with button ‚ or ƒ. The letter R and the number of the memory position appear in the upper left-hand corner of the display. The numbers are stored in the order of the calls received. Returning calls received 왘 When you have selected a number, press s button. The call will be made. 229 Controls in detail Audio system 앫 Speed dial Redial If you have stored telephone numbers as speed dial numbers in your telephone, you can also enter these with buttons 1 to R on the radio unit. If the number you have dialed is busy, you can again place calls to the last ten telephone numbers dialed using the redial function. 왘 Press desired button 1 to R briefly. 왘 Press s button. The call will be made. 앫 Turbo dial If you have stored telephone numbers as turbo dial numbers in your telephone, you can also enter these with buttons 1 to R on the radio unit. 왘 230 Press desired button 1 to R until the call is made. 왘 The telephone number last dialed will appear in the display. 왘 i If you have activated the automatic redial Manual redial Select desired telephone number with button ‚ or ƒ. The letter L and the number of the memory position appears in the left-hand corner of the display. The numbers are stored in the order of the calls received. function on your mobile telephone, the number of the person being called is automatically redialed after a short waiting period if there is a busy signal. Refer to the separate operating instructions for the mobile telephone. 앫 Press s button. 왘 When you have selected a number, press s button. The call will be made. Controls in detail Audio system Accepting an incoming call Muting a call Accepting a second incoming call If the telephone is active in the background (reception symbol is visible in the display), the audio source is muted when an incoming call is received. A ringing tone can be heard and the caller’s telephone number, or the name under which the telephone number has been saved in the telephone book, appears in the display. If the caller’s number is not relayed, CALL will appear in the display. It is possible to mute a call; the caller is then no longer able to hear you. If you receive another call during an already active call, you can accept the second call and switch between the two. 왘 Press s button. The call is accepted. 앫 Mute on 왘 Press MUT soft key. 왘 MIC MUTE will 앫 appear in the display. Mute off 왘 Press MUT soft key again. Terminating a call 왘 앫 Accepting a second call 왘 Place new call by entering telephone number manually. i You will be notified of the second call acoustically, but you will not see this in the display. You are connected to the second caller; the first caller is kept on hold. Press t button. The current call is terminated and the muted audio source becomes active again. 231 Controls in detail Audio system 앫 Switching between calls Placing a second call 왘 If you wish to place another call during an already active call, you can place the second call and switch between the callers or combine them into one call. Note that this feature is dependent on availability from your mobile phone service provider. Press s button. This switches between the calls. The non-active call is kept on hold. 앫 Terminating a call 왘 Press t button. The current call is terminated. The connection to the caller previously kept on hold is also interrupted; however, reconnection is indicated by an acoustic signal. 앫 Placing a second call 왘 Place a new call by entering telephone number manually. 왘 Press s button. You are connected to the second caller; the first caller is kept on hold. 앫 Terminating a call 왘 Press t button. The current call is terminated. The connection to the caller previously kept on hold is also interrupted; however, reconnection is indicated by an acoustic signal. 앫 Combining two calls 왘 Press s button. The calls are combined into one call. 앫 Terminating a combined call 왘 Press t button. The connection to both callers is terminated. 232 Controls in detail Audio system Emergency calls “911” The following conditions must be met for a “911” emergency call: The following describes how to dial a “911” emergency call using the audio system head unit when a Mercedes-Benz specified mobile phone* is inserted in the phone cradle. Unless otherwise specified, the descriptions refer to the audio system head unit. Consult the separate telephone operating instructions that came with your mobile phone* for information on how to place a “911” emergency call on the mobile phone*. Warning! G The “911” emergency call system is a public service. Using it without due cause is a criminal offense. GSM network phones 앫 Telephone must be switched on. Placing a “911” emergency call using audio head unit with the phone locked 앫 The corresponding mobile communications network must be available. 왘 i Emergency calls may not be possible with all telephone networks or if certain network services and/or telephone functions are active. Check with your local service providers. If you cannot make an emergency call, you will have to initiate rescue measures yourself. Press h button to switch to telephone operation. PIN? appears in the audio display. 왘 Enter 911 using the number keypad on the audio head unit. 왘 Press OK soft key or s button for dialing to begin. DIALING appears in the audio display while the telephone establishes the connection. 왘 Wait until the emergency call center answers, then describe the emergency. 233 Controls in detail Audio system Placing a “911” emergency call using audio head unit with the phone unlocked 왘 왘 왘 Press h button to switch to telephone operation. TDMA/CDMA network phones Placing a “911” emergency call using audio head unit with the phone locked 왘 Enter 911 using the number keypad on the audio head unit. Press s button for dialing to begin. 왘 왘 Enter 911 using the number keypad on the audio head unit. 왘 Press OK soft key or s button for dialing to begin. Wait until the emergency call center answers, then describe the emergency. i If no SIM card is in the mobile phone, NO SERVICE appears in the audio display. In that case, you only can make an emergency call on the mobile phone itself, without the use of the head unit. 234 왘 Press h button to switch to telephone operation. 왘 Enter 911 using the number keypad on the audio head unit. 왘 Press s button for dialing to begin. CODE? appears in the audio display. DIALING appears in the audio display while the telephone establishes the connection. Press h button to switch to telephone operation. Placing a “911” emergency call using audio head unit with the phone unlocked DIALING appears in the audio display while the telephone establishes the connection. 왘 Wait until the emergency call center answers, then describe the emergency. DIALING appears in the audio display while the telephone establishes the connection. 왘 Wait until the emergency call center answers, then describe the emergency. Controls in detail Power windows 왔 Power windows Opening and closing the windows Warning! The windows are opened and closed electrically. The switches for both door windows are located on the driver’s door. The switch for operating the passenger-side door window is located on the passenger door. The door windows can also be operated using the retractable hardtop switch (컄 page 237). The rear side windows can only be operated using the retractable hardtop switch (컄 page 237) or the SmartKey* (컄 page 238). G When closing the windows, make sure there is no danger of anyone being harmed by the closing procedure. The closing of the door windows can be immediately halted by releasing the switch or, if the switch was pressed past the resistance point and released, by pressing the respective switch. The door windows are equipped with the express-close and automatic reversal function. If a door window encounters an obstruction that blocks its path in a circumstance where you pressed the switch past the resistance point and released it to close the window, the automatic reversal function will stop the window and open it slightly. If a door window encounters an obstruction that blocks its path in a circumstance where you are closing the window by pressing and holding the switch, by pressing and holding button ‹ on the SmartKey, by pushing and holding the retractable hardtop switch, or by pressing and holding the , button on the climate control panel or automatic climate control* panel, the automatic reversal function will not operate. When leaving the vehicle, always remove the SmartKey from the starter switch, take it with you, and lock the vehicle. Do not leave children unattended in the vehicle, or with access to an unlocked vehicle. A child’s unsupervised access to a vehicle could result in an accident and/or serious personal injury. 1 Left door window 2 Right door window 235 Controls in detail Power windows i You can also open or close the windows using the SmartKey* (컄 page 238) or the retractable hardtop switch (컄 page 237). Opening the door windows 왘 You can close and open the windows using the air recirculation switch , in the control panel of the climate control (컄 page 178) or the automatic climate control* (컄 page 189). i After switching off the ignition (컄 page 37) or removing the SmartKey from the starter switch, the door windows can be operated: 앫 until you open a door 앫 for at least 5 minutes if no door was opened 왘 Switch on the ignition (컄 page 37). Press and hold switch 1 or 2 at the symbol k to the resistance point. 왘 The corresponding window will move downwards until you release the switch. Press switch 1 or 2 at the symbol k past the resistance point and release. The corresponding window opens completely. Closing the door windows 왘 Press and hold switch 1 or 2 at the symbol j to the resistance point. The corresponding window will move upwards until you release the switch. Warning! G If you press and hold the switch when closing the window, and upward movement of the window is blocked by some obstruction including but not limited to arms, hands, fingers, etc., the automatic reversal will not operate. 236 Fully opening the door windows (Express-open) Fully closing the door windows (Express-close) 왘 Press switch 1 or 2 at the symbol j past the resistance point and release. The corresponding window closes completely. Warning! G Driver’s door only: If the switch is pressed again past the resistance point and released within 5 seconds, the automatic reversal will not operate. Controls in detail Power windows ! If the upward movement of the window is blocked during the closing procedure, the window will stop and open slightly. Remove the obstruction, press the respective switch at the symbol j again past the resistance point and release. If the window still does not close when there is no obstruction, press and hold the respective switch at the symbol j. The window will then close without the obstruction sensor function. Opening and closing the windows with the retractable hardtop switch All windows can be opened or closed with the retractable hardtop switch. The retractable hardtop switch is located on the lower part of the center console. G Never operate the windows if there is the possibility of anyone being harmed by the opening or closing procedure. In case the procedure causes potential danger, the procedure can be immediately halted by releasing the retractable hardtop switch. If a door window encounters an obstruction that blocks its path in a circumstance where you are closing the windows using the retractable hardtop switch, the automatic reversal function will not operate. Stopping windows during Express-operation 왘 Warning! Briefly press the respective switch at the symbol k or j again. Retractable hardtop switch 왘 Switch on the ignition (컄 page 37). 1 Opening all side windows 2 Closing all side windows 237 Controls in detail Power windows Opening 왘 Push the retractable hardtop switch in quick succession twice in direction of arrow 1. All side windows open. Opening and closing the windows with the SmartKey* Opening (Summer opening feature) 왘 The retractable hardtop (컄 page 240) will also be opened or closed when the power windows are operated with the SmartKey. The windows and retractable hardtop begin to open after approximately 1 second. In the multifunction display you will see the message Retractable roof in operation. i You can operate the rear side windows only by using the retractable hardtop switch. 왘 Closing 왘 왘 Push the retractable hardtop switch in quick succession twice in direction of arrow 2. Keep the retractable hardtop switch pushed the second time until all windows are closed. The windows in the driver’s and passenger door will close first, followed by the rear side windows. i When the retractable hardtop is open, only the windows in the driver’s and passenger door will close. The rear side windows remain open. 238 Press and hold button Œ. Release button Œ on the SmartKey to interrupt procedure. Closing (Convenience closing feature) 왘 왘 Press and hold lock button ‹. The windows and retractable hardtop begin to close after approximately 1 second. In the multifunction display you will see the message Retractable roof in operation. Aim transmitter eye at the outside driver’s or passenger door handle. The SmartKey must be in close proximity to the respective outside door handle. 왘 Release button ‹ on the SmartKey to interrupt procedure. Controls in detail Power windows Warning! G Warning! G Synchronizing power windows The power windows must be synchronized When closing the side windows and retractable hardtop, make sure that there is no danger of anyone being harmed by the closing procedure. If the retractable hardtop does not completely open or close, the roof hydraulics will lose pressure and the retractable hardtop is lowered If potential danger exists, proceed as follows: 앫 after approximately 7 minutes when the ignition is switched on. 앫 앫 after approximately 15 seconds when the ignition is switched off. Release button ‹ to stop the closing procedure. To open, press and hold button Œ. To continue the closing procedure after making sure that there is no danger of anyone being harmed by the closing procedure, press and hold button ‹. Shortly before the hardtop is lowered, a warning will sound. In the multifunction display you will see K and the message Retractable roof being opened. 앫 after the battery has been disconnected or discharged. 앫 if the power windows cannot be fully opened (Express-open) or closed (Express-close). Each power window must be synchronized. 왘 Close all doors. 왘 Switch on the ignition (컄 page 37). 왘 Press and hold both switches 1 and 2 (컄 page 235) at the symbol j until the windows are completely closed. 왘 Hold on to switches 1 and 2 for approximately 1 second. Properly lock the retractable hardtop (컄 page 242) before continuing to drive. The power windows are synchronized. 239 Controls in detail Retractable hardtop Opening and closing the retractable hardtop For safety reasons, the retractable hardtop can only be opened and closed when the vehicle is standing still. Warning! G Before operating the switch for the retractable hardtop, make sure no persons are injured by the moving parts (retractable hardtop, roof frame, and trunk lid). Hands must never be placed near the roof frame, upper windshield area, retractable hardtop, shelf behind roll bars, or trunk lid while the retractable hardtop is being raised or lowered. Serious personal injury may occur. If potential danger exists, release the retractable hardtop switch. This immediately interrupts the raising or lowering procedure. You can then operate the retractable hardtop switch to raise or lower the retractable hardtop away from the danger zone. 240 Warning! G ! When opening and closing the retractable hardtop, make sure 앫 there is sufficient clearance for the retractable hardtop to move up and the trunk lid to move back 앫 the luggage cover is extended and closed 앫 the trunk is only loaded to the height of the luggage cover 앫 the luggage/cargo does not push the closed luggage cover up 앫 the trunk lid is closed 앫 no roof luggage carrier is installed shelf. Doing so could cause damage to the retractable hardtop and the rear shelf. 앫 the outside temperature is above +5°F (-15°C) ! Please keep in mind that weather conditions Otherwise the roof and other parts of the vehicle could be damaged. When leaving the vehicle, always remove the SmartKey from the starter switch, take it with you, and lock the vehicle. Do not leave children unattended in the vehicle, or with access to an unlocked vehicle. A child’s unsupervised access to a vehicle could result in an accident and/or serious personal injury. ! Never sit or place heavy objects on the rear can sometimes change rapidly. Make sure to close the retractable hardtop when leaving the vehicle. If water enters the vehicle interior, vehicle electronics could be damaged which is not covered by the Mercedes-Benz Limited Warranty. Controls in detail Retractable hardtop Luggage cover Opening The luggage cover is located in the trunk. 왘 왘 Retractable hardtop Press the release handle on the luggage cover. Warning! Guide the luggage cover forward to its end stop. To prevent possible accidents, drive the vehicle only with the retractable hardtop either completely closed and locked, or fully lowered into its storage compartment. ! To prevent damage to the retractable hardtop or luggage/cargo when lowering the roof: Luggage cover Closing 왘 Pull the luggage cover at the handle in direction of the arrow until it engages on both sides at the trunk sill. G 앫 Load trunk only to the height of the luggage cover. 앫 Do not permit luggage/cargo to push up the closed luggage cover. 앫 Do not place anything on top or in front of the luggage cover. Make sure the retractable hardtop and the rear window are dry before you open it. Otherwise water may enter the interior and/or trunk. 앫 Do not place anything on the shelf behind the roll bar. i Before operating the retractable hardtop via i For safety reasons, the retractable hardtop cannot be opened or closed while driving. the retractable hardtop switch, do the following first: 앫 Engage the parking brake (컄 page 59). 앫 Close the luggage cover. 앫 Close the trunk lid. 앫 Switch on the ignition (컄 page 37). 241 Controls in detail Retractable hardtop The switch for opening/closing the retractable hardtop is on the lower part of the center console. Opening 왘 Push and hold the retractable hardtop switch in direction of arrow 1 until the retractable hardtop is completely lowered into the trunk. Closing 왘 Retractable hardtop switch 1 Opening 2 Closing For operating the power windows with the retractable hardtop switch (컄 page 237). 242 Push and hold the retractable hardtop switch in direction of arrow 2 until the retractable hardtop is completely closed and locked. Locking the retractable hardtop after raising/lowering Warning! G Be sure to keep the hardtop switch pushed until the hardtop is fully opened or closed. The hydraulic pump will then shut off. To prevent possible accidents, drive the vehicle only with the hardtop either completely closed and locked, or fully lowered into its storage compartment. Controls in detail Retractable hardtop Warning! G If the retractable hardtop does not completely open or close, the roof hydraulics will lose pressure and the retractable hardtop is lowered 앫 앫 after approximately 7 minutes when the ignition is switched on. after approximately 15 seconds when the ignition is switched off. Shortly before the hardtop is lowered, a warning will sound. In the multifunction display you will see K and the message Retractable roof being opened. 앫 Warning! G The hardtop is not fully closed and locked or not fully opened and locked if: 앫 the message Retractable roof in operation is shown in the multifunction display 앫 a warning sounds for 10 seconds when driving and a message in the multifunction display appears (컄 page 374). If the retractable hardtop is not properly locked, lock it as described below. Unlocked status noticed when stopped 왘 Switch on the ignition (컄 page 37). 왘 To lock the retractable hardtop in its fully closed position, push the retractable hardtop switch forward until the retractable hardtop is fully closed. or: 왘 To lock the retractable hardtop in its fully opened position, push the retractable hardtop switch rearward until the retractable hardtop is fully open. Properly lock the retractable hardtop before continuing to drive (컄 page 243). 243 Controls in detail Retractable hardtop Unlocked status noticed while driving Warning! G Stop the vehicle and lock the retractable hardtop before continuing to drive. You could otherwise endanger yourself and others. 왘 Stop the vehicle and leave the ignition switched on. 왘 To lock the retractable hardtop in its fully closed position, push the retractable hardtop switch forward until the retractable hardtop is fully closed. or: 왘 To lock the retractable hardtop in its fully opened position, push the retractable hardtop switch rearward until the retractable hardtop is fully open. 244 Opening and closing the retractable hardtop with the SmartKey* The power windows (컄 page 235) will also be opened or closed when you operate the retractable hardtop with the SmartKey. Warning! G Before operating the retractable hardtop, make sure no persons can be injured by the moving parts (retractable roof, roof frame, and trunk lid) due to negligence. Hands must never be placed near the roof frame, upper windshield area, hardtop, shelf behind roll bars, or trunk lid while the retractable hardtop is being raised or lowered. Serious personal injury may occur. If potential danger exists, release the respective button on the SmartKey. This immediately interrupts the raising or lowering procedure. You can then operate Œ or ‹ to raise or lower the hardtop away from the danger zone. 왘 Aim transmitter eye at the outside driver’s or passenger door handle. The SmartKey must be in close proximity to the respective outside door handle. Controls in detail Retractable hardtop Opening (Summer opening feature) 왘 Press and hold unlock button Œ until the retractable hardtop is completely open. The retractable hardtop and windows begin to open after approximately 1 second. In the multifunction display you will see the message Retractable roof in operation. 왘 Release button Œ on the SmartKey to interrupt procedure. Closing (Convenience closing feature) 왘 Press and hold lock button ‹ until the retractable hardtop is fully closed. The retractable hardtop and windows begin to close after approximately 1 second. In the multifunction display you will see the message Retractable roof in operation. 왘 Warning! G Warning! G When closing the side windows and retractable hardtop, make sure that there is no danger of anyone being harmed by the closing procedure. If the retractable hardtop does not completely open or close, the roof hydraulics will lose pressure and the retractable hardtop is lowered If potential danger exists, proceed as follows: 앫 after approximately 7 minutes when the ignition is switched on. 앫 앫 after approximately 15 seconds when the ignition is switched off. Release button ‹ to stop the closing procedure. To open, press and hold button Œ. To continue the closing procedure after making sure that there is no danger of anyone being harmed by the closing procedure, press and hold button‹. Shortly before the hardtop is lowered, a warning will sound. In the multifunction display you will see K and the message Retractable roof being opened. 앫 Properly lock the retractable hardtop before continuing to drive (컄 page 243). Release button ‹ on the SmartKey to interrupt procedure. 245 Controls in detail Retractable hardtop Wind screen* Warning! i Make sure the lower wind screen edging is inserted through the gap 5 between the storage compartment and the rear panel. G The wind screen can restrict the driver’s vision to the rear of the vehicle. To prevent a possible accident when visibility is limited (e.g. in darkness), the upper part of the wind screen should be folded back. 왘 Close snap fasteners 2 by pushing in handle cap 6. 왘 Pull wind screen 1 on molding over roll bars. Pull the wind screen edging, not on the netting itself. 6 Handle cap Removing Installing 왘 왘 1 Wind screen 2 Snap fastener (with handle cap) 3 Supporting strap 4 Fastening pin 5 Gap 246 왘 Pull off wind screen 1 from roll bars. Remove wind screen 1 from its storage bag and unfold. 왘 Open snap fasteners 2 by pulling out handle cap 6. The storage bag is located on the wall behind the seat backrests. 왘 Loosen supporting straps 3 from fastening pins 4. Attach supporting straps 3 to fastening pins 4. 왘 Fold wind screen 1 and put it back into storage bag. Controls in detail Driving systems 왔 Driving systems The driving system of your vehicle is described on the following pages: 앫 Cruise control, with which the vehicle can maintain a preset speed. The BAS, ABS and ESP® driving systems are described in the “Safety and Security” section (컄 page 84). Cruise control Warning! The cruise control automatically maintains the speed you set for your vehicle. Use of cruise control is recommended for driving at a constant speed for extended periods of time. You can set or resume cruise control at any speed over 20 mph (30 km/h). The cruise control function is operated by means of the cruise control lever. G The cruise control is a convenience system designed to assist the driver during vehicle operation. The driver is and must remain at all times responsible for the vehicle speed and for safe brake operation. Only use the cruise control if the road, traffic, and weather conditions make it advisable to travel at a steady speed. 앫 The use of cruise control can be dangerous on winding roads or in heavy traffic because conditions do not allow safe driving at a steady speed. 앫 The use of cruise control can be dangerous on slippery roads. Rapid changes in tire traction can result in wheel spin and loss of control. 앫 Deactivate the cruise control when driving in fog. The cruise control lever is the uppermost lever on the left-hand side of the steering column (컄 page 24). The “Resume” function should only be operated if the driver is fully aware of the previously set speed and wishes to resume this particular preset speed. 247 Controls in detail Driving systems Warning! G Cruise control brakes automatically so that the set speed is not exceeded. The brake pedal is depressed automatically to do this. 1 Set current or higher speed 2 Set current or lower speed 3 Cancel cruise control 4 Resume to last set speed Keep in mind that cruise control is a convenience system designed to assist the driver during vehicle operation. The driver is and must always remain responsible for the vehicle’s speed and for safe braking operation. Keep driver’s foot area clear at all times, including the area under the brake pedal. Objects stored in this area may impair pedal movement which could interfere with the braking ability of the cruise control system. Do not place your foot under the brake pedal – your foot could become caught. 248 Setting current speed 왘 Accelerate or decelerate to the desired speed. 왘 Briefly lift 1 or depress 2 the cruise control lever (컄 page 248). The current speed is set. 왘 Remove your foot from the accelerator pedal. The cruise control is activated. The selected speed appears in the multifunction display. Controls in detail Driving systems i On uphill or downhill grades, the cruise Canceling cruise control i The cruise control switches off automatical- control may not be able to maintain the set speed. Once the grade eases, the set speed will be resumed. There are several ways to cancel the cruise control: 앫 you step on the brake pedal. 앫 you pull up the parking brake lever firmly. 앫 the vehicle speed is below 20 mph (30 km/h). 앫 ESP® is in operation or switched off with the ESP® switch (컄 page 86). 앫 Vehicles with manual transmission: you depress the clutch pedal for longer than 6 seconds during shifting into another gear. 앫 Vehicles with automatic transmission*: you move the gear selector lever to position N while driving. On downhill grades, the cruise control maintains the set speed with braking from the vehicle’s braking system. In addition, on longer downhill grades the automatic transmission* will automatically downshift. i Vehicles with manual transmission: If you depress the clutch pedal when shifting into another gear, the engine speed may increase. 왘 Step on the brake pedal. The cruise control is canceled. The last speed set is stored for later use. ly, if or 왘 Briefly push the cruise control lever in direction of arrow 3 (컄 page 248). The cruise control is canceled. The last speed set is stored for later use. 앫 Drive with sufficient engine speed. 앫 Shift gears in a timely manner. i The last stored speed is canceled when you 앫 If possible, do not shift down more than one gear. turn off the engine. ! Vehicles with automatic transmission*: Moving gear selector lever to position N while driving also cancels cruise control. However, the gear selector lever should not be moved to position N while driving except to coast when the vehicle is in danger of skidding (e.g. on icy roads). i Depressing the accelerator pedal does not deactivate the cruise control. After brief acceleration (e.g. for passing), the cruise control will resume the last speed set. 249 Controls in detail Driving systems Setting a higher speed 왘 왘 Lift the cruise control lever in direction of arrow 1 (컄 page 248) and hold it up until the desired speed is reached. Release the cruise control lever. Fine adjustment in 1 mph (Canada: 1 km/h) increments Faster 왘 Briefly tip the cruise control lever in direction of arrow 1 (컄 page 248). The new speed is set. Slower Setting a lower speed 왘 왘 Depress the cruise control lever in direction of arrow 2 (컄 page 248) and hold it down until the desired speed is reached. 왘 Briefly tip the cruise control lever in direction of arrow 2 (컄 page 248). Setting to last stored speed (“Resume” function) Warning! The speed stored in memory should only be set again if prevailing road conditions permit. Possible acceleration or deceleration differences arising from returning to the preset speed could cause an accident and/or serious injury to you and others. 왘 Release the cruise control lever. decelerate, the brake system will automatically brake the vehicle if the engine’s braking power does not brake the vehicle sufficiently. 250 Briefly pull the cruise control lever in direction of arrow 4 (컄 page 248). The cruise control resumes the last set speed. The new speed is set. i When you use the cruise control lever to G 왘 Remove your foot from the accelerator pedal. The last set speed appears in the multifunction display. Controls in detail Loading 왔 Loading Roof rack ! This vehicle is not designed to carry items on its roof. Roof rails and any roof-mounted devices, unless expressly approved by Mercedes-Benz for use on this vehicle model, must not be used as they will damage the vehicle and retractable hardtop. ! This vehicle is not designed to carry any items on its trunk lid or accommodate any type of trunk lid rack or device. Using such devices may damage the vehicle and retractable hardtop mechanism. At time of printing, Mercedes-Benz does not offer any roof racks or any other roof-mounted devices for use on this vehicle. 251 Controls in detail Useful features Storage compartments Warning! Glove box Storage/telephone* compartment under armrest G To help avoid personal injury during a collision or sudden maneuver, exercise care when storing objects in the vehicle. Put luggage or cargo in the trunk if possible. Do not place anything on shelf behind the roll bars. Parcel nets cannot secure hard or heavy objects. Keep compartment lids closed. This will help to prevent stored objects from being thrown around and injuring vehicle occupants during an accident. i The glove box and the storage/telephone* compartment under the armrest are centrally locked and unlocked. 252 1 Glove box lid release 2 Glove box lid 왘 Pull glove box lid release 1 to open the glove box. The glove box lid opens downward. 왘 Push glove box lid 2 up until it engages to close the glove box. i The CD changer* is located in the glove box. 1 Armrest 2 Recess for opening storage compartment and telephone* compartment i The mobile phone cradle* (컄 page 259), Roadside Assistance button • (컄 page 265) and the Information button ¡ (컄 page 267) are located in the telephone* compartment, see “Telephone* compartment” (컄 page 253). Depending on production date, your vehicle may be equipped with a storage compartment only. To access the mobile phone cradle*, the Roadside Assistance button • and the Information button ¡, see “Storage compartment” (컄 page 253). Controls in detail Useful features Storage compartment 왘 Reach into recess 2 on the left or right side and lift armrest 1 in direction of arrow to open the storage compartment. 왘 Lower armrest 1 until it engages to close storage compartment. Storage compartment between the seat backrests 왘 Reach into recess 2 on the left or right side, press in and fold up armrest to the right or left side to open it. Fold armrest back until it engages to close the telephone compartment. G Do not place heavy or fragile objects, or objects having sharp edges, in the parcel net. 1 Storage compartment lid release 2 Storage compartment 왘 Press storage compartment lid release 1 to open. In an accident, during hard braking or sudden maneuvers, they could be thrown around inside the vehicle, and cause injury to vehicle occupants. The storage compartment lid opens downward. The telephone compartment is opened. 왘 A small convenience parcel net is located in the passenger footwell and behind the driver’s seat. It is for small and light items, such as road maps, mail, etc. Warning! Telephone* compartment i Depending on production date, your vehicle may not be equipped with a separate telephone* compartment. Parcel net in passenger footwell 왘 Push storage compartment lid up until it engages to close it. 253 Controls in detail Useful features Shelf behind roll bars Warning! Cup holder G The shelf behind the roll bars should not be used to carry objects. This will prevent such objects from being thrown around and injuring vehicle occupants during an accident or sudden maneuver. The trunk is the preferred place to carry objects. Warning! G In order to help prevent spilling liquids on vehicle occupants and/or vehicle equipment, only use containers that fit into the cup holder. Use lids on open containers and do not fill containers to a height where the contents, especially hot liquids, could spill during braking, vehicle maneuvers, or in an accident. Liquids spilled on vehicle occupants may cause serious personal injury. Liquids spilled on vehicle equipment may cause damage not covered by the Mercedes-Benz Limited Warranty. When not in use, keep the cup holder closed. An open cup holder may cause injury to you or others when contacted during braking, vehicle maneuvers, or in an accident. Keep in mind that objects placed in the cup holder may come loose during hard braking, vehicle maneuvers, or in an accident and be thrown around in the vehicle interior. Objects thrown around in the vehicle interior may cause an accident and/or serious personal injury. 1 Cover plate 왘 Press briefly on cover plate 1 to open the cup holder. The cup holder opens automatically. 왘 254 Press cover plate 1 until the cup holder engages to close it. Controls in detail Useful features Ashtray Removing ashtray insert Warning! G Remove front ashtray only with vehicle standing still. Set the parking brake to secure vehicle from movement. Move gear selector lever to position N (manual transmission: into second gear). With gear selector lever in position N (manual transmission: into second gear), turn off the engine. 왘 Open the ashtray. 왘 Reach into both recesses on the left and right side of the retainer and pull out the ashtray insert. Installing ashtray insert 왘 Place the ashtray insert into the retainer. 왘 Push the ashtray insert down into the retainer until it engages. 1 Cover plate 왘 Press cover plate 1 briefly in direction of the arrow. The ashtray opens automatically. 왘 To close the ashtray again, press cover plate 1 until the ashtray engages. 왘 Secure vehicle from movement by setting the parking brake. 왘 Move the selector lever to position N (manual transmission: second gear). Now you have more room to take out the ashtray insert. 255 Controls in detail Useful features ! The lighter socket can be used to Cigarette lighter Warning! G Never touch the heating element or sides of the cigarette lighter; they are extremely hot. Hold the knob only. Make sure that any children traveling with you do not injure themselves or start a fire with the hot cigarette lighter. When leaving the vehicle, always remove the SmartKey from the starter switch, take it with you, and lock the vehicle. Do not leave children unattended in the vehicle, or with access to an unlocked vehicle. A child’s unsupervised access to a vehicle could result in an accident and/or serious personal injury. 왘 Switch on the ignition (컄 page 37). 256 1 Cigarette lighter 왘 Push in cigarette lighter 1. Cigarette lighter 1 will pop out automatically when hot. 왘 Reinsert cigarette lighter 1 in its socket after use. accommodate 12V DC electrical accessories (up to a maximum of 85 W) designed for use with the standard “cigarette lighter” plug type. Keep in mind, however, that connecting accessories to the lighter socket (for example extensive connecting and disconnecting, or using plugs that do not fit properly) can damage the lighter socket. With the socket damaged, the lighter may no longer be able to be placed in the heating (pushed-in) position, or the lighter may pop out too early with the lighter not hot enough. To help avoid damaging the cigarette lighter socket, we recommend connecting 12V DC electrical accessories designed for use with the standard “cigarette lighter” plug type to the 12V power outlets (컄 page 257) in your vehicle whenever possible. Controls in detail Useful features Power outlet A power outlet is located in the passenger footwell on the side panel of the center console. Floormat (driver’s side only) Warning! Removing G Whenever you are using floormats, make sure there is enough clearance and the floormats are securely fastened. Floormats should always be securely fastened using eyelets 4 and retainer pins 5. Before driving off, check that the floormats are securely in place and adjust them if necessary. A loose floormat could slip and hinder proper functioning of the pedals. 1 Power outlet 왘 Switch on the ignition (컄 page 37). 왘 Flip up cover of power outlet 1 and insert electrical plug (cigarette lighter type). i The power outlet can be used to accommodate 12V DC electrical accessories (e.g. air pump, auxiliary lamps) up to a maximum of 180 W. Do not place several floormats on top of each other as this may impair pedal movement. 1 Removing 2 Retainer pin 왘 Pull floormat off of retainer pin 2 in direction of arrow 1. 왘 Remove the floormat. i To install or remove the floormat more easily, move the driver’s seat as far to the rear as possible (컄 page 39). 257 Controls in detail Useful features Installing Telephone* Warning! Warning! 3 Installing 4 Eyelet 5 Retainer pin 왘 Lay down the floormat. 왘 Press the floormat eyelet 4 onto retainer pin 5 in direction of arrow 3. G 258 Please do not forget that your primary responsibility is to drive the vehicle. A driver’s attention to the road must always be his/her primary focus when driving. For your safety and the safety of others, we recommend that you pull over to a safe location and stop before placing or taking a telephone call. Never operate radio transmitters equipped with a built-in or attached antenna (i.e. without being connected to an external antenna) from inside the vehicle while the engine is running. Doing so could lead to a malfunction of the vehicle’s electronic system, possibly resulting in an accident and/or serious personal injury. If you choose to use the telephone1 while driving, please use the hands-free device and only use the telephone when road, weather and traffic conditions permit. Some jurisdictions prohibit the driver from using a mobile telephone while driving a vehicle. Radio transmitters, such as a portable telephone or a citizens band unit, should only be used inside the vehicle if they are connected to an antenna that is installed on the outside of the vehicle. The external antenna must be approved by Mercedes-Benz. Please contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center for information on the installation of an approved external antenna. Refer to the radio transmitter operation instructions regarding use of an external antenna. G Only operate the audio system or COMAND*1 if road, weather and traffic conditions permit. Bear in mind that at a speed of just 30 mph (approximately 50 km/h), your vehicle is covering a distance of 44 feet (approximately 14 m) every second. 1 Observe all legal requirements. Controls in detail Useful features i Various mobile phone cradles can be installed in the center armrest, see separate installation instructions for the mobile phone cradle. These mobile phone cradles can be obtained from an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. The functions and services available to you while using the mobile phone depend on your service provider and the type of mobile phone you are using. See also separate operating manual for instructions on how to use your mobile phone. When the mobile phone is inserted in the cradle, you can operate the telephone using the following devices: 앫 mobile phone keypad 앫 COMAND* (see separate operating instructions) 앫 buttons s and t on the multifunction steering wheel (컄 page 149) 앫 audio system (컄 page 219) Please note that these functions are only available with Mercedes-Benz approved mobile phones. Please contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center for information on features available for your mobile phone of choice. Inserting mobile phone in mobile phone cradle The cradle is located in the front center armrest. ! Do not try to remove the mobile phone along with the cradle. You could otherwise damage the mobile phone cradle. i Depending on production date, your vehicle may be equipped with a storage compartment only. The mobile phone cradle is then located in the storage compartment (컄 page 252). 왘 Open the telephone* compartment or, depending on production date, open the storage compartment, see “Storage/telephone* compartment under armrest” (컄 page 252). Once the mobile phone has been inserted in the mobile phone cradle, you have to use the hands-free device to respond during phone calls. 왘 If applicable, remove the cover for the external antenna connection from the back of the mobile phone and store it in a safe place. Be sure to comply with the mobile phone’s operating instructions as well. 컄컄 259 Controls in detail Useful features 컄컄 The mobile phone is linked to the hands-free device and the multifunction steering wheel. Removing mobile phone from mobile phone cradle The battery is charged depending on its charge status and the position of the SmartKey in the starter switch. The charge procedure will be indicated in the mobile phone’s display. Example illustration 1 Insert the mobile phone 2 Connector contact 3 Mobile phone cradle 왘 왘 Slide the lower end of the mobile phone into connector contact 2 on mobile phone cradle 3. Push the top of the mobile phone in direction of arrow 1, until the lug on the mobile phone release button engages. The mobile phone is connected to the network via the external antenna. 260 You can place or receive phone calls. You can control other functions of the mobile phone via the control system (컄 page 149), audio system (컄 page 219), or COMAND* (see separate operating instructions). i When you take the SmartKey out of the starter switch, the mobile phone remains switched on for approximately 10 minutes. If you place or receive a call during this time, the mobile phone switches off 10 minutes after the call has been completed. Example illustration 1 Release catch for mobile phone 2 Mobile phone cradle i When using a flip-style mobile phone, open flip top before removing from the cradle while a call is connected. Otherwise, the call will be disconnected. 왘 Press release catch in direction of arrow 1 and take mobile phone out of mobile phone cradle 2. Controls in detail Useful features Changing mobile phone cradle If you require a different cradle for your mobile phone, remove the present cradle before installing a new one. Installing a different mobile phone cradle Tele Aid* ! The initial activation of the Tele Aid system may only be performed by completing the subscriber agreement and placing an acquaintance call using the ¡ button. Failure to complete either of these steps will result in a system that is not activated. Removing an existing mobile phone cradle If you have any questions regarding activation, please call the Response Center at 1-800-756-9018 (in the USA) or 1-888-923-8367 (in Canada). Example illustration 1 Contact plate 2 Recesses 3 Mobile phone cradle Example illustration 1 To release the mobile phone cradle 2 To remove the mobile phone cradle 3 Mobile phone cradle 왘 왘 Insert mobile phone cradle 3 into recesses 2 of contact plate 1. 왘 Push mobile phone cradle 3 forward until it engages. Shortly after the completion of your Tele Aid acquaintance call, you will receive a user ID and password. By visiting www.mbusa.com and selecting “Tele Aid” (USA only), you will have access to account information, remote door unlock and more. Press release button in direction of arrow 1 and take mobile phone cradle 3 out in direction of arrow 2. 261 Controls in detail Useful features The Tele Aid* system (Telematic Alarm Identification on Demand) The Tele Aid system consists of three types of response: 앫 Automatic and manual emergency 앫 Roadside Assistance 앫 Information The Tele Aid system is operational providing that the vehicle’s battery is charged, properly connected, not damaged and cellular and GPS coverage is available. The speaker volume of a Tele Aid call can be adjusted when using the volume control on the multifunction steering wheel. To raise, press button æ and to lower, press button ç or use the volume knob on your audio system or COMAND* head unit. 262 왘 To activate, press the SOS button, the Roadside Assistance button • or the Information button ¡, depending on the type of response required. i The SOS button is located in the overhead control panel. The Roadside Assistance button • (컄 page 265) and the Information button ¡ (컄 page 267) are located below the center armrest cover. ! The Tele Aid system utilizes the cellular network for communication and the GPS (Global Positioning System) satellites for vehicle location. If either of these signals are unavailable, the Tele Aid system may not function and if this occurs, assistance must be summoned by other means. i When a Tele Aid call has been initiated, the audio system or COMAND* system audio is muted and the selected mode (radio, tape or CD) pauses. The optional cellular phone* (if installed) and inserted in cradle switches off. If you must use this phone, we recommend that you use it only with the vehicle at a standstill in a safe location. Remove the phone from the cradle and place the call. The COMAND* navigation system (if engaged) will continue to run. The display in the instrument cluster is available for use, and spoken commands are only available by pressing the RPT button on the COMAND* unit. A pop-up window will appear in the COMAND* display to indicate that a Tele Aid call is in progress. After the Tele Aid call has ended, the optional cellular phone switches on again. A PIN entry might be necessary. Controls in detail Useful features System self-check Initially, after switching on ignition, malfunctions are detected and indicated (the indicator lamps in the SOS button, the Roadside Assistance button •, and the Information button ¡ stay on longer than 10 seconds or do not come on). The message Tele Aid inoperative appears for approximately 10 seconds in the multifunction display. Warning! G If the indicator lamps in the SOS button, in the Roadside Assistance button, and/or in the Information button do not come on during the system self-check or if any of these indicators remain illuminated constantly in red and/or the message Tele Aid inoperative is displayed in the multifunction display after the system self-check, a malfunction in the system has been detected. If a malfunction is indicated as outlined above, the system may not operate as expected. Have the system checked at the nearest Mercedes-Benz Center as soon as possible. Emergency calls An emergency call is initiated automatically following an accident in which the emergency tensioning devices (ETDs) or air bags deploy. An emergency call can also be initiated manually by opening the cover next to the interior rear view mirror labeled SOS, then briefly pressing the button located under the cover. See (컄 page 264) for instructions on initiating an emergency call manually. Once the emergency call is in progress, the indicator lamp in the SOS button will begin to flash. The message Connecting call appears in the multifunction display and the audio system is muted. When the connection is established, the message Call connected appears in the multifunction display. All information relevant to the emergency, such as the location of the vehicle (determined by the GPS satellite location system), vehicle model, identification number and color are generated. 263 Controls in detail Useful features A voice connection between the Response Center and the occupants of the vehicle will be established automatically soon after the emergency call has been initiated. The Response Center will attempt to determine more precisely the nature of the emergency provided they can speak to an occupant of the vehicle. The Tele Aid system is available if: 앫 앫 it has been activated and is operational. Activation requires a subscription for monitoring services, connection and cellular air time. the relevant cellular phone network and GPS signals are available and pass the information on to the Response Center. i Location of the vehicle on a map is only possible if the vehicle is able to receive signals from the GPS satellite network and pass the information on to the Response Center. 264 Warning! G Initiating an emergency call manually If the indicator lamp in the SOS button is flashing continuously and there was no voice connection to the Response Center established, then the Tele Aid system could not initiate an emergency call (e.g. the relevant cellular phone network is not available). The message Call failed appears in the multifunction display for approximately 10 seconds. Should this occur, assistance must be summoned by other means. 1 Cover 2 SOS button 왘 Briefly press on cover 1. The cover opens. Controls in detail Useful features 왘 Press SOS button 2 briefly. Roadside Assistance button • The indicator lamp in SOS button 2 flashes until the emergency call is concluded. The Roadside Assistance button • is located below the center armrest cover. 왘 Wait for a voice connection to the Response Center. 왘 Close cover 1 after the emergency call is concluded. Warning! i Depending on production date, your vehicle may be equipped with a storage compartment only. The Roadside Assistance button • is then located in the rear of the storage compartment (컄 page 252). Vehicles with storage compartment G If you feel at any way in jeopardy when in the vehicle (e.g. smoke or fire in the vehicle, vehicle in a dangerous road location), please do not wait for voice contact after you have pressed the emergency button. Carefully leave the vehicle and move to a safe location. The Response Center will automatically contact local emergency officials with the vehicle’s approximate location if they receive an automatic SOS signal and cannot make voice contact with the vehicle occupants. 1 Roadside Assistance button 왘 Open the telephone* compartment or, depending on production date, open the storage compartment see “Storage/telephone* compartment under armrest” (컄 page 252). 컄컄 Vehicles with separate telephone* compartment 1 Roadside Assistance button 265 Controls in detail Useful features 컄컄 왘 Press and hold button 1 (for longer than 2 seconds). A call to a Mercedes-Benz Roadside Assistance dispatcher will be initiated. The button will flash while the call is in progress. The message Connecting call will appear in the multifunction display and the audio system is muted. When the connection is established, the message Call connected appears in the multifunction display. The Tele Aid system will transmit data generating the vehicle identification number, model, color and location (subject to availability of cellular and GPS signals). A voice connection between the Roadside Assistance dispatcher and the occupants of the vehicle will be established. 왘 Describe the nature of the need for assistance. 266 The Mercedes-Benz Roadside Assistance dispatcher will either dispatch a qualified Mercedes-Benz technician or arrange to tow your vehicle to the nearest Mercedes-Benz Center. For services such as labor and/or towing, charges may apply. Refer to the Roadside Assistance manual for more information. i The indicator lamp in the Roadside Assistance button • remains illuminated in red for approximately 10 seconds during the system self-check after switching on ignition (together with the SOS button and the Information button ¡). The following is only available in the USA: If the indicator lamp in the Roadside Assistance button • is flashing continuously and there was no voice connection to the Response Center established, then the Tele Aid system could not initiate a Roadside Assistance call (e.g. the relevant cellular phone network was not available). The message Call failed appears in the multifunction display. 앫 Sign and Drive services: Services such as jump start, a few gallons of fuel or the replacement of a flat tire with the vehicle spare tire are obtainable. See “System self-check” (컄 page 263) when the indicator lamp does not come on in red or stays on longer than approximately 10 seconds. Roadside Assistance calls can be terminated using the button t on the multifunction steering wheel or the respective button for ending a telephone call on the audio system or COMAND* head unit. Controls in detail Useful features 왘 Information button ¡ The Information button ¡ is located below the center armrest cover. A call to the Customer Assistance Center will be initiated. The button will flash while the call is in progress. The message Connecting call will appear in the multifunction display and the audio system is muted. i Depending on production date, your vehicle may be equipped with a storage compartment only. The Information button ¡ is then located in the rear of the storage compartment (컄 page 252). Vehicles with storage compartment 1 Information button 왘 Vehicles with separate telephone* compartment 1 Information button Press and hold button 1 (for longer than 2 seconds). Open the telephone* compartment or, depending on production date, open the storage compartment see “Storage/telephone* compartment under armrest” (컄 page 252). When the connection is established, the message Call connected appears in the multifunction display. The Tele Aid system will transmit data generating the vehicle identification number, model, color and location (subject to availability of cellular and GPS signals). A voice connection between the Customer Assistance Center representative and the occupants of the vehicle will be established. Information regarding the operation of your vehicle, the nearest Mercedes-Benz Center or Mercedes-Benz USA products and services is available to you. 267 Controls in detail Useful features For more details concerning the Tele Aid system, please visit www.mbusa.com and use your ID and password (sent to you separately) to learn more (USA only). i The indicator lamp in the Information button ¡ remains illuminated in red for approximately 10 seconds during the system self-check after switching on ignition (together with the SOS button and the Roadside Assistance button •). See “System self-check” (컄 page 263) when the indicator lamp does not come on in red or stays on longer than approximately 10 seconds. If the indicator lamp in the Information button ¡ is flashing continuously and there was no voice connection to the Response Center established, then the Tele Aid system could not initiate an Information call (e.g. the relevant cellular phone network is not available). The message Call failed appears in the multifunction display. Information calls can be terminated using the button t on the multifunction steering wheel or the respective button for ending a telephone call on the audio system or COMAND* head unit. 268 ! If the indicator lamps do not start flashing Call priority after pressing one of the buttons or remain illuminated (in red) at any time, the Tele Aid system has detected a malfunction or the service is not currently active, and may not initiate a call. Visit your Mercedes-Benz Center and have the system checked or contact the Response Center at 1-800-756-9018 (in the USA) or 1-888-923-8367 (in Canada) as soon as possible. If other service calls such as a Roadside Assistance call or Information call are active, an Emergency call is still possible. In this case, the Emergency call will take priority and override all other active calls. i The indicator lamp in the respective button flashes until the call is concluded. Calls can only be terminated by a Response Center or Customer Assistance Center representative, except Roadside Assistance and Information calls, which can also be terminated by pressing the t button on the multifunction steering wheel or the respective button for ending a telephone call on the audio system or COMAND* head unit. ! If the indicator lamp continues to flash or the system does not reset, contact the Response Center at 1-800-756-9018 (in the USA) or 1-888-923-8367 (in Canada), or Mercedes-Benz Customer Assistance at 1-800-FOR-MERCedes (1-800-367-6372) in the USA or Customer Service at 1-800-387-0100 in Canada. Controls in detail Useful features Remote door unlock In case you have locked your vehicle unintentionally (e.g. SmartKey inside vehicle), and the reserve SmartKey is not handy: 왘 Contact the Mercedes-Benz Response Center at 1-800-756-9018 (in the USA) or 1-888-923-8367 (in Canada). You will be asked to provide your password which you provided when you completed the subscriber agreement. 왘 Then return to your vehicle and pull the trunk recessed handle for a minimum of 20 seconds until the SOS button is flashing. The message Connecting call appears in the multifunction display. As an alternative, you may unlock the vehicle via Internet using the ID and password sent to you shortly after the completion of your acquaintance call. The Response Center will then unlock your vehicle with the remote door unlocking feature. i The remote door unlock feature is available Stolen Vehicle Recovery services In the event your vehicle was stolen: 왘 The police will issue a numbered incident report. if the relevant cellular phone network is available. The SOS button will flash and the message Connecting call will appear in the multifunction display to indicate receipt of the door unlock command. Once the vehicle is unlocked, a Response Center specialist may attempt to establish voice contact with the vehicle occupants. If the trunk recessed handle was pulled for more than 20 seconds before door unlock authorization was received by the Response Center, you must wait 15 minutes before pulling the trunk handle again. Report the incident to the police. 왘 Pass this number on to the Mercedes-Benz Response Center along with your password issued to you when you subscribed to the service. The Response Center will then attempt to covertly contact the vehicle’s Tele Aid system. Once the vehicle is located, the Response Center will contact the local law enforcement and you. The vehicle’s location will only be provided to law enforcement. i When the anti-theft alarm or the tow-away alarm stays on for more than 30 seconds, a call is initiated automatically to the Response Center. See “Anti-theft alarm system” (컄 page 90) and “Tow-away alarm” (컄 page 91). 269 Controls in detail Useful features Garage door opener* Warning! The integrated remote control is capable of operating up to three separately controlled devices. It provides a convenient way to replace up to three hand-held remote controls used to operate devices such as garage door openers, gate openers, or other devices compatible with HomeLink® or some other systems. Before the integrated remote control can be used, it must be programmed to the garage door opener, gate operator or other device you wish to operate. See the following instructions for programming information. 270 Overhead control panel with integrated remote control 1 Indicator lamp 2 3 4 Signal transmitter button Needed for programming (not part of vehicle equipment): 5 Hand-held remote control of garage door opener, gate operator or other device 6 Hand-held remote control button G Before programming the integrated remote control to a garage door opener or gate operator, make sure people and objects are out of the way of the device to prevent potential harm or damage. When programming a garage door opener, the door moves up or down. When programming a gate operator, the gate opens or closes. Do not use the integrated remote control with any garage door opener that lacks safety stop and reverse features as required by U.S. federal safety standards (this includes any garage door opener model manufactured before April 1, 1982). A garage door that cannot detect an object – signaling the door to stop and reverse – does not meet current U.S. federal safety standards. Controls in detail Useful features When programming a garage door opener, it is advised to park outside the garage. Do not run the engine while programming the integrated remote control. Inhalation of exhaust gas is hazardous to your health. All exhaust gas contains carbon monoxide (CO), and inhaling it can cause unconsciousness and possible death. Programming the integrated remote control Step 1: 왘 Switch on the ignition (컄 page 37). Step 2: Step 3: 왘 왘 If you have previously programmed a signal transmitter button and wish to retain its programming, proceed to step 3. If you are programming the integrated remote control for the first time, press and hold the two outer signal transmitter buttons 2 and 4 and release them only when indicator lamp 1 begins to flash after approximately 20 seconds (do not hold the button for longer than 30 seconds). This procedure erases any previous settings for all three channels and initializes the memory. If you later wish to program a second and/or third hand-held transmitter to the remaining two signal transmitter buttons, do not repeat this step and begin directly with step 3. Hold the end of hand-held remote control 5 of the device you wish to train approximately 2 to 5 in (5 to12 cm) away from the signal transmitter button (2, 3 or 4) to be programmed, while keeping indicator lamp 1 in view. Step 4: 왘 Using both hands, simultaneously press hand-held remote control button 6 and the desired signal transmitter button (2, 3 or 4). Do not release the buttons until step 5 is completed. Indicator lamp 1 will flash, first slowly and then rapidly. i Indicator lamp 1 flashes immediately the first time the signal transmitter button is programmed. If this button has already been programmed, the indicator lamp will only start 컄컄 flashing after 20 seconds. 271 Controls in detail Useful features 컄컄 Step 왘 5: After indicator lamp 1 changes from a slow to a rapidly flashing light, release the hand-held remote control button and the signal transmitter button. Step 6: 왘 Press and hold the just-trained signal transmitter button (2, 3 or 4) and observe indicator lamp 1. If indicator lamp 1 stays on constantly, programming is complete and your device should activate when the respective signal transmitter button (2, 3 or 4) is pressed and released. i If indicator lamp 1 flashes rapidly for about 2 seconds and then turns to a constant light, continue with programming steps 8 through 12 as your garage door opener may be equipped with the “rolling code” feature. Step 7: 왘 To program the remaining two signal transmitter buttons, repeat the steps above starting with step 3. 272 Rolling code programming Step 9: To train a garage door opener (or other rolling code devices) with the rolling code feature, follow these instructions after completing the “Programming” portion (steps 1 through 6) of this text. (A second person may make the following training procedures quicker and easier.) 왘 Step 8: 왘 Locate “training” button on the garage door opener motor head unit. Exact location and color of the button may vary by garage door opener brand. Depending on manufacturer, the “training” button may also be referred to as “learn”or “smart” button. If there is difficulty locating the transmitting button, refer to the garage door opener Operator’s Manual. Press the “training” button on the garage door opener motor head unit. The “training light” is activated. You have 30 seconds to initiate the following step. Step 10: 왘 Return to the vehicle and firmly press, hold for 2 seconds and release the programmed signal transmitter button (2, 3 or 4). Controls in detail Useful features Step 11: Gate operator/Canadian programming 왘 Canadian radio-frequency laws require transmitter signals to “time-out” (or quit) after several seconds of transmission which may not be long enough for the integrated signal transmitter to pick up the signal during programming. Similar to this Canadian law, some U.S. gate operators are designed to “time-out” in the same manner. Press, hold for 2 seconds and release same signal transmitter button a second time to complete the training process. i Some garage door openers (or other rolling code equipped devices) may require you to press, hold for 2 seconds and release the same signal transmitter button a third time to complete the training process. Step 12: 왘 Confirm the garage door operation by pressing the programmed signal transmitter button (2, 3 or 4). Step 13: 왘 To program the remaining two signal transmitter buttons, repeat the steps above starting with step 3. If you live in Canada or if you are having difficulties programming a gate operator (regardless of where you live) by using the programming procedures, replace step 4 with the following: Step 4: 왘 Press and hold the signal transmitter button (2, 3 or 4). Do not release this button until it has been successfully trained. 왘 While still holding down the signal transmitter button (2, 3 or 4), “cycle” your hand-held remote control button 6 as follows: Press and hold button 6 for 2 seconds, then release it for 2 seconds, and again press and hold it for 2 seconds. Repeat this sequence on the hand-held remote control until the frequency signal has been learned. Upon successful training, indicator lamp 1 will flash slowly and then rapidly after several seconds. 왘 Proceed with programming step 5 and step 6 to complete. i Upon completion of programming the integrated remote control, make sure you retain the hand-held remote control that came with the garage door opener, gate operator or other device. You may need it for use in other vehicles, for future programming of an integrated remote control, or simply for continued use as a hand-held remote control to operate the respective device in other situations. 273 Controls in detail Useful features Reprogramming a single signal transmitter button To program a device using a signal transmitter button previously trained, follow these steps: 왘 Switch on the ignition (컄 page 37). 왘 Press and hold the desired signal transmitter button (2, 3 or 4). Do not release the button. 왘 Indicator lamp 1 will begin to flash after 20 seconds. Without releasing the signal transmitter button, proceed with programming starting with step 3. 274 Operation of integrated remote control 왘 Switch on the ignition (컄 page 37). 왘 Select and press the appropriate integrated signal transmitter button (2, 3 or 4) to activate the remote controlled device. The integrated remote control transmitter continues to send the signal as long as the button is pressed – up to 20 seconds. Erasing the integrated remote control memory 왘 Switch on the ignition (컄 page 37). 왘 Simultaneously press and hold outer signal transmitter buttons 2 and 4, for approximately 20 seconds, until indicator lamp 1 flashes rapidly. Do not hold for longer than 30 seconds. The codes of all three channels are erased. i If you sell your vehicle, erase the codes of all three channels. Controls in detail Useful features Programming tips 앫 If you are having difficulty programming the integrated remote control, here are some helpful tips: 앫 앫 앫 Check the frequency of the hand-held remote control 5 (typically located on the reverse side of the remote). The integrated remote control is compatible with radio-frequency devices operating between 280-390 MHz. Put a new battery in hand-held remote control 5. This will increase the likelihood of the hand-held remote control sending a faster and more accurate signal to the integrated remote control. While performing step 3, hold hand-held remote control 5 at different lengths and angles from the signal transmitter button (2, 3 or 4) you are programming. Attempt varying angles at the distance of 2 to 5 in (5 to 12 cm) away or the same angle at varying distances. 앫 If another hand-held remote control is available for the same device, try the programming steps again using that other hand-held remote control. Make sure new batteries are in the hand-held remote control before beginning the procedure. Straighten the antenna wire from the garage door opener assembly. This may help improve transmitting and/or receiving signals. i Certain types of garage door openers are incompatible with the integrated remote control. If you should experience further difficulties with programming the integrated remote control, contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center, or call Mercedes-Benz Customer Assistance Center (in the USA only) at 1-800-FOR-MERCedes, or Customer Service (in Canada) at 1-800-387-0100. i USA only: This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1) This device may not cause harmful interference, and (2) this device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation. Any unauthorized modification to this device could void the user’s authority to operate the equipment. i Canada only: This device complies with RSS-210 of Industry Canada. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1) This device may not cause interference, and (2) this device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation of the device. Any unauthorized modification to this device could void the user’s authority to operate the equipment. 275 Controls in detail Useful features Heated steering wheel* (SLK 280, SLK 350, Canada only) Switching on Switching off 왘 Switch on the ignition (컄 page 37). 왘 The steering wheel heating warms up the leather area of the steering wheel. 왘 Turn switch at tip of stalk in direction of arrow 1 and release it. The steering wheel is heated. Indicator lamp 2 comes on. The stalk is located on the lower left-hand side of the steering wheel. i The steering wheel heating is temporarily suspended while indicator lamp 2 remains on when 앫 the temperature of the vehicle interior is above 86°F (30°C) 앫 the temperature of the steering wheel is above 95°F (35°C) When these conditions do not apply anymore, steering wheel heating continues. 1 Switching on 2 Indicator lamp 3 Switching off 276 Turn switch at tip of stalk in direction of arrow 3 and release it. The steering wheel heating is switched off. Indicator lamp 2 goes out. i Indicator lamp 2 flashes or switches off in case of 앫 power surge or undervoltage 앫 steering wheel heating malfunction i The steering wheel heating switches off automatically when you remove the SmartKey from the starter switch. Operation The first 1000 miles (1500 km) Driving instructions At the gas station Engine compartment Tires and wheels Winter driving Maintenance Vehicle care 277 Operation The first 1000 miles (1500 km) In the “Operation” section you will find detailed information on operating, maintaining and caring for your vehicle. The more cautiously you treat your vehicle during the break-in period, the more satisfied you will be with its performance later on. 앫 앫 Drive your vehicle during the first 1000 miles (1500 km) at varying but moderate vehicle and engine speeds. After 1000 miles (1500 km), you may gradually increase vehicle and engine speeds to the permissible maximum. 앫 During this period, avoid heavy loads (full throttle driving) and excessive engine speeds (no more than 2/3 of maximum rpm in each gear). ! Additional instructions for SLK 55 AMG: 앫 278 Vehicles with automatic transmission*: Do not attempt to slow the vehicle down by shifting to a lower gear using the gear selector lever*. 앫 Shift gears in a timely manner. 앫 Avoid accelerating by kickdown. 앫 Vehicles with automatic transmission*: Select gear 3, 2, or 1 (컄 page 160) only when driving at moderate speeds (for hill driving). Vehicles with automatic transmission*: Select C as the preferred shift program (컄 page 161) for the first 1000 miles (1500 km). 앫 During the first 1000 miles (1500 km), do not exceed a speed of 85 mph (140 km/h). 앫 During this period, avoid engine speeds above 4500 rpm in each gear. All of the above instructions, as may apply to your vehicle type, also apply when driving the first 1000 miles (1500 km) after the engine or the rear differential has been replaced. i Always obey applicable speed limits. Operation Driving instructions 왔 Driving instructions Drive sensibly – save fuel Fuel consumption, to a great extent, depends on driving habits and operating conditions. To save fuel you should: 앫 Keep tires at the recommended inflation pressures. 앫 Remove unnecessary loads. 앫 Allow engine to warm up under low load use. 앫 Avoid frequent acceleration and deceleration. 앫 Have all maintenance work performed at the intervals specified in the Maintenance Booklet and as required by the Maintenance System. Contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. Drinking and driving Warning! Pedals G Drinking and driving and/or taking drugs and driving are very dangerous combinations. Even a small amount of alcohol or drugs can affect your reflexes, perceptions and judgment. The possibility of a serious or even fatal accident are greatly increased when you drink or take drugs and drive. Do not drink or take drugs and drive or allow anyone to drive who has been drinking or taking drugs. Warning! G Make sure that absolutely no objects are obstructing the pedal’s range of movement. Keep the driver’s footwell clear of all obstacles. If there are any floormats or carpets in the footwell, make sure the pedals still have sufficient clearance. During sudden driving or braking maneuvers, the objects could get caught between the pedals. You could then no longer brake or accelerate. This could lead to accidents and injury. Fuel consumption is also increased by driving in cold weather, in stop-and-go traffic, on short trips and in hilly area. 279 Operation Driving instructions Power assistance Warning! ! Because the ESP® operates automatically, Brakes G With the engine not running, there is no power assistance for the brake and steering systems. In this case, it is important to keep in mind that a considerably higher degree of effort is necessary to brake and steer the vehicle. Warning! G After driving in heavy rain for some time without applying the brakes or through water deep enough to wet brake components or salty road conditions, the first braking action may be somewhat reduced and increased pedal pressure may be necessary to obtain expected braking effect. Maintain a safe distance from vehicles in front. Resting your foot on the brake pedal will cause excessive and premature wear of the brake pads. It can also result in the brakes overheating, thereby significantly reducing their effectiveness. It may not be possible to stop the vehicle in sufficient time to avoid an accident. 280 the engine must be turned off (SmartKey in starter switch position 0 or 1) when 앫 the parking brake is being tested on a brake test dynamometer 앫 the vehicle is being towed with the front axle raised Active braking action through the ESP® may otherwise seriously damage the brake system. To help prevent brake disc corrosion after driving on wet road surfaces (particularly salted roads), it is advisable to brake the vehicle with considerable force prior to parking. The heat generated serves to dry the brakes. If your brake system is normally only subjected to moderate loads, you should occasionally test the effectiveness of the brakes by applying above-normal braking pressure at higher speeds. This will also enhance the grip of the brake pads. Operation Driving instructions Warning! G Make sure not to endanger any other road users when carrying out these braking maneuvers. Refer to the description of the Brake Assist System (BAS) (컄 page 86). Brake pad wear or a leak in the system may be the reason for low brake fluid in the reservoir. The brake fluid level in the reservoir may be too low if the brake warning lamp in the instrument cluster (컄 page 26) comes on although the parking brake is released (컄 page 348). Observe additional messages that may appear in the multifunction display (컄 page 367). Have the brake system inspected immediately. Contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. All checks and service work on the brake system should be carried out by qualified technicians only. Contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. Install only brake pads and brake fluid recommended by Mercedes-Benz. Warning! G If other than recommended brake pads are installed, or other than recommended brake fluid is used, the braking properties of the vehicle can be degraded to an extent that safe braking is substantially impaired. This could result in an accident. ! When driving down long and steep grades, relieve the load on the brakes by shifting into a lower gear to use the engine’s braking power. This helps prevent overheating of the brakes and reduces brake pad wear. High-performance brake system (SLK 55 AMG only) The high-performance brake system is designed to operate under the extremely high operating demands required to accommodate the performance capabilities of the vehicle. The brakes may produce a squeaking-type noise depending on the 앫 vehicle speed 앫 brake force applied 앫 ambient conditions, e.g. temperature and humidity As with any brake system, the wear of individual brake system components such as brake pads or discs strongly depends on your driving style and the conditions under which you operate the vehicle. Thus, a driving style calling for high demand braking will cause your vehicle’s brakes to wear more quickly. After hard braking, it is advisable to drive on for some time, rather than immediately park, so that the air stream will cool down the brakes faster. 281 Operation Driving instructions Warning! G New vehicle brake pads and discs, and replacement brake pads and discs may take several hundred miles of driving until they provide optimum braking efficiency. Until that time, you may need to use increased brake pedal pressure while braking. Please be aware of this and adjust your driving and braking accordingly during this break-in period. Excessive high demand braking will cause correspondingly high brake wear. Please be attentive to the brake warning lamp in the instrument cluster and brake condition messages in the multifunction display. Especially for high performance driving, it is important to maintain the brake system and have it checked regularly. 282 Driving off Apply the brakes to test them briefly after driving off. Perform this procedure only when the road is clear of other traffic. Warm up the engine smoothly. Do not place full load on the engine until the operating temperature has been reached. ! When starting off on a slippery surface, do not allow a drive wheel to spin for an extended period with the ESP® switched off. Doing so may cause serious damage to the drivetrain which is not covered by the Mercedes-Benz Limited Warranty. Parking Warning! G Do not park this vehicle in areas where combustible materials such as grass, hay or leaves can come into contact with the hot exhaust system, as these materials could be ignited and cause a vehicle fire. To reduce the risk of personal injury or damage to the vehicle drivetrain as a result of vehicle movement, before turning off the engine and leaving the vehicle always: ! Simultaneously depressing the accelerator 앫 Keep right foot on brake pedal. pedal and applying the brake reduces engine performance and causes premature brake and drivetrain wear. 앫 Pull the parking brake lever up as many notches as possible. 앫 Manual transmission: Move the gearshift lever into first or reverse gear. 앫 Automatic transmission*: Move the gear selector lever to position P. Operation Driving instructions 앫 Slowly release brake pedal. 앫 When parked on an incline, turn front wheels towards the road curb. 앫 Turn the SmartKey in the starter switch to position 0 and remove. 앫 Take the SmartKey with you and lock vehicle when leaving. Tires Warning! The treadwear indicator appears as a solid band across the tread. G If you feel a sudden significant vibration or ride disturbance, or you suspect that possible damage to your vehicle has occurred, you should turn on the hazard warning flashers, carefully slow down, and drive with caution to an area which is a safe distance from the road. Inspect the tires and the vehicle undercarriage for possible damage. If the vehicle or tires appear unsafe, have the vehicle towed to the nearest Mercedes-Benz Center or tire dealer for repairs. Treadwear indicators (TWI) are required by law. These indicators are located in six places on the tread circumference and become visible at a tread depth of approximately 1/16 in (1.6 mm), at which point the tire is considered worn and should be replaced. Warning! G Although the applicable federal motor vehicle safety laws consider a tire to be worn when the treadwear indicators (TWI) become visible at approximately 1/16 in (1.6 mm), we recommend that you do not allow your tires to wear down to that level. As tread depth approaches 1/8 in (3.0 mm), the adhesion properties on a wet road are sharply reduced. Depending upon the weather and/or road surface (conditions), the tire traction varies widely. Specified tire inflation pressures must be maintained. This applies particularly if the tires are subject to high loads (e.g. high speeds, heavy loads, high ambient temperatures). 283 Operation Driving instructions Warning! G Do not drive with a flat tire. A flat tire affects the ability to steer or brake the vehicle. You may lose control of the vehicle. Continued driving with a flat tire or driving at high speed with a flat tire will cause excessive heat build-up and possibly a fire. For more information, see “Tires and wheels” (컄 page 304). Hydroplaning Depending on the depth of the water layer on the road, hydroplaning may occur, even at low speeds and with new tires. Reduce vehicle speed, avoid track grooves in the road and apply brakes cautiously in the rain. 284 Tire traction The safe speed on a wet, snow-covered or icy road is always lower than on a dry road. You should pay particular attention to the condition of the road whenever the outside temperatures are close to the freezing point. Warning! G If ice has formed on the road, tire traction will be substantially reduced. Under such weather conditions, drive, steer and brake with extreme caution. Mercedes-Benz recommends winter tires (컄 page 332) with a minimum tread depth of approximately 1/6 in (4 mm) on all four wheels for the winter season to ensure normal balanced handling characteristics. On packed snow, they can reduce your stopping distance as compared with summer tires. Stopping distance, however, is still considerably greater than when the road is not covered with snow or ice. Exercise appropriate caution. ! Avoid spinning of a drive wheel. This may cause serious damage to the drivetrain which is not covered by the Mercedes-Benz Limited Warranty. Operation Driving instructions Tire speed rating An electronic speed limiter prevents your vehicle from exceeding a speed of: Regardless of the tire speed rating, local speed limits should be obeyed. Use prudent driving speeds appropriate to prevailing conditions. Warning! G 앫 앫 Even when permitted by law, never operate a vehicle at speeds greater than the maximum speed rating of the tires. Exceeding the maximum speed for which tires are rated can lead to sudden tire failure, causing loss of vehicle control and possibly resulting in an accident and/or personal injury and possible death, for you and for others. 앫 SLK 280 SLK 280 (Sport Package*) SLK 280 (Appearance Package*): 149 mph (240 km/h) SLK 350 SLK 350 (Sport Package*) SLK 350 (Appearance Package*) SLK 55 AMG: 155 mph (250 km/h) SLK 55 AMG (Performance Package*): 174 mph (280 km/h) For information on how to identify the tire speed rating on a tire’s sidewall, see “Tire size designation, load and speed rating” (컄 page 318). If you are uncertain about the correct reading of the information given on a tire’s sidewall, any authorized Mercedes-Benz Center will be glad to assist you. i For information on speed rating for winter tires, see “Winter tires” (컄 page 332). For additional general information on tire speed markings on tire sidewall, see “Tire speed rating” (컄 page 318). The factory equipped tires on your vehicle may have a tire speed rating above the maximum speed permitted by the electronic speed limiter. Make sure your tires have the required tire speed rating as specified for your vehicle in the “Technical data” section (컄 page 434), for example when purchasing new tires. 285 Operation Driving instructions Winter driving instructions The most important rule for slippery or icy roads is to drive sensibly and to avoid abrupt acceleration, braking and steering maneuvers. Do not use the cruise control system under such conditions. When the vehicle is in danger of skidding, move gear selector lever* to position N or declutch in case of manual transmission. Try to keep the vehicle under control by corrective steering action. Road salts and chemicals can adversely affect braking efficiency. Increased pedal force may become necessary to produce the normal brake effect. Depressing the brake pedal periodically when traveling at length on salt-strewn roads can bring road-salt-impaired braking efficiency back to normal. If the vehicle is parked after being driven on salt-treated roads, the braking efficiency should be tested as soon as possible after driving is resumed. Warning! G If the vehicle becomes stuck in snow, make sure snow is kept clear of the exhaust pipe and from around the vehicle with the engine running. Otherwise, deadly carbon monoxide (CO) gases may enter the vehicle interior, resulting in unconsciousness and death. To assure sufficient fresh air ventilation, open a window slightly on the side of the vehicle not facing the wind. i For information on driving with snow chains, see “Snow chains” (컄 page 333). Warning! Warning! G On slippery road surfaces, never downshift in order to obtain braking action. This could result in drive wheel slip and reduced vehicle control. Your vehicle’s ABS will not prevent this type of control loss. G Make sure not to endanger any other road users when carrying out these braking maneuvers. Warning! G The outside temperature indicator is not designed to serve as an ice-warning device and is therefore unsuitable for that purpose. Indicated temperatures just above the freezing point do not guarantee that the road surface is free of ice. For more information, see “Winter driving” (컄 page 332). 286 Operation Driving instructions Standing water ! Do not drive through flooded areas or water of unknown depth. Before driving through water, determine its depth. Never accelerate before driving into water. The bow wave could force water into the engine and auxiliary equipment, thus damaging them. If you must drive through standing water, drive slowly to prevent water from entering the passenger compartment or the engine compartment. Water in these areas could cause damage to electrical components or wiring of the engine or transmission, or could result in water being ingested by the engine through the air intake, causing severe internal engine damage. Any such damage is not covered by the Mercedes-Benz Limited Warranty. Control and operation of radio transmitter Passenger compartment Warning! G COMAND*, radio, and telephone* Always fasten items being carried as securely as possible. Warning! In an accident, during hard braking or sudden maneuvers, loose items will be thrown around inside the vehicle, and cause injury to vehicle occupants unless the items are securely fastened in the vehicle. Please do not forget that your primary responsibility is to drive the vehicle safely. Only operate the COMAND*, radio or telephone1 if road, traffic and weather conditions permit. The trunk is the preferred place to carry objects. Bear in mind that at a speed of just 30 mph (approximately 50 km/h), your vehicle is covering a distance of 44 feet (approximately 14 m) every second. Driving abroad Abroad, there is an extensive Mercedes-Benz service network at your disposal. If you plan to drive into areas which are not listed in the index of your Mercedes-Benz Center directory, you should request pertinent information from an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. G 1 Observe all legal requirements. 287 Operation Driving instructions Telephones and two-way radios Catalytic converter Warning! Warning! G Never operate radio transmitters equipped with a built-in or attached antenna (i.e. without being connected to an external antenna) from inside the vehicle while the engine is running. Doing so could lead to a malfunction of the vehicle’s electronic system, possibly resulting in an accident and/or personal injury. Radio transmitters, such as a portable telephone or a citizens band unit should only be used inside the vehicle if they are connected to an antenna that is installed on the outside of the vehicle. Refer to the radio transmitter operation instructions regarding use of an external antenna. 288 Your Mercedes-Benz is equipped with monolithic-type catalytic converters, an important element in conjunction with the oxygen sensors to achieve substantial control of the pollutants in the exhaust emissions. Keep your vehicle in proper operating condition by following our recommended maintenance instructions as outlined in your Maintenance Booklet. ! To prevent damage to the catalytic converters, use only premium unleaded gasoline in this vehicle. Any noticeable irregularities in engine operation should be repaired promptly. Otherwise, excessive unburned fuel may reach the catalytic converter, causing it to overheat and potentially start a fire. G As with any vehicle, do not idle, park or operate this vehicle in areas where combustible materials such as grass, hay or leaves can come into contact with the hot exhaust system, as these materials could be ignited and cause a vehicle fire. Operation Driving instructions Emission control Warning! Certain engine systems serve to keep the toxic components of the exhaust gases within permissible limits required by law. These systems, of course, will function properly only when maintained strictly according to factory specifications. Any adjustments on the engine should therefore only be carried out by qualified Mercedes-Benz Center authorized technicians. Engine adjustments should not be altered in any way. Moreover, the specified service jobs must be carried out regularly according to Mercedes-Benz servicing requirements. For details refer to the Maintenance Booklet. G Inhalation of exhaust gas is hazardous to your health. All exhaust gas contains carbon monoxide (CO), and inhaling it can cause unconsciousness and possible death. Do not run the engine in confined areas (such as a garage) which are not properly ventilated. If you think that exhaust gas fumes are entering the vehicle while driving, have the cause determined and corrected immediately. If you must drive under these conditions, drive only with at least one window fully open at all times. Coolant temperature Warning! G 앫 Driving when your engine is overheated can cause some fluids, which may have leaked into the engine compartment, to catch fire. You could be seriously burned. 앫 Steam from an overheated engine can cause serious burns and can occur just by opening the hood. Stay away from the engine if you see or hear steam coming from it. Turn off the engine, get out of the vehicle and do not stand near the vehicle until the engine has cooled down. 289 Operation Driving instructions ! Excessive coolant temperature triggers a warning message in the multifunction display (컄 page 368). The engine should not be operated with a coolant temperature above 248°F (120°C). Doing so may cause serious engine damage which is not covered by the Mercedes-Benz Limited Warranty. i During severe operating conditions, e.g. stop-and-go city traffic, the coolant temperature may rise close to 248°F (120°C). 290 Operation At the gas station 왔 At the gas station Refueling Warning! G i In case that the central locking system does 왘 not release the fuel filler flap, or the opening mechanism is clamping, contact Roadside Assistance or an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. Turn fuel filler cap counterclockwise and hold on to it until possible pressure is released. 왘 Take off fuel filler cap and set it in direction of arrow 2 in the recess on the inside of fuel filler flap. Gasoline is highly flammable and poisonous. It burns violently and can cause serious personal injury. To prevent fuel vapors from escaping into open air, fully insert filler nozzle unit. Never allow sparks, flame or smoking materials near gasoline! 왘 Turn off the engine before refueling. Whenever you are around gasoline, avoid inhaling fumes and skin contact, extinguish all smoking materials. Direct skin contact with fuels and the inhalation of fuel vapors are damaging to your health. The fuel filler flap is located on the right-hand side of the vehicle towards the rear. Locking and unlocking the vehicle with the SmartKey automatically locks and unlocks the fuel filler flap. 1 To open fuel filler flap 2 To insert fuel filler cap 왘 Remove the SmartKey from the starter switch. 왘 Open fuel filler flap by pushing at point indicated by arrow 1. The fuel filler flap springs open. Only fill your tank until the filler nozzle unit cuts out – do not top off or overfill. Warning! G Overfilling of the fuel tank may create pressure in the system which could cause a gas discharge. This could cause the gas to spray back out when removing the fuel pump nozzle, which could cause personal injury. 왘 Replace the fuel filler cap by turning it clockwise until it audibly engages. 컄컄 291 Operation At the gas station 컄컄 i Make sure to close the fuel filler flap before Check regularly and before a long trip locking your vehicle as the flap locking pin prevents closing after you have locked the vehicle. 왘 For information on refilling the reservoir, see “Windshield washer system and headlamp cleaning system*” (컄 page 302). Close the fuel filler flap. i Only use premium unleaded gasoline with a minimum Posted Octane Rating of 91 (average of 96 RON/86 MON). Information on gasoline quality can normally be found on the fuel pump. Please contact gas station personnel in case labels on the pump cannot be found. For more information on gasoline, see “Premium unleaded gasoline” (컄 page 446), refer to the Factory Approved Service Products pamphlet (USA only), or contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz-Center. i Leaving the engine running and the fuel cap open can cause the yellow fuel tank reserve warning lamp to flash and the ? malfunction indicator lamp (USA only) or the ± malfunction indicator lamp (Canada only) to illuminate. For more information, see “Practical hints” (컄 page 349). 292 Windshield washer system and headlamp cleaning system* Brake fluid ! If you find that the brake fluid in the brake Engine compartment (example illustration, SLK 350) 1 Windshield washer system and headlamp cleaning system* reservoir 2 Brake fluid reservoir 3 Coolant expansion tank i For opening the hood, see “Hood” (컄 page 294). fluid reservoir has fallen to the minimum mark or below, have the brake system checked for brake pad thickness and leaks immediately. Notify an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center immediately. Do not add brake fluid as this will not solve the problem. For more information, see “Practical hints” (컄 page 348). For information on brake fluid, see “Fuels, coolants, lubricants, etc.” (컄 page 443). Operation At the gas station Coolant Vehicle lighting For normal replenishing, use water (potable water quality). Check function and cleanliness. For more information on coolant, see “Coolant level” (컄 page 300) and “Fuels, coolants, lubricants, etc.” (컄 page 443). Engine oil level For information on engine oil, see “Engine oil” (컄 page 296). For more information on vehicle lighting, see “Replacing bulbs” (컄 page 393). For information on switching on the exterior lighting, see “Exterior lamp switch” (컄 page 109). Tire inflation pressure For information on tire inflation pressure, see “Important notes on tire inflation pressure” (컄 page 313). 293 Operation Engine compartment Hood Warning! Warning! G Do not pull the release lever while the vehicle is in motion. Otherwise the hood could be forced open by passing air flow. This could cause the hood to come loose and injure you and/or others. You could be injured when the hood is open – even when the engine is turned off. Parts of the engine can become very hot. To prevent burns, let the engine cool of completely before touching any components on the vehicle. Comply with all relevant safety precautions. Opening Warning! Warning! G If you see flames or smoke coming from the engine compartment, or if the coolant temperature gauge indicates that the engine is overheated, do not open the hood. Move away from the vehicle and do not open the hood until the engine has cooled. If necessary, call the fire department. G G Warning! The engine is equipped with a transistorized ignition system. Because of the high voltage it is dangerous to touch any components (ignition coils, spark plug sockets, diagnostic socket) of the ignition system 앫 with the engine running 앫 while starting the engine 앫 if ignition is “on” and the engine is turned manually To help prevent personal injury, stay clear of moving parts when the hood is open and the engine is running. The radiator fan may continue to run for approximately 30 seconds or may even restart after the engine has been turned off. Stay clear of fan blades. 1 Hood lock release lever 294 G Operation Engine compartment 왘 Pull hood lock release lever 1 in direction of arrow. The hood is unlocked. ! To avoid damage to the windshield wipers or hood, never open the hood if the wiper arms are folded forward away from the windshield. 왘 With the hood released, lift the hood by lifting it at the front edge. The hood will be automatically held open at shoulder height by gas-filled struts. Closing Warning! G 왘 Let the hood drop from a height of approximately 1 ft (30 cm). The hood will lock audibly. 왘 Check to make sure the hood is fully closed. If you can raise the hood at a point above the headlamps, then it is not properly closed. Open it again and let it drop with somewhat greater force. When closing the hood, use extreme caution not to catch hand or fingers. Be careful that you do not close the hood on anyone. 2 Lever for opening the hood 왘 Push lever 2 on the hood upward to release hood. Make sure the hood is securely engaged before driving. Do not continue driving if the hood can no longer engage after an accident for example. The hood could otherwise come loose while the vehicle is in motion and injure you and/or others. 295 Operation Engine compartment Engine oil The amount of oil your engine needs will depend on a number of factors, including driving style. Higher oil consumption can occur when 앫 the vehicle is new 앫 the vehicle is driven frequently at higher engine speeds Engine oil consumption checks should only be made after the vehicle break-in period. ! Do not use any special lubricant additives, as these may damage the drive assemblies. Using special additives not approved by Mercedes-Benz may cause damage not covered by the Mercedes-Benz Limited Warranty. More information on this subject is available at any authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. 296 Checking engine oil level with the control system (SLK 55 AMG only) To check the engine oil level via the multifunction display, do the following: When checking the oil level 왘 앫 the vehicle must be parked on level ground. 앫 with the engine at operating temperature, the vehicle must have been stationary for at least 5 minutes with the engine turned off. 앫 with the engine not at operating temperature, the vehicle must have been stationary for at least 30 minutes with the engine turned off. Switch on the ignition (컄 page 37). The standard display appears in the multifunction display (컄 page 127). 왘 Press button k or j on the multifunction steering wheel repeatedly until the following message appears in the multifunction display (컄 page 122): Operation Engine compartment One of the following messages will subsequently appear in the multifunction display: 앫 Engine oil level OK 앫 Add 1.0 qt. (Canada: 1.0 liter) to reach max. oil level 앫 Add 1.5 qts. (Canada: 1.5 liters) to reach max. oil level 앫 Add 2.0 qts. (Canada: 2.0 liters) to reach max. oil level i If you want to interrupt the checking procedure, press button k or j on the multifunction steering wheel (컄 page 122). 왘 Other display messages If you see the message: If the ignition is not switched on, the following message will appear: Cannot check engine level with engine on Turn on ignition to see engine oil level 왘 Turn off the engine. 왘 If the engine is at operating temperature, wait 5 minutes before checking oil. 왘 If the engine is not at operating temperature yet, you must wait 30 minutes before checking oil. 왘 Switch on the ignition (컄 page 37). If you see the message: Observe waiting time 왘 왘 If engine is at operating temperature, wait 5 minutes before repeating check procedure. If engine is not at operating temperature yet, you must wait 30 minutes before checking oil. i If you want to interrupt the checking procedure, press button k or j on the multifunction steering wheel (컄 page 122). If necessary, add engine oil. For adding engine oil, see “Adding engine oil” (컄 page 299). For more information on engine oil, see “Fuels, coolants, lubricants, etc.” (컄 page 443). 297 Operation Engine compartment If there is excess engine oil with the engine at normal operating temperature, the following message will appear: Engine oil level Reduce oil level 왘 Have excess oil siphoned or drained off. Contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. ! Excess oil must be siphoned or drained off. It could cause damage to the engine and catalytic converter not covered by the Mercedes-Benz Limited Warranty. For more information on messages in the display concerning engine oil, see the “Practical hints” section (컄 page 356). 298 Checking engine oil level with the oil dipstick (SLK 280, SLK 350 only) When checking the oil level 앫 the vehicle must be parked on level ground. 앫 with the engine at operating temperature, the vehicle must have been stationary for at least 5 minutes with the engine turned off. 앫 with the engine not at operating temperature, the vehicle must have been stationary for at least 30 minutes with the engine turned off. 1 Oil dipstick 2 Upper (max) mark 3 Lower (min) mark To check the engine oil level with the oil dipstick, do the following: 왘 Open the hood (컄 page 294). 왘 Pull out oil dipstick 1. 왘 Wipe oil dipstick 1 clean. 왘 Fully insert oil dipstick 1 into the dipstick guide tube. Operation Engine compartment 왘 Pull out oil dipstick 1 again after approximately 3 seconds to obtain accurate reading. The oil level is correct when it is between the lower (min) mark 3 and upper (max) mark 2 of oil dipstick 1. i The filling quantity between the upper and lower marks on the oil dipstick is approximately 2.1 US qt. (2.0 l). 왘 If necessary, add engine oil. For adding engine oil, see “Adding engine oil” (컄 page 299). For more information on engine oil, see “Fuels, coolants, lubricants, etc.” (컄 page 443). For more information on messages in the multifunction display concerning engine oil, see the “Practical hints” section (컄 page 356). Adding engine oil Only use approved engine oils and oil filters required for vehicles with Maintenance System. For a listing of approved engine oils and oil filters, refer to the Factory Approved Service Products pamphlet (USA only) in your vehicle literature portfolio, or contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. Using engine oils and oil filters of specification other than those expressly required for the Maintenance System, or changing of oil and oil filter at change intervals longer than those called for by the Maintenance System will result in engine or emission control system damage not covered by the Mercedes-Benz Limited Warranty. SLK 350 (example illustration) 1 Filler cap SLK 55 AMG 1 Filler cap 299 Operation Engine compartment 왘 Unscrew filler cap 1 from filler neck. 왘 Add engine oil as required. Be careful not to overfill with oil. Be careful not to spill any oil when adding. Avoid environmental damage caused by oil entering the ground or water. ! Excess oil must be siphoned or drained off. It could cause damage to the engine and emission control system not covered by the Mercedes-Benz Limited Warranty. 왘 Screw filler cap 1 back on filler neck. For more information on engine oil, see “Technical data” (컄 page 443) and (컄 page 445). 300 Transmission fluid level* Coolant level Vehicles with automatic transmission*: The transmission fluid level does not need to be checked. If you notice transmission fluid loss or gear shifting malfunctions, have an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center check the transmission. The engine coolant is a mixture of water and anticorrosion/antifreeze. To check the coolant level, the vehicle must be parked on level ground and the engine must be cool. Warning! G In order to avoid any potentially serious burns: 앫 Use extreme caution when opening the hood if there are any signs of steam or coolant leaking from the cooling system, or if the coolant temperature gauge indicates that the coolant is overheated. 앫 Do not remove pressure cap on coolant reservoir if coolant temperature is above 158°F (70°C). Allow engine to cool down before removing cap. The coolant reservoir contains hot fluid and is under pressure. Operation Engine compartment 앫 앫 Using a rag, slowly open the cap approximately 1/2 turn to relieve excess pressure. If opened immediately, scalding hot fluid and steam will be blown out under pressure. The coolant expansion tank is located on the passenger side of the engine compartment. 왘 Using a rag, turn cap 2 slowly approximately one half turn counterclockwise to release any excess pressure. 왘 Continue turning cap 2 counterclockwise and remove it. Do not spill antifreeze on hot engine parts. Antifreeze contains ethylene glycol which may burn if it comes into contact with hot engine parts. The coolant level is correct if the level SLK 350 (example illustration) 1 Coolant expansion tank 2 Cap 3 Marking bar in the expansion tank 앫 for cold coolant: reaches marking bar 3 in expansion tank 1 앫 for warm coolant: is approximately 0.6 in (1.5 cm) higher 왘 Add coolant as required. 왘 Replace and tighten cap 2. For more information on coolant, see “Coolants” (컄 page 448). 301 Operation Engine compartment Windshield washer system and headlamp cleaning system* The windshield washer reservoir is located on the passenger side of the engine compartment. During all seasons, add MB Windshield Washer Concentrate “MB SummerFit” to water. Premix the windshield washer fluid in a suitable container. Warning! G Washer solvent/antifreeze is highly flammable. Do not spill washer solvent/antifreeze on hot engine parts, because it may ignite and burn. You could be seriously burned. 왘 Use the tab to pull cap 1 upwards. 왘 Refill the reservoir with MB Windshield Washer Concentrate “MB SummerFit” and water (or commercially available premixed windshield washer solvent/antifreeze, depending on ambient temperatures). ! Always use washer solvent/antifreeze where temperatures may fall below freezing point. Failure to do so could result in damage to the washer system/reservoir. ! Only use washer fluid which is suitable for plastic lenses. Improper washer fluid can damage the plastic lenses of the headlamps. SLK 350 (example illustration) 1 Cap for windshield washer reservoir Fluid for the windshield washer system and the headlamp cleaning system* is supplied from the windshield washer reservoir. It has a capacity of approximately 7.4 US qt (7 l). 302 For more information, see “Windshield washer system and headlamp cleaning system*” (컄 page 450). Operation Engine compartment Battery G Warning! Your vehicle’s battery is located in the engine compartment. The battery should always be sufficiently charged in order to achieve its rated service life. Refer to the Maintenance Booklet for battery maintenance intervals. If you use your vehicle mostly for short-distance trips, you will need to have the battery charge checked more frequently. When replacing the battery, always use batteries approved by Mercedes-Benz. If you do not intend to operate your vehicle for an extended period of time, consult an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center about steps you need to observe. Observe all safety instructions and precautions when handling automotive batteries. Wear eye protection. Rinse any acid spills immediately with clear water. Contact a physician if necessary. Risk of explosion. Keep children away. Fire, open flames and smoking are prohibited when handling batteries. Avoid creating sparks. Battery acid is caustic. Do not allow it to come into contact with skin, eyes or clothing. Wear suitable protective clothing, especially gloves, apron and faceguard. Follow the instructions in this Operator’s Manual. Batteries contain materials that can harm the environment if disposed of improperly. Recycling of batteries is the preferred method of disposal. Many states require sellers of batteries to accept old batteries for recycling. 303 Operation Tires and wheels Contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center for information on tested and recommended rims and tires for summer and winter operation. They can also offer advice concerning tire service and purchase. Warning! G Replace rims or tires with the same designation, manufacturer and type as shown on the original part. Contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center for further information. If incorrectly sized rims and tires are mounted: 앫 The wheel brakes or suspension components can be damaged. 앫 The operating clearance of the wheels and the tires may no longer be correct. 304 Warning! G Worn, old tires can cause accidents. If the tire tread is badly worn, or if the tires have sustained damage, replace them. When replacing rims, only use genuine Mercedes-Benz wheel bolts specified for the particular rim type. Failure to do so can result in the bolts loosening and may lead to an accident. Retreaded tires are not tested or recommended by Mercedes-Benz, since previous damage cannot always be recognized on retreads. Mercedes-Benz therefore cannot assure the operating safety of the vehicle when such tires are used. Important guidelines 앫 Only use sets of tires and rims of the same type and make. 앫 Tires must be of the correct size for the rim. 앫 Break in new tires for approximately 60 miles (100 km) at moderate speeds. 앫 Regularly check the tires and rims for damage. Dented or bent rims can cause tire inflation pressure loss or damage the tire beads. 앫 If vehicle is heavily loaded, check tire inflation pressure and correct as required. 앫 Do not allow your tires to wear down too far. Adhesion properties on wet roads are sharply reduced at tread depths of less than 1/8 in (3 mm). 앫 When replacing individual tires, you should mount new tires on the front wheels first (on vehicles with same-sized wheels all around). Operation Tires and wheels Tire care and maintenance Warning! G Regularly check the tires for damage. Damaged tires can cause tire inflation pressure loss. As a result, you could lose control of your vehicle. Worn, old tires can cause accidents. If the tire tread is badly worn, or if the tires have sustained damage, replace them. Regularly check your tire inflation pressure at least once a month. For more information on checking tire inflation pressure, see “Recommended tire inflation pressure” (컄 page 312). Tire inspection Life of tire Every time you check your tire inflation pressure, you should also inspect your tires for the following: The service life of a tire is dependent upon varying factors including but not limited to: 앫 excessive treadwear (컄 page 306) 앫 cord or fabric showing through the tire’s rubber 앫 bumps, bulges, cuts, cracks or splits in the tread or side of the tire Replace the tire if you find any of the above conditions. 앫 Driving style 앫 Tire inflation pressure 앫 Distance driven Warning! G Tires and spare tire should be replaced after 6 years, regardless of the remaining tread. Make sure you also inspect the spare tire periodically for condition and inflation. Spare tires will age and become worn over time even if never used, and thus should be inspected and replaced when necessary. 305 Operation Tires and wheels Tread depth Do not allow your tires to wear down too far. Adhesion properties on wet roads are sharply reduced at tread depths of less than 1/8 in (3 mm). Treadwear indicators (TWI) are required by law. These indicators are located in six places on the tread circumference and become visible at a tread depth of approximately 1/16 in (1.6 mm), at which point the tire is considered worn and should be replaced. to wear down to that level. As tread depth approaches 1/8 in (3 mm), the adhesion properties on a wet road are sharply reduced. Depending upon the weather and/or road surface (conditions), the tire traction varies widely. Summer tires 1/8 in (3 mm) 앫 Winter tires 1/6 in (4 mm) Warning! G Although the applicable federal motor safety laws consider a tire to be worn when the treadwear indicators (TWI) become visible at approximately 1/16 in (1.6 mm), we recommend that you do not allow your tires 306 ! Keep unmounted tires in a cool, dry place with as little exposure to light as possible. Protect tires from contact with oil, grease and gasoline. Cleaning tires ! Never use a round nozzle to power wash tires. The intense jet of water can result in damage to the tire. Always replace a damaged tire. Recommended minimum tire tread depth: 앫 Storing tires 1 TWI (Tread Wear Indicator) The treadwear indicator appears as a solid band across the tread. Operation Tires and wheels Direction of rotation Loading the vehicle Unidirectional tires offer added advantages, such as better hydroplaning performance. To benefit, however, you must make sure the tires rotate in the direction specified. Two labels on your vehicle show how much weight it may properly carry. An arrow on the sidewall indicates the intended direction of rotation (spinning) of the tire. i Spare wheels may be mounted against the direction of rotation (spinning) even with a unidirectional tire for temporary use only until the regular drive wheel has been repaired or replaced. Always observe and follow applicable temporary use restrictions and speed limitations indicated on the spare wheel. able weight that can be carried by a single axle (front or rear). Never exceed the GVWR or GAWR for either the front axle or rear axle. 1) The Tire and Loading Information placard can be found on the driver’s door B-pillar. This placard tells you important information about the number of people that can be in the vehicle and the total weight that can be carried in the vehicle. It also contains information on the proper size and recommended tire inflation pressures for the original equipment tires on your vehicle. 2) The certification label, also found on the driver’s door B-pillar. It tells you about the gross weight capacity of your vehicle, called the Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR). The GVWR includes the weight of the vehicle, all occupants, fuel and cargo. The certification label also tells you about the front and rear axle weight capacity, called the Gross Axle Weight Rating (GAWR). The GAWR is the total allow- 1 Driver’s door B-pillar Following is a discussion on how to work with the information contained on the Tire and Loading Information placard with regards to loading your vehicle. 307 Operation Tires and wheels Seating capacity Tire and Loading Information Warning! The seating capacity gives you important information on the number of occupants that can be in the vehicle. The Tire and Loading Information placard showing the seating capacity is located on the driver’s door B-pillar (컄 page 307). G Do not overload the tires by exceeding the specified load limit as indicated on the Tire and Loading Information placard on the driver’s door B-pillar. Overloading the tires can overheat them, possibly causing a blowout. Overloading the tires can also result in handling or steering problems, or brake failure. Tire and Loading Information placard i Data shown on Tire and Loading Information placard example are for illustration purposes only. Load limit data are specific to each vehicle and may vary from data shown in the illustration below. Refer to Tire and Loading Information placard on vehicle for actual data specific to your vehicle. 1 Load limit information on the Tire and Loading Information placard The Tire and Loading Information placard showing the load limit information is located on the driver’s door B-pillar (컄 page 307). 왘 Locate the statement “The combined weight of occupants and cargo should never exceed XXX kilograms or XXX lbs.” on the Tire and Loading Information placard. The combined weight of all occupants, cargo/luggage and trailer tongue load (if applicable) should never exceed the weight referenced in that statement. 308 i Data shown on Tire and Loading Information placard example are for illustration purposes only. Seating data are specific to each vehicle and may vary from data shown in the illustration below. Refer to Tire and Loading Information placard on vehicle for actual data specific to your vehicle. Operation Tires and wheels Step 2 Step 6 (if applicable) 왘 왘 Determine the combined weight of the driver and passenger that will be riding in your vehicle. Step 3 왘 1 Seating capacity information on the Tire and Loading Information placard Subtract the combined weight of the driver and passenger from XXX kilograms or XXX lbs. Step 4 왘 Steps for determining correct load limit The following steps have been developed as required of all manufacturers under Title 49, Code of U.S. Federal Regulations, Part 575 pursuant to the “National Traffic and Motor Vehicle Safety Act of 1966”. The resulting figure equals the available amount of cargo and luggage load capacity. For example, if the “XXX” amount equals 1400 lbs and there will be five 150 lbs passengers in your vehicle, the amount of available cargo and luggage load capacity is 650 lbs (1400-750 (5 x150) = 650 lbs). Step 1 Step 5 왘 왘 Locate the statement “The combined weight of occupants and cargo should never exceed XXX kg or XXX lbs.” on your vehicle’s Tire and Loading Information placard. If your vehicle will be towing a trailer, load from your trailer will be transferred to your vehicle. Consult this manual to determine how this reduces the available cargo and luggage load capacity of your vehicle (컄 page 311). The following table shows examples on how to calculate total and cargo load capacities with varying seating configurations and number and size of occupants. The following examples use a load limit of 1500 lbs. This is for illustration purposes only. Make sure you are using the actual load limit for your vehicle stated on the vehicle’s Tire and Loading Information placard (컄 page 308). Determine the combined weight of luggage and cargo being loaded on the vehicle. That weight may not safely exceed the available cargo and luggage load capacity calculated in step 4. 309 Operation Tires and wheels Example Combined weight limit of occupants and cargo from Tire and Loading Information placard Number of Occupants weight occupants (driver and passengers) 1 1500 lbs 1 Occupant 1: 175 lbs 175 lbs 1500 lbs - 175 lbs = 1325 lbs 2 1500 lbs 2 Occupant 1: 175 lbs 370 lbs Occupant 2: 195 lbs 1500 lbs - 370 lbs = 1130 lbs The higher the weight of all occupants, the less cargo and luggage load capacity is available. For more information, see “Trailer tongue load” (컄 page 311). 310 Combined Available cargo/luggage and trailer weight of all tongue weight (total load limit from occupants Tire and Loading Information placard minus combined weight of all occupants) Operation Tires and wheels Certification label Even after careful determination of the combined weight of all occupants, cargo and the trailer tongue load (if applicable) (컄 page 311) as to not exceed the permissible load limit, you must make sure that your vehicle never exceeds the Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR) and the Gross Axle Weight Rating (GAWR) for either the front or rear axle. You can obtain the GVWR and GAWR from the certification label. The certification label can be found on the driver’s door B-pillar, see “Technical data” (컄 page 430). Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR): The total weight of the vehicle, all occupants, all cargo, and the trailer tongue load (컄 page 311) must never exceed the GVWR. Gross Axle Weight Rating (GAWR): The total allowable weight that can be carried by a single axle (front or rear). To assure that your vehicle does not exceed the maximum permissible weight limits (GVWR and GAWR for front and rear axle), have the loaded vehicle (including driver, passengers and all cargo and, if applicable, trailer fully loaded) weighed on a suitable commercial scale. Trailer tongue load The tongue load of any trailer is an important weight to measure because it affects the load you can carry in your vehicle. If a trailer is towed, the tongue load must be added to the weight of all occupants riding and any cargo you are carrying in the vehicle. The tongue load typically is 10 percent of the trailer weight and everything loaded in it. Your Mercedes-Benz has been designed primarily to carry passengers and their cargo. Mercedes-Benz does not recommend trailer towing with your vehicle. 311 Operation Tires and wheels Recommended tire inflation pressure Warning! G Follow recommend tire inflation pressures. Do not underinflate tires. Underinflated tires wear excessively and/or unevenly, adversely affect handling and fuel economy, and are more likely to fail from being overheated. Do not overinflate tires. Overinflated tires can adversely affect handling and ride comfort, wear unevenly, increase stopping distance, and result in sudden deflation (blowout) because they are more likely to become punctured or damaged by road debris, potholes etc. 312 Do not overload the tires by exceeding the specified load limit as indicated on the Tire and Loading Information placard on the driver’s door B-pillar. Overloading the tires can overheat them, possibly causing a blowout. Overloading the tires can also result in handling or steering problems, or brake failure. Your vehicle is equipped with the Tire and Loading Information placard located on the driver’s door B-pillar (컄 page 307). The tire inflation pressure should be checked regularly and should only be adjusted on cold tires. The tires can be considered cold if the vehicle has been parked for at least three hours or driven less than one mile (1.6 km). Follow recommended cold tire inflation pressures listed on the Tire and Loading Information placard on the driver’s door B-pillar. Keeping the tires properly inflated provides the best handling, tread life and riding comfort. In addition to the Tire and Loading Information placard on the driver’s door B-pillar, also consult the tire inflation pressure label (if available) on the fuel filler flap (컄 page 291) for any additional information pertaining to special driving situations. For more information, see “Important notes on tire inflation pressure” (컄 page 313). Operation Tires and wheels i Data shown on Tire and Loading Information placard example are for illustration purposes only. Tire data are specific to each vehicle and may vary from data shown in the illustration below. Refer to Tire and Loading Information placard on vehicle for actual data specific to your vehicle. Important notes on tire inflation pressure Warning! G If the tire inflation pressure drops repeatedly: 앫 Check the tires for punctures from foreign objects. 앫 Check to see whether air is leaking from the valves or from around the rim. Tire temperature and tire inflation pressure are also increased while driving, depending on the driving speed and the tire load. 1 Tire and Loading Information placard with recommended cold tire inflation pressures The Tire and Loading Information placard lists the recommended cold tire inflation pressures for maximum loaded vehicle weight. The tire inflation pressures listed apply to the tires installed as original equipment. If you will be driving your vehicle at high speeds of 100 mph (160 km/h) or higher, where it is legal and conditions allow, consult the tire inflation pressure label (if available) on the inside of the fuel filler flap on how to adjust the cold tire inflation pressure. If you do not adjust the tire inflation pressure, excessive heat can build up and result in sudden tire failure. If your vehicle is not equipped with the tire inflation pressure label on the inside of the fuel filler flap, contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Light Truck Center for proper tire inflation pressure. i Driving comfort may be reduced when the tire inflation pressure is adjusted to the value for speeds above 100 mph (160 km/h) as specified on the tire inflation pressure label located on the inside of the fuel filler flap. Be sure to readjust the tire inflation pressure for normal driving speeds. You should wait until the tires are cold before adjusting the tire inflation pressure. Some vehicles may have supplemental tire inflation pressure information for vehicle loads less than the maximum loaded vehicle condition. If such information is provided, it can be found on the tire inflation pressure label located on the inside of the fuel filler flap (컄 page 291). 313 Operation Tires and wheels Tire inflation pressure changes by approximately 1.5 psi (0.1 bar) per 18°F (10°C) of air temperature change. Keep this in mind when checking tire inflation pressure where the temperature is different from the outside temperature. Checking tire inflation pressure Regularly check your tire inflation pressure at least once a month. Check and adjust the tire inflation pressure when the tires are cold. The tires can be considered cold if the vehicle has been parked for at least 3 hours or driven less than 1 mile (1.6 km). If you check the tire inflation pressure when the tires are warm (the vehicle has been driven for several miles or sitting less than 3 hours), the reading will be approximately 4 psi (0.3 bar) higher than the cold reading. This is normal. Do not let air out to match the specified cold tire inflation pressure. Otherwise, the tire will be underinflated. 314 Warning! G Follow recommend tire inflation pressures. Do not underinflate tires. Underinflated tires wear excessively and/or unevenly, adversely affect handling and fuel economy, and are more likely to fail from being overheated. Do not overinflate tires. Overinflated tires can adversely affect handling and ride comfort, wear unevenly, increase stopping distance, and result in sudden deflation (blowout) because they are more likely to become punctured or damaged by road debris, potholes etc. Do not overload the tires by exceeding the specified load limit as indicated on the Tire and Loading Information placard on the driver’s door B-pillar. Overloading the tires can overheat them, possibly causing a blowout. Overloading the tires can also result in handling or steering problems, or brake failure. Checking tire inflation pressure manually Follow the steps below to achieve correct tire inflation pressure: 왘 Remove the cap from the valve on one tire. 왘 Firmly press a tire gauge onto the valve. 왘 Read tire inflation pressure on tire gauge and check against the recommended tire inflation pressure on the Tire and Loading Information placard on the driver’s door B-pillar (컄 page 307). If necessary, add air to achieve the recommended tire inflation pressure. i If you have overfilled the tire, release tire inflation pressure by pushing the metal stem of the valve with e.g. a tip of a pen. Then recheck the tire inflation pressure with the tire gauge. 왘 Install the valve cap. 왘 Repeat this procedure for each tire. Operation Tires and wheels Run Flat Indicator* While the vehicle is being driven, the Run Flat Indicator monitors the set tire inflation pressures by evaluating each wheel’s rotational speed. This allows the system to detect a significant loss of pressure in a tire. If a wheel’s rotational speed changes due to falling tire inflation pressure, you will see a corresponding warning message in the multifunction display. The Run Flat Indicator may function in a restricted manner or with a delay if: 앫 snow chains are mounted to the vehicle 앫 winter road conditions prevail 앫 you are driving on a loose surface (e.g. sand or gravel) 앫 you are driving in a very sporty manner (involving rapid acceleration or high speeds in curves) Warning! G When the multifunction display shows the message Tire pressure Check tires, one or more of your tires is significantly underinflated. You should stop and check your tires as soon as possible, and inflate them to the proper tire inflation pressure as indicated on the vehicle’s Tire and Loading Information placard or, if available, on the tire inflation pressure label. Driving on a significantly underinflated tire causes the tire to overheat and can lead to tire failure. Underinflation also reduces fuel efficiency and tire tread life, and may affect the vehicle’s handling and stopping ability. Each tire, including the spare, should be checked monthly when cold and set to the recommended tire inflation pressure as specified on the Tire and Loading Information placard on the driver’s door B-pillar (컄 page 307) or, if available, on the tire inflation pressure label located on the inside of the fuel filler flap (컄 page 291). Warning! G The Run Flat Indicator does not indicate a warning for wrongly selected tire inflation pressures. Always adjust tire inflation pressure according to the Tire and Loading Information placard on the driver’s door B-pillar (컄 page 307) or, if available, on the tire inflation pressure label located on the inside of the fuel filler flap (컄 page 291). The Run Flat Indicator does not replace regular checks of the tire inflation pressures since a gradual pressure loss in more than one tire cannot be detected by the Run Flat Indicator. The Run Flat Indicator is not able to issue a warning due to a sudden dramatic loss of tire inflation pressure (e.g. tire blowout caused by a foreign object). In this case bring the vehicle to a halt by carefully applying the brakes and avoiding abrupt steering maneuvers. 315 Operation Tires and wheels Reactivating the Run Flat Indicator 왘 The tire inflation pressure monitor must be restarted in the following situations: 앫 If you have changed the tire inflation pressure 앫 If you have replaced the wheels or tires 앫 If you have installed new wheels or tires 왘 Using the Tire and Loading Information placard on the driver’s door B-pillar or, if available, the tire inflation pressure label on the inside of the fuel filler flap, make sure the tire inflation pressure of all four tires is correct. Warning! G The Run Flat Indicator can only warn you in a reliable manner if you have set the correct tire inflation pressures for each tire. If an incorrect tire inflation pressure was set, the system will monitor the pressure according to the incorrect value. 316 왘 Switch on the ignition (컄 page 37). If you wish to confirm activation: The standard display menu appears in the multifunction display (컄 page 127). 왘 왘 The following message will appear in the multifunction display: Press button k or j repeatedly until the following message appears in the multifunction display: Run Flat Indicator active Menu: R-Button Press reset button J (컄 page 26). The following message will appear in the multifunction display: Restart Run Flat Indicator? Press button æ. Run Flat Indicator restarted After a certain “learning phase”, the Run Flat Indicator checks the set pressure values for all four tires. If you wish to cancel activation: 왘 Press button ç. or 왘 Wait until the message Restart Run Flat Indicator? disappears. Operation Tires and wheels Potential problems associated with underinflated and overinflated tires Overinflated tires Underinflated tires 앫 adversely affect handling characteristics 앫 cause uneven tire wear The MOExtended system allows you to continue driving your vehicle even if there is a total loss of pressure in one or more tires. 앫 be more prone to damage from road hazards You may only use the MOExtended system in conjunction with the Run Flat Indicator*. 앫 adversely affect ride comfort 앫 increase stopping distance For information on driving in case of pressure loss in one or more tires (emergency mode), see the “Practical hints” section (컄 page 414). Overinflated tires can: Underinflated tires can: 앫 cause excessive and uneven tire wear 앫 adversely affect fuel economy 앫 lead to tire failure from being overheated 앫 adversely affect handling characteristics Warning! Warning! G Follow recommended tire inflation pressures. Do not underinflate tires. Underinflated tires wear excessively and/or unevenly, adversely affect handling and fuel economy, and are more likely to fail from being overheated. MOExtended system* G Follow recommended tire inflation pressures. Do not overinflate tires. Overinflated tires can adversely affect handling and ride comfort, wear unevenly, increase stopping distance, and result in sudden deflation (blowout) because they are more likely to become punctured or damaged by road debris, potholes etc. 317 Operation Tires and wheels Tire labeling Besides tire name (sales designation) and manufacturer name, a number of markings can be found on a tire. Following are some explanations for the markings on your vehicle’s tires: 1 Uniform Quality Grading Standards (컄 page 325) 2 DOT, Tire Identification Number (TIN) (컄 page 322) 3 Maximum tire load (컄 page 324) 4 Maximum tire inflation pressure (컄 page 324) 5 Manufacturer 6 Tire ply material (컄 page 327) 7 Tire size designation, load and speed rating (컄 page 318) 8 Load identification (컄 page 322) 9 Tire name i For illustration purposes only. Actual data on tires are specific to each vehicle and may vary from data shown in above illustration. For more information, see “Rims and tires” (컄 page 434). Tire size designation, load and speed rating 1 Tire width 2 Aspect ratio in % 3 Radial tire code 4 Rim diameter 5 Tire load rating 6 Tire speed rating i For illustration purposes only. Actual data on tires are specific to each vehicle and may vary from data shown in above illustration. 318 Operation Tires and wheels General: Tire width Rim diameter Depending on the design standards used, the tire size molded into the sidewall may have no letter or a letter preceding the tire size designation. The tire width 1 (컄 page 318) indicates the nominal tire width in mm. The rim diameter 4 (컄 page 318) is the diameter of the bead seat, not the diameter of the rim edge. Rim diameter is indicated in inches (in). No letter preceding the size designation (as illustrated above): Passenger car tire based on European design standards. The aspect ratio 2 (컄 page 318) is the dimensional relationship between tire section height and section width and is expressed in percentage. The aspect ratio is arrived at by dividing section height by section width. Letter “P” preceding the size designation: Passenger car tire based on U.S. design standards. Letter “LT” preceding the size designation: Light Truck tire based on U.S. design standards. Letter “T” preceding the size designation: Temporary spare tires which are high pressure compact spares designed for temporary emergency use only. Aspect ratio Tire code The tire code 3 (컄 page 318) indicates the tire construction type. The “R” stands for radial tire type. Letter “D” means diagonal or bias ply construction; letter “B” means belted-bias ply construction. Tire load rating The tire load rating 5 (컄 page 318) is a numerical code associated with the maximum load a tire can support. For example, a load rating of 91 corresponds to a maximum load of 1356 lbs (615 kg) the tire is designed to support. See also “Maximum tire load” (컄 page 324) where the maximum load associated with the load index is indicated in kilograms and lbs. At the tire manufacturer’s option, any tire with a speed capability above 149 mph (240 km/h) can include a “ZR” in the size designation (for example: 245/40 ZR 18). For additional information, see “Tire speed rating” (컄 page 320). 319 Operation Tires and wheels Warning! G The tire load rating must always be at least half of the GAWR (컄 page 328) of your vehicle. Otherwise, tire failure may be the result which may cause an accident and/or serious personal injury to you or others. Always replace rims and tires with the same designation, manufacturer and type as shown on the original part. Warning! G Do not overload the tires by exceeding the specified load limit as indicated on the Tire and Loading Information placard located on the driver’s door B-pillar. Overloading the tires can overheat them, possibly causing a blowout. Overloading the tires can also result in handling or steering problems, or brake failure. 320 For additional information on tire load rating, see “Load identification” (컄 page 322). speed rating 6 (컄 page 318) are also referred to as “service description”. i Tire load rating 5 (컄 page 318) and Tire Summer tires speed rating 6 (컄 page 318) are also referred to as “service description”. i Tire load rating 5 (컄 page 318) and Tire Index Speed rating Q up to 100 mph (160 km/h) Tire speed rating R up to 106 mph (170 km/h) The tire speed rating 6 (컄 page 318) indicates the approved maximum speed for the tire. S up to 112 mph (180 km/h) T up to 118 mph (190 km/h) H up to 130 mph (210 km/h) V up to 149 mph (240 km/h) W up to 168 mph (270 km/h) Y up to 186 mph (300 km/h) (Y) above 186 mph (300 km/h) ZR above 149 mph (240 km/h) Warning! G Even when permitted by law, never operate a vehicle at speeds greater than the maximum speed rating of the tires. Exceeding the maximum speed for which tires are rated can lead to sudden tire failure, causing loss of vehicle control and possibly resulting in an accident and/or personal injury and possible death, for you and for others. Operation Tires and wheels 앫 If a service description 5 and 6 (컄 page 318) is given, the speed capability is limited by the speed symbol in the service description. Example: 245/40 ZR18 97Y. In this example, “97Y” is the service description. The letter “Y” designates the speed rating and the speed capability of the tire is limited to 186 mph (300 km/h). At the tire manufacturer’s option, any tire with a speed capability above 149 mph (240 km/h) can include a “ZR” in the size designation (for example: 245/40 ZR18). To determine the maximum speed capability of the tire, the service description for the tire must be referred to. The service description is comprised of the tire load rating 5 (컄 page 318) and the tire speed rating 6 (컄 page 318). If your tire includes “ZR” in the size designation and no service description 5 and 6 (컄 page 318) is given, the tire manufacturer must be consulted for the maximum speed capability. 앫 Any tire with a speed capability above 186 mph (300 km/h) must include a “ZR” in the size designation AND the service description must be placed in parenthesis. Example: 275/40 ZR 18 (99Y). The “(Y)” speed rating in parenthesis designates the maximum speed capability of the tire as being above 186 mph (300 km/h). Consult the tire manufacturer for the actual maximum permissible speed of the tire. All-season and winter tires Index Speed rating M+S1 up to 100 mph (160 km/h) T M+S 1 up to 118 mph (190 km/h) H M+S 1 up to 130 mph (210 km/h) M+S1 up to 149 mph (240 km/h) Q V 1 or M+S.for winter tires. i Not all M+S rated tires provide special winter performance. Make sure the tires you use show M+S and the mountain/snowflake.marking on the tire sidewall. These tires meet specific snow traction performance requirements of the Rubber Manufacturers Association (RMA) and the Rubber Association of Canada (RAC) and have been designed specifically for use in snow conditions. 321 Operation Tires and wheels Load identification In addition to tire load rating, special load identification 1 may be molded into the tire sidewall following the letter designating the tire speed rating (컄 page 318). No specification given: absence of any text (like in above example) indicates a standard load (SL) tire. XL or Extra Load: designates an extra load (or reinforced) tire. Light Load: designates a light load tire. 1 Load identification i For illustration purposes only. Actual data on tires are specific to each vehicle and may vary from data shown in above illustration. 322 C, D, E: designates load range associated with the maximum load a tire can carry at a specified pressure. DOT, Tire Identification Number (TIN) U.S. tire regulations require each new tire manufacturer or tire retreader to mold a TIN into or onto a sidewall of each tire produced. The TIN is a unique identifier which facilitates efforts by tire manufactures to notify purchasers in recall situations or other safety matters concerning tires and gives purchasers the means to easily identify such tires. The TIN is comprised of “Manufacturer’s identification mark”, “Tire size”, “Tire type code”, and “Date of manufacture”. Operation Tires and wheels 1 DOT 2 Manufacturer’s identification mark 3 Tire size 4 Tire type code (at the option of the tire manufacturer) 5 Date of manufacture i For illustration purposes only. Actual data on tires are specific to each vehicle and may vary from data shown in above illustration. DOT (Department of Transportation) Tire type code A tire branding symbol 1 (컄 page 323) which denotes the tire meets requirements of the U.S. Department of Transportation. The code 4 (컄 page 323) may, at the option of the manufacturer, be used as a descriptive code for identifying significant characteristics of the tire. Manufacturer’s identification mark Date of manufacture The manufacturer’s identification mark 2 (컄 page 323) denotes the tire manufacturer. The date of manufacture 5 (컄 page 323) identifies the week and year of manufacture. New tires have a mark with two symbols. The first two figures identify the week, starting with “01” to represent the first full week of the calendar year. The second two figures represent the year. Retreaded tires have a mark with four symbols. For more information on retreaded tires, see (컄 page 304). Tire size For example, “3202” represents the 32nd week of 2002. The code 3 (컄 page 323) indicates the tire size. 323 Operation Tires and wheels Maximum tire load Warning! G Maximum tire inflation pressure Do not overload the tires by exceeding the specified load limit as indicated on the Tire and Loading Information placard located on the driver’s door B-pillar. Overloading the tires can overheat them, possibly causing a blowout. Overloading the tires can also result in handling or steering problems, or brake failure. 1 Maximum tire load rating i For illustration purposes only. Actual data on tires are specific to each vehicle and may vary from data shown in above illustration. The maximum tire load is the maximum weight the tires are designed to support. 324 For more information on tire load rating (컄 page 319). For information on calculating total and cargo load capacities (컄 page 309). 1 Maximum permissible tire inflation pressure i For illustration purposes only. Actual data on tires are specific to each vehicle and may vary from data shown in above illustration. This is the maximum permissible tire inflation pressure for the tire. Operation Tires and wheels Always follow the recommended tire inflation pressure (컄 page 312) for proper tire inflation. Warning! G Never exceed the max. tire inflation pressure. Follow recommended tire inflation pressures. Uniform Tire Quality Grading Standards (U.S. vehicles) Tire manufacturers are required to grade tires based on three performance factors: treadwear, traction and temperature resistance. Treadwear Traction Temperature 200 AA A All passenger car tires must conform to federal safety requirements in addition to these grades. Do not underinflate tires. Underinflated tires wear excessively and/or unevenly, adversely affect handling and fuel economy, and are more likely to fail from being overheated. Do not overinflate tires. Overinflated tires can adversely affect handling and ride comfort, wear unevenly, increase stopping distance, and result in sudden deflation (blowout) because they are more likely to become punctured or damaged by road debris, potholes etc. Quality grades can be found, where applicable, on the tire sidewall between tread shoulder and maximum section width. For example: 1 Treadwear 2 Traction 3 Temperature resistance i For illustration purposes only. Actual data on tires are specific to each vehicle and may vary from data shown in above illustration. 325 Operation Tires and wheels Treadwear Traction Temperature The treadwear grade is a comparative rating based on the wear rate of the tire when tested under controlled conditions on a specified government test course. For example, a tire graded 150 would wear one and one-half (1 1/2) times as well on the government course as a tire graded 100. The relative performance of tires depends upon the actual conditions of their use, however, and may depart significantly from the norm due to variations in driving habits, service practices and differences in road characteristics and climate. The traction grades, from highest to lowest, are AA, A, B, and C. Those grades represent the tire’s ability to stop on wet pavement as measured under controlled conditions on specified government test surfaces of asphalt and concrete. A tire marked C may have poor traction performance. The temperature grades are A (the highest), B, and C, representing the tire’s resistance to the generation of heat and its ability to dissipate heat when tested under controlled conditions on a specified indoor laboratory test wheel. Sustained high temperature can cause the material of the tire to degenerate and reduce tire life, and excessive temperature can lead to sudden tire failure. The grade C corresponds to a level of performance which all passenger car tires must meet under the Federal Motor Vehicle Safety Standard No. 109. Grades B and A represent higher levels of performance on the laboratory test wheel than the minimum required by law. 326 Warning! G The traction grade assigned to this tire is based on straight-ahead braking traction tests, and does not include acceleration, cornering, hydroplaning, or peak traction characteristics. Operation Tires and wheels Warning! G Tire ply material Tire and loading terminology Accessory weight The temperature grade for this tire is established for a tire that is properly inflated and not overloaded. Excessive speed, underinflation, or excessive loading, either separately or in combination, can cause excessive heat build-up and possible tire failure. 1 Plies in sidewall 2 Plies under tread i For illustration purposes only. Actual data on tires are specific to each vehicle and may vary from data shown in above illustration. This marking tells you about the type of cord and number of plies in the sidewall and under the tread. The combined weight (in excess of those standard items which may be replaced) of automatic transmission, power steering, power brakes, power windows, power seats, radio, and heater, to the extent that these items are available as factory-installed equipment (whether installed or not). Air pressure The amount of air inside the tire pressing outward on each square inch of the tire. Air pressure is expressed in pounds per square inch (psi), or kilopascal (kPa), or bars. Aspect ratio Dimensional relationship between tire section height and section width expressed in percentage. 327 Operation Tires and wheels Bar DOT (Department of Transportation) GVWR (Gross Vehicle Weight Rating) Another metric unit for air pressure. There are 14.5038 pounds per square inch (psi) to 1 bar; there are 100 kilopascals (kPa) to 1 bar. A tire branding symbol which denotes the tire meets requirements of the U.S. Department of Transportation. This is the maximum permissible vehicle weight of the fully loaded vehicle (weight of the vehicle including all options, passengers, fuel, and cargo and, if applicable, trailer tongue load). It is indicated on certification label located on the driver’s door B-pillar. GAWR (Gross Axle Weight Rating) Bead The tire bead contains steel wires wrapped by steel cords that hold the tire onto the rim. Cold tire inflation pressure Tire inflation pressure when your vehicle has been sitting for at least three hours or driven no more than 1 mile (1.6 km). Curb weight The weight of a motor vehicle with standard equipment including the maximum capacity of fuel, oil, and coolant, and, if so equipped, air conditioning and additional optional equipment, but without passengers and cargo. 328 The GAWR is the maximum permissible axle weight. The gross vehicle weight on each axle must never exceed the GAWR for the front and rear axle indicated on the certification label located on the driver’s door B-pillar. GVW (Gross Vehicle Weight) The GVW comprises the weight of the vehicle including fuel, tools, spare wheel, installed accessories, passengers and cargo and, if applicable, trailer tongue load. The GWV must never exceed the GWVR indicated on the certification label located on the driver’s door B-pillar. Kilopascal (kPa) The metric unit for air pressure. There are 6.9 kPa to 1 psi; another metric unit for air pressure is bars. There are 100 kilopascals (kPa) to 1 bar. Maximum load rating The maximum load in kilograms and pounds that can be carried by the tire. Maximum loaded vehicle weight The sum of curb weight, accessory weight, total load limit and production options weight. Operation Tires and wheels Maximum tire inflation pressure PSI (Pounds per square inch) TIN (Tire Identification Number) This number is the greatest amount of air pressure that should ever be put in the tire under normal driving conditions. A standard unit of measure for air pressure -> bar, kilopascal (kPa). Unique identifier which facilitates efforts by tire manufacturers to notify purchasers in recall situations or other safety matters concerning tires and gives purchases the means to easily identify such tires. The TIN is comprised of “Manufacturer’s identification mark”, “Tire size”, “Tire type code”, and “Date of manufacture”. Recommended tire inflation pressure Normal occupant weight The number of occupants the vehicle is designed to seat, multiplied by 68 kilograms (150 lbs). Occupant distribution The distribution of occupants in a vehicle at their designated seating positions. Production options weight The combined weight of those installed regular production options weighing over 5 lbs (2.3 kilograms) in excess of those standard items which they replace, not previously considered in curb weight or accessory weight, including heavy duty brakes, ride levelers, roof rack, heavy duty battery, and special trim. Recommended tire inflation pressure for normal driving conditions is listed on the Tire and Loading Information placard located on the driver’s door B-pillar. Provides best handling, tread life and riding comfort. If so equipped, supplemental information pertaining to special driving situations can be found on the tire inflation pressure label on the inside of the fuel filler flap. Tire load rating Numerical code associated with the maximum load a tire can support. Tire ply composition and material used Rim A metal support for a tire or a tire and tube assembly upon which the tire beads are seated. Sidewall This indicates the number of plies or the number of layers of rubber-coated fabric in the tire tread and sidewall. Tire manufacturers also must indicate the ply materials in the tire and sidewall, which include steel, nylon, polyester, and others. The portion of a tire between the tread and the bead. 329 Operation Tires and wheels Tire speed rating Uniform Tire Quality Grading Standards Part of tire designation; indicates the speed range for which a tire is approved. A tire information system that provides consumers with ratings for a tire’s traction, temperature and treadwear. Ratings are determined by tire manufacturers using government testing procedures. The ratings are molded into the sidewall of the tire. Total load limit Rated cargo and luggage load plus 68 kilograms (150 lbs) times the vehicle’s designated seating capacity. Traction Force exerted by the vehicle on the road via the tires. The amount of grip provided. Vehicle maximum load on the tire Load on an individual tire that is determined by distributing to each axle its share of the maximum loaded vehicle weight and dividing it by two. Rotating tires Warning! G Rotate front and rear wheels only if the tires are of the same dimension. If your vehicle is equipped with mixed-size tires (different tire dimensions front vs. rear), tire rotation is not possible. Treadwear indicators Tire rotation can be performed on vehicles with tires of the same dimension all around. If your vehicle is equipped with tires of the same dimension all around, tires can be rotated, observing a front-to-rear rotation pattern that will maintain the intended rotation (spinning) direction of the tire (컄 page 307). Narrow bands, sometimes called “wear bars” that show across the tread of a tire when only 1/16 in (1.6 mm) of tread remains. In some cases, such as when your vehicle is equipped with mixed-size tires (different tire dimension front vs. rear), tire rotation is not possible. Tread The portion of a tire that comes into contact with the road. 330 Operation Tires and wheels If applicable to your vehicle’s tire configuration, tires can be rotated according to the tire manufacturer’s recommended intervals in the tire manufacturer’s warranty pamphlet located in your vehicle literature portfolio. If none is available, tires should be rotated every 3000 to 6000 miles (5000 to 10000 km), or sooner if necessary, according to the degree of tire wear. The same rotation (spinning) direction must be maintained (컄 page 307). Rotate tires before the characteristic tire wear pattern becomes visible (shoulder wear on front tires and tread center wear on rear tires). Warning! G Have the tightening torque checked after changing a wheel. Wheels could become loose if not tightened with a torque of 80 lb-ft (110 Nm). Only use genuine Mercedes-Benz wheel bolts specified for your vehicle’s rims. For information on wheel change, see the “Practical hints” section (컄 page 385) and (컄 page 401). Thoroughly clean the mounting face of wheels and brake discs, i.e. the inner side of the wheels/tires, during each rotation. Check for and ensure proper tire inflation pressure. 331 Operation Winter driving Before the onset of winter, have your vehicle winterized at an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. This service includes: 앫 Checking anticorrosion and antifreeze concentration. 앫 Adding of cleaning concentrate to the water of the windshield and headlamp cleaning* system. Add MB Windshield Washer Concentrate “MB SummerFit” to a pre-mixed windshield washer solvent/antifreeze which is formulated for temperatures below freezing point (컄 page 450). 앫 Battery test. Battery capacity drops with decreasing ambient temperature. A well charged battery helps to make sure the engine can be started, even at low ambient temperatures. 앫 Tire change. ! When scraping ice or snow from the rear window, be careful not to damage the sealing strip or apertures along the side of the window. 332 Winter tires Warning! Always use winter tires at temperatures below 45°F (7°C) and whenever wintry road conditions prevail. Not all M+S rated tires provide special winter performance. Make sure the tires you use show M+S and the mountain/snowflake symbol .marking on the tire sidewall. These tires meet specific snow traction performance requirements of the Rubber Manufacturers Association (RMA) and the Rubber Association of Canada (RAC) and have been designed specifically for use in snow conditions. Use of winter tires is the only way to achieve the maximum effectiveness of the ABS and ESP® in winter operation. For safe handling, make sure all mounted winter tires are of the same make and have the same tread design. G Winter tires with a tread depth of less than 1/ in (4 mm) must be replaced. They are 6 no longer suitable for winter operation. Always observe the speed rating of the winter tires mounted to your vehicle. If the maximum speed for which your tires are rated is below the speed rating of your vehicle, you must place a notice to this effect where it will be seen by the driver. Such notices are available at your tire dealer or any authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. Operation Winter driving Warning! G If you use your spare tire when winter tires are fitted on the other wheels, be aware that the difference in tire characteristics may very well impair turning stability and that overall driving stability may be reduced. Adapt your driving style accordingly. Have the spare tire replaced with a winter tire at the nearest authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. Snow chains ! Some tire sizes do not leave adequate clearance for snow chains. To help avoid serious damage to your vehicle or tires, make sure that the use of snow chains is permissible as specified in the “Technical data” section of this Operator’s Manual, see “Rims and tires” (컄 page 434). ! If snow chains are mounted to the front wheels, they may scrape against the body or axle components. The tires or the vehicle could be damaged as a result. 앫 Only use snow chains that are approved by Mercedes-Benz. Any authorized Mercedes-Benz Center will be glad to advise you on this subject. 앫 Use of snow chains may be prohibited depending on location. Always check local and state laws before installing snow chains. Please observe the following guidelines when using snow chains: 앫 Do not use snow chains on the spare wheel (컄 page 439). 앫 Use of snow chains is not permissible with all wheel/tire combinations (컄 page 434). i When driving with snow chains, you may 앫 Use snow chains in pairs and on rear wheels only. Follow the manufacturer’s mounting instructions. Snow chains should only be driven on snow-covered roads at speeds not higher than 30 mph (50 km/h). Remove chains as soon as possible when driving on roads without snow. wish to deactivate the ESP® (컄 page 88) before setting the vehicle in motion. This will improve the vehicle’s traction. 333 Operation Maintenance We strongly recommend that you have your vehicle serviced by an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center, in accordance with the Maintenance Booklet at the times called for by the maintenance service indicator. Maintenance service indicator message ! Failure to have the vehicle maintained in Starting approximately 1 month before the next maintenance service is due, one of the following messages will appear in the multifunction display while you are driving or when you switch on the ignition (example service A): accordance with the Maintenance Booklet and the maintenance service indicator at the designated times/mileage will result in vehicle damage not covered by the Mercedes-Benz Limited Warranty. The maintenance service indicator message will notify you when the next maintenance service is due. Service Service Service Service A A A A due due due due The maintenance services will be indicated by showing a service type A through type H in the multifunction display. Types A through H are classified based on estimated time needed to perform the maintenance service, ranging: from Service A (approximately 1 hour) to Service H (approximately 8 hours) in XXXXX miles (km) in XXX days in X day now Refer to Maintenance Booklet for a listing of maintenance services and intervals the need to be performed at. i The Maintenance System tracks distance driven and the time elapsed since the last maintenance service, calculates other maintenance service work required, and calls for the next maintenance service accordingly. 334 Operation Maintenance Clearing the maintenance service indicator message The maintenance service indicator message is automatically cleared: 앫 앫 after approximately 10 seconds when you switch on the ignition or when reaching the service threshold while driving after approximately 30 seconds once the suggested maintenance service term has passed You can also clear it yourself. 왘 Press reset button J (컄 page 26) on the instrument cluster. The maintenance service indicator message is cleared and the standard display appears in the multifunction display (컄 page 127). Maintenance service term exceeded If you have exceeded the suggested maintenance service term, you will see the following message in the multifunction display: Service A exceeded by XXXXX miles (km) Service A exceeded by XXX days Service A exceeded by X day Calling up the maintenance service indicator display i The menu overview can be found on (컄 page 124). You can call up the maintenance service indicator display at any time to check when the next maintenance service is due. 왘 In addition, a signal sounds when the message appears. Any authorized Mercedes-Benz Center will reset the maintenance service indicator following a completed maintenance service. Switch on the ignition (컄 page 37). The standard display menu appears in the multifunction display (컄 page 127). 왘 Press button j or k on the multifunction steering wheel repeatedly until the maintenance service indicator display with the service symbol 9 appears in the multifunction display. 컄컄 335 Operation Maintenance 컄컄 i If the battery is disconnected, the days of disconnection will not be included in the count shown by the maintenance service indicator. To arrive at the true maintenance service deadline, you will need to subtract these days from the days shown in the maintenance service indicator message or maintenance service indicator display. Do not confuse the maintenance service indicator with the engine oil level indicator N. Resetting the maintenance service indicator In the event that the maintenance service on your vehicle is not carried out by an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center, you can have the maintenance service indicator reset. The automotive maintenance facility carrying out the maintenance service will find the information for resetting the maintenance service indicator in the maintenance-relevant literature for your vehicle. Such literature is available from either your authorized Mercedes-Benz Center or directly from Mercedes-Benz. i If the maintenance service indicator was inadvertently reset, have an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center correct it. Only reset if the proper maintenance service has been performed. Resetting the system without performing the proper maintenance service as called for by the maintenance service indicator will result in engine damage and/or other vehicle damage not covered by the Mercedes-Benz Limited Warranty. 336 Operation Vehicle care 왔 Vehicle care Cleaning and care of vehicle Regular and proper care will help to maintain the value of your vehicle. The best way to protect your vehicle from harmful environmental influences is to wash it and use protective treatments regularly. Warning! G Many cleaning products can be hazardous. Some are poisonous, others are flammable. Always follow the instructions on the particular container. Always open your vehicle’s doors or windows when cleaning the inside. Never use fluids or solvents that are not designed for cleaning your vehicle. Always lock away cleaning products and keep them out of reach of children. While in operation, even while parked, your vehicle is subjected to varying external influences which, if gone unchecked, can attack the paintwork as well as the undercarriage and cause lasting damage. Such damage is caused not only by extreme and varying climatic conditions, but also by: More frequent washings are necessary to deal with unfavorable conditions: 앫 near the ocean 앫 in industrial areas (smoke, exhaust emissions) Tar 앫 during winter operation Gravel and stone chipping You should check your vehicle from time to time for stone chipping or other damage. Any damage should be repaired as soon as possible to prevent corrosion. 앫 Air pollution 앫 Road salt 앫 앫 To avoid paint damage, you should immediately remove: 앫 Grease and oil 앫 Fuel 앫 Coolant 앫 Brake fluid 앫 Bird droppings 앫 Insects 앫 Tree resins, etc. Frequent washing reduces and/or eliminates the aggressiveness and potency of the above adverse influences. In doing so, do not neglect the underbody of the vehicle. A prerequisite for a thorough check is a washing of the underbody followed by a thorough inspection. Damaged areas need to be re-undercoated. Your vehicle has been treated at the factory with a wax-base rustproofing in the body cavities which will last for the lifetime of the vehicle. Post-production treatment is neither necessary nor recommended by Mercedes-Benz because of the possibility 337 Operation Vehicle care of incompatibility between materials used in the production process and others applied later. We have selected car-care products and compiled recommendations which are specially matched to our vehicles and which always reflect the latest technology. You can obtain Mercedes-Benz approved car-care products at an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. Scratches, corrosive deposits, corrosion or damage due to negligent or incorrect care cannot always be removed or repaired with the car-care products recommended here. In such cases it is best to seek aid at an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. The following topics deal with the cleaning and care of your vehicle and give important “how-to” information as well as references to Mercedes-Benz approved car-care products. 338 Power washer Paintwork, painted body components ! Follow the instructions provided by the power washer manufacturer on maintaining a distance between the vehicle and the nozzle of the power washer. ! Affixing stickers, adhesive tape or similar Never use a round nozzle to power-wash tires. The intense jet of water can result in damage to the tire. Always replace a damaged tire. Always keep the jet of water moving across the surface. Do not aim directly at electrical parts, electrical connectors, seals, or other rubber parts. materials to painted body components may damage the paintwork. Mercedes-Benz approved Paint Care should be applied when water drops on the paint surface do not “bead up”. This should normally be done every 3 to 5 months, depending on the climate and washing detergent used. Tar stains Mercedes-Benz approved Paint Cleaner should be applied if the paint surface shows signs of embedded dirt (i.e. loss of gloss). Quickly remove tar stains before they dry and become more difficult to remove. A tar remover is recommended. Do not apply any of these products or wax if your vehicle is parked in the sun or if the hood is still hot. 왘 Use the appropriate MB-Touch-Up Stick for quick and provisional repairs of minor paint damage (i.e. chips from stones, vehicle doors, etc.). Operation Vehicle care Engine cleaning Hand-wash Automatic car wash Prior to cleaning the engine compartment, make sure to protect electrical components and connectors from the intrusion of water and cleaning agents. Do not use hot water or wash your vehicle in direct sunlight. You can have your car washed in an automatic car wash from the start. Automatic car washes without brushes are preferable. Corrosion protection, such as MB Anticorrosion Wax should be applied to the engine compartment after every engine cleaning. Before applying, all control linkage bushings and joints should be lubricated. The poly-V-belt and all pulleys should be protected from any wax. Vehicle washing In the winter, thoroughly remove all traces of road salt as soon as possible. When washing the vehicle underbody, do not forget to clean the inner sides of the wheels. 왘 왘 Use only a mild car wash detergent, such as Mercedes-Benz approved Car Shampoo. Thoroughly spray the vehicle with a diffused jet of water. Direct only a very weak spray towards the ventilation intake. 왘 Use plenty of water and rinse the sponge and chamois frequently. 왘 Rinse with clean water and thoroughly dry with a chamois. Do not allow cleaning agents to dry on the finish. ! Do not use scouring agents on these parts. Never apply strong force and only use a soft, non-scratching cloth when cleaning the vehicle. Do not attempt to wipe the surface with a dry cloth or sponge. Otherwise you may scratch or damage the paint. 왘 To protect the filter system, switch the climate control (컄 page 178) or automatic climate control (컄 page 189) to air recirculation mode. ! Do not clean your vehicle in an automatic touchless car wash which uses caustic spray. Otherwise the caustic spray will damage the paint or ornamental moldings. If the vehicle is very dirty, prewash it before running it through the automatic car wash. ! Make sure that the windshield wiper switch is set to 0 (컄 page 56). Otherwise, the rain sensor* could activate and cause the wipers to move unintentionally. This may lead to vehicle damage. Due to the width of the vehicle, fold in exterior rear view mirrors prior to running the vehicle through an automatic car wash to prevent damage to the mirrors. 339 Operation Vehicle care automatic car wash, wipe any wax off of the windshield (컄 page 340). This will prevent smears and reduce wiping noise which can be caused by residual wax on the windshield. Headlamps, tail lamps, side makers, turn signal lenses Cleaning the windows and the wiper blades 왘 ! The windshield wipers must be in a vertical When leaving the car wash, make sure that the mirrors are folded out. Otherwise they may vibrate. ! Only use window cleaners that are suitable i After running the vehicle through an Ornamental moldings For regular cleaning and care of very dirty chrome-plated parts, use a chrome cleaner. ! Do not use chrome cleaner on ornamental moldings. Although ornamental moldings may have chrome appearance, they could be made of anodized aluminum that will be damaged when cleaned with chrome cleaner. Instead, use a damp cloth to clean those ornamental moldings. For very dirty ornamental moldings of which you are sure are chrome-plated, use a chrome cleaner. If in doubt whether an ornamental molding is chrome-plated, contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. 340 Use a mild car wash detergent, such as Mercedes-Benz approved Car Shampoo, with plenty of water. for plastic lamp lenses. Window cleaning solutions which are not suitable may damage the plastic lamp lenses of the headlamps. Therefore, do not use abrasives, solvents or cleaners that contain solvents. Never apply strong force and use only a soft, non-scratchy cloth when cleaning the lenses. Do not attempt to wipe dirty lenses with a dry cloth or sponge. Otherwise you may scratch or damage the lens surface. position before folding them away from the windshield. They could otherwise damage the hood. Never open the hood when the wiper arms are folded forward. 왘 Make sure the hood is fully closed. 왘 Switch on the ignition (컄 page 37). 왘 Turn combination switch to wiper setting II (컄 page 56). 왘 With wiper arms in vertical position, switch off the ignition (컄 page 37). Warning! G For safety reasons, switch off wipers and remove SmartKey from starter switch before cleaning the windshield and/or the wiper blades. Otherwise, the wiper motor could suddenly turn on and cause injury. Operation Vehicle care 왘 Fold the wiper arms forward until they snap into place. ! Do not pull on the wiper blade inserts. They Rear window cleaning Light alloy wheels Clean the rear window with the hardtop fully raised and closed. If possible, clean wheels once a week. could tear. 왘 Clean the wiper blade inserts with a clean cloth and detergent solution. 왘 Use a clean cloth and a mild window cleaning solution on all outside and inside glass surfaces. An automotive glass cleaner is recommended. ! Fold the windshield wiper arms back onto the windshield before turning the SmartKey in the starter switch. Hold on to the wiper when folding the wiper arm back. If released, the force of the impact from the tensioning spring could crack the windshield. ! To clean the window interior, do not use a dry cloth, abrasives, solvents or cleaners containing solvents. Do not touch the inside of the front, rear or side windows with hard objects such as an ice scraper or ring. Doing so may damage the windows. Warning! G Do not clean the rear window with the hardtop in a position other than the fully raised and closed position. Otherwise, the hardtop may move unexpectedly which may result in personal injury to you or others. 왘 Use a clean cloth and a mild window cleaning solution on all outside and inside glass surfaces. An automotive glass cleaner is recommended. 왘 Use Mercedes-Benz approved Wheel Care, a soft bristle brush and a strong spray of water for cleaning the light alloy wheels. ! Only use acid-free cleaning materials. Acid may cause corrosion or damage the clear coat. ! The vehicle should not be parked for an extended period of time immediately after it has been cleaned, especially not after the wheel rims have been cleaned with wheel rim cleaner. Wheel rim cleaners can lead to increased corrosion of the brake discs and brake pads. Non-approved wheel cleaners may also damage the wheel paint if the car is not driven after cleaning. Therefore, the vehicle’s brake system should always be warmed-up before it is parked after cleaning. To do so, please drive your vehicle for several minutes to allow the brakes to dry. When applying Mercedes-Benz approved Tire Care and Mercedes-Benz approved Wheel Care products, take care not to spray them on the brake discs. 341 Operation Vehicle care Plastic and rubber parts ! Do not use oil, wax or scouring agents on 왘 these parts. 왘 Use a gentle dishwashing detergent or mild detergent for delicate fabrics as a washing solution. Wipe with a cloth moistened in a lukewarm solution. The surface may temporarily change color. If this is the case, wait for it to dry. Never apply strong force and only use a soft, non-scratching cloth when cleaning the surface. Do not attempt to wipe the surface with a dry cloth or sponge. Otherwise you may scratch or damage the surface. Hard plastic trim items 왘 Warning! G Do not use cleaners or cockpit care sprays containing solvents to clean the cockpit or the steering wheel. Cleaners containing solvents will make the surface porous and vehicle occupants could suffer serious injuries from plastic parts coming loose in the event of air bag deployment. 342 Use Mercedes-Benz approved Interior Care, a soft, lint-free cloth and apply with light pressure. ! Never apply strong force and only use a soft, non-scratching cloth when cleaning the surface. Do not attempt to wipe the surface with a dry cloth or sponge. Otherwise you may scratch or damage the surface. Steering wheel and gearshift/gear selector lever 왘 Wipe with a damp cloth and dry thoroughly or clean with Mercedes-Benz approved Leather Care. Carpets 왘 Use Mercedes-Benz approved Carpet and Fabric Care for cleaning the carpets. Headliner 왘 Use a soft bristle brush or a dry-shampoo cleaner in case of excessive dirt. Operation Vehicle care Seat belts 왘 Use only clear, lukewarm water and soap. ! The seat belts must not be treated with chemical cleaning agents. Do not dry the seat belts at temperatures above 176°F (80°C) or in direct sunlight. Warning! G Do not bleach or dye seat belts as this may severely weaken them. In a crash they may not be able to provide adequate protection. Upholstery Using aftermarket seat covers or wearing clothing that have the tendency to give off coloring (e.g. when wet, etc.) may cause the upholstery to become permanently discolored. By lining the seats with a proper intermediate cover, contact-discoloration will be prevented. Warning! G Only use seat covers which have been tested and approved by Mercedes-Benz for your vehicle model. Using other seat covers may interfere with or prevent the deployment of the head-thorax air bags. Contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center for availability. Leather upholstery Exercise particular care when cleaning perforated leather as its underside should not become wet. Wood trims 왘 Dampen cloth using water and use damp cloth to clean wood trims in your vehicle. ! Do not use solvents like tar remover or wheel cleaner nor polishes or waxes as these may be abrasive. Please note that leather upholstery is a natural product and is therefore subject to a natural aging process. Leather upholstery may also react to certain ambient influences such as high humidity or high temperature by showing wrinkles for example. 왘 Wipe leather upholstery with a damp cloth and dry thoroughly or clean with Mercedes-Benz approved Leather Care. ! Wipe with light pressure, to avoid damage to the upholstery. 343 344 Practical hints What to do if … Where will I find...? Unlocking/locking in an emergency Opening/closing in an emergency Replacing SmartKey batteries Replacing bulbs Replacing wiper blades Flat tire Battery Jump starting Towing the vehicle Fuses 345 Practical hints What to do if … Lamps in instrument cluster Problem - General information: If any of the following lamps in the instrument cluster fails to come on during the Possible cause/consequence bulb self-check when switching on ignition (컄 page 37), have the respective bulb checked and replaced if necessary. Suggested solution The yellow ABS indicator lamp comes on The ABS has detected a malfunction 왘 Continue driving with added caution. when the engine is running. and has switched off. The BAS and Wheels may lock during hard braking, ESP® are also switched off (see mesreducing steering capability. sages in the multifunction display). 왘 Read and observe messages in the The brake system is still functioning multifunction display (컄 page 356). normally but without the systems 왘 Have the system checked at an specified above. authorized Mercedes-Benz Center as If the ABS control unit is malfunctionsoon as possible. ing, other systems such as the navigaFailure to follow these instructions intion system* or the automatic creases the risk of an accident. transmission* may also be malfunctioning. The charging voltage has fallen below When the voltage is above this value 10 volts. The ABS has switched off. again, the ABS is operational again an the ABS indicator lamp should go out. The battery might not be charged sufficiently. If the ABS indicator lamp does not go out: 왘 346 Have the generator (alternator) and battery checked. Practical hints What to do if … Problem - Possible cause/consequence The yellow ABS indicator lamp comes on The ABS is temporary not available. when the engine is running. The ESP® and the BAS are also unavailable. Suggested solution 왘 The system’s self-diagnosis may not be completed yet. The brake system is still functioning normally but without the systems specified above. Drive a short distance with added caution at a vehicle speed of above 12 mph (20 km/h). When the ABS indicator lamp goes out, the ABS, the ESP®, and the BAS are available again. If the yellow ABS indicator lamp does not go out: 왘 Continue driving with added caution. 왘 Have the system checked at an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center as soon as possible. Failure to follow these instructions increases the risk of an accident. 347 Practical hints What to do if … Problem USA only: ? Canada only: ± Possible cause/consequence Suggested solution The red brake warning lamp You are driving with the parking brake 왘 Release the parking brake (컄 page 53). comes on when the engine is set. running and an acoustic warning sounds. The red brake warning lamp comes on when the engine is running. There is insufficient brake fluid in the Risk of accident! reservoir. 왘 Carefully stop the vehicle in a safe location or as soon as it is safe to do so. 왘 Apply the parking brake (컄 page 59). 왘 Read and observe messages in the display (컄 page 356). 왘 Contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. Do not add brake fluid! This will not solve the problem. Warning! G Driving with the brake warning lamp illuminated can result in an accident. Have your brake system checked immediately if the brake warning lamp stays on. 348 Do not add brake fluid before checking the brake system. Overfilling the brake fluid reservoir can result in spilling brake fluid on hot engine parts and the brake fluid catching fire. You can be seriously burned. ! If you find that the brake fluid in the brake fluid reservoir has fallen to the minimum mark or below, have the brake system checked for brake pad thickness and leaks. Practical hints What to do if … Problem USA only: ? Canada only: The yellow engine malfunction indicator lamp comes on when the engine is running. ± Possible cause/consequence Suggested solution There is a malfunction in: 왘 앫 The fuel injection system 앫 The ignition system 앫 The emission control system 앫 Systems which effect emissions Such malfunctions may result in excessive emissions values and may switch the engine to its limp-home (emergency operation) mode. Have the vehicle checked as soon as possible by an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. An on-board diagnostic connector is used by the service station to link the vehicle to the shop diagnostics system. It allows the accurate identification of system malfunctions through the readout of diagnostic trouble codes. It is located in the front left area of the footwell near the hood release. i Some states may by law require you to visit a workshop as soon as the engine malfunction indicator lamp comes on. Check local requirements. 349 Practical hints What to do if … Problem Possible cause/consequence v The yellow ESP® warning lamp The ESP® has been switched off 왘 Switch the ESP® back on (컄 page 89). with the ESP® switch or has been Exceptions: (컄 page 86). switched off due to a malfunction. 왘 If leaving the ESP® switched off, adapt your Risk of accident! speed and driving to the prevailing road, weather and traffic conditions. ® When the ESP is switched off, it will not stabilize the vehicle if the If the ESP® cannot be switched back on: system recognizes that the vehicle 왘 Continue driving with added caution. starts to skid or that a wheel is 왘 Observe additional messages that may appear spinning. in the multifunction display (컄 page 359). The cruise control is deactivated 왘 Have the system checked at an authorized and cannot be switched on. Mercedes-Benz Center as soon as possible. comes on when the engine is running. The yellow ESP® warning lamp The ESP® or traction control has flashes when the engine is running. come into operation because of detected traction loss in at least one tire. The cruise control is deactivated. Suggested solution 왘 When driving off, apply as little throttle as possible. 왘 While driving, ease up on the accelerator. 왘 Adapt your speed and driving to the prevailing road and weather conditions. 왘 Do not deactivate the ESP®. Exceptions: (컄 page 86). Failure to follow these instructions increases the risk of an accident. 350 Practical hints What to do if … Problem < Possible cause/consequence The red seat belt telltale comes The seat belt telltale reminds you and your on for a maximum of 6 seconds passenger to fasten your seat belts before after starting the engine. driving off. Suggested solution 왘 Fasten your seat belts. Regardless of whether the seat belts are fastened or not, the seat belt telltale always comes on and remains lit for 6 seconds after starting the engine. < Your hear a warning chime for a You have forgotten to fasten your seat belt. 왘 Fasten your seat belt. maximum of 6 seconds after The warning chime stops sounding. starting the engine. < The red seat belt telltale comes You and/or your passenger have forgotten to 왘 Fasten your seat belts. on while the vehicle is standing fasten your seat belts. The seat belt telltale goes out. still and the engine is running or There are items placed on the passenger seat 왘 Remove the items from the passenger during driving. and therefore the system senses the passenseat and put them in a safe place. ger seat as being occupied. The seat belt telltale goes out. 351 Practical hints What to do if … Problem < During driving the red seat belt telltale flashes and you additionally hear an intermittent warning chime sound with increasing intensity. i After 60 seconds with an unfastened seat belt, the warning chime stops sounding and the seat belt telltale illuminates continuously. The seat belt telltale will only go out if both, the driver and passenger’s seat belt are fastened, or the vehicle is standing still and a door is opened. 352 Possible cause/consequence Suggested solution The vehicle’s speed once exceeds 15 mph (25 km/h) and you and/or your passenger have forgotten to fasten your seat belts. 왘 Fasten your seat belts. The seat belt telltale goes out and the warning chime stops sounding. There are items placed on the passenger seat 왘 Remove the items from the passenger and therefore the system senses the passenseat and put them in a safe place. ger seat as being occupied. The seat belt telltale goes out and the warning chime stops sounding. Practical hints What to do if … Problem Possible cause/consequence 4 The yellow fuel reserve warning lamp The fuel cap is not closed properly. Suggested solution 왘 Close the fuel cap. 왘 Refuel at the next gas station (컄 page 291). flashes after starting the engine. The yellow fuel reserve warning lamp The fuel level has gone below the comes on when the engine is reserve mark. running. Additionally you see the message Reserve fuel in the multifunction display. 1 The red SRS indicator lamp comes on when the engine is running. Warning! G In the event a malfunction of the SRS is indicated as outlined above, the SRS may not be operational. For your safety, we strongly recommend that you contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center immediately to have the system checked; After refueling you will see the message 1 message in the multifunction display. 왘 Press reset button J to confirm the message (컄 page 26). There is a malfunction in the 왘 Drive with added caution to the nearest restraint systems. The air bags or authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. emergency tensioning devices (ETDs) could deploy unexpectedly or fail to deploy in an accident. otherwise the SRS may not be deployed when needed in an accident, which could result in serious or fatal injury, or it might deploy unexpectedly and unnecessarily which could also result in an accident and/or injury to you or to others. 353 Practical hints What to do if … Lamp in center console Problem Possible cause/consequence Suggested solution 75 The passenger front air bag off in- The system is malfunctioning. dicator lamp illuminates and remains illuminated with the weight of a typical adult or someone larger than a small individual on the passenger seat. Warning! G If the 75 indicator lamp illuminates and remains illuminated with the weight of a typical adult or someone larger than a small individual on the passenger seat, do not have any passenger use the passenger seat until the system has been repaired. 354 왘 Have the system checked as soon as possible by an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. 왘 Also read and observe any messages in the multifunction display and follow corrective steps (컄 page 361). Practical hints What to do if … Problem Possible cause/consequence Suggested solution 75 The front passenger front air bag The system is malfunctioning. off indicator lamp does not illuminate and/or does not remain illuminated with the weight of a typical 12-month-old child in a standard child restraint or less on the passenger seat. Warning! G If the 75 indicator lamp does not illuminate or remains out with the 왘 Make sure there is nothing between seat cushion and child seat and check installation of the child seat. 왘 Make sure that no objects applying supplemental weight onto the seat are present. 왘 If the front passenger front air bag off indicator lamp remains out, have the system checked as soon as possible by an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. Do not transport a child on the passenger seat until the system has been repaired. 왘 Also read and observe any messages in the multifunction display and follow corrective steps (컄 page 361). weight of a typical 12-month-old child in a standard child restraint or less on the passenger seat, do not transport a child on the passenger seat until the system has been repaired. 355 Practical hints What to do if … Vehicle status messages in the multifunction display Warning and malfunction messages appear in the multifunction display located in the instrument cluster. Certain warning and malfunction messages are accompanied by an audible signal. Address these messages accordingly and follow the additional instructions given in this Operator’s Manual. Selecting the vehicle status message memory menu in the control system (컄 page 135) displays both cleared and uncleared messages. High-priority messages appear in the multifunction display in red color. 356 Certain messages of high priority cannot be cleared from the multifunction display using the reset button J (컄 page 26) or button j, k, ·, or è on the multifunction steering wheel. Other high-priority messages and messages of less immediate priority (regular display colors) can be cleared from the multifunction display using the reset button J (컄 page 26) or button j, k, ·, or è on the multifunction steering wheel. They are then stored in the vehicle status message memory (컄 page 135). Remember that clearing a message will only make the message disappear. Clearing a message will not correct the condition that caused the message to appear. Warning! G All categories of messages contain important information which should be taken note of and, where a malfunction is indicated, addressed as soon as possible at an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. Failure to repair condition noted may cause damage not covered by the Mercedes-Benz Limited Warranty, or result in property damage or personal injury. Practical hints What to do if … Warning! G No messages will be displayed if either the instrument cluster or the multifunction display is inoperative. Contact your nearest authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. i Switching on ignition (컄 page 37) causes all instrument cluster lamps (except high beam headlamp indicator lamp and turn signal indicator lamps unless activated) as well as the multifunction display to come on. Make sure the lamps and multifunction display are in working order before starting your journey. On the pages that follow, you will find a compilation of the most important warning and malfunction messages that may appear in the multifunction display. For your convenience the messages are divided into two sections: 앫 Text messages (컄 page 358) 앫 Symbol messages (컄 page 366) 357 Practical hints What to do if … Text messages Display message Possible cause/consequence ABS ABS, ESP inoperative See Operators’s Manual The ABS and are not available 왘 Continue driving with added caution. Wheels due to a malfunction. may lock during hard braking, reducing steering capability. The BAS is also deactivated. 왘 Have the system checked at an authorized The brake system is still functioning Mercedes-Benz Center as soon as possible. normally but without the systems specified above. Failure to follow these instructions increases the risk of an accident. Cruise control ESP inoperative The cruise control is malfunctioning. inoperative See Operator’s Manual The ESP® has switched off due to a 왘 Continue driving with added caution. malfunction. 왘 Have the system checked at an authorized The ABS and the BAS might not be Mercedes-Benz Center as soon as possible. operational. Failure to follow these instructions increases The brake system is still functioning the risk of an accident. normally but without the systems specified above. 358 Possible solution ESP® 왘 Have the cruise control checked by an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. Practical hints What to do if … Display message Possible cause/consequence ESP The ESP® is temporarily not available. 왘 Drive a short distance with added caution at a vehicle speed of above The system’s self-diagnosis may not 12 mph (20 km/h). be completed yet. When the message disappears, the ESP® is The ABS and the BAS might not be available again. operational. If the message does not disappear: The brake system is still functioning 왘 Continue driving with added caution. normally but without the systems specified above. 왘 Have the system checked at an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center as soon as possible. unavailable See Operator’s Manual Possible solution Failure to follow these instructions increases the risk of an accident. The charging voltage has fallen below 10 volts. The ESP® has switched off. The BAS may be switched off, too. The battery may not be charged. The battery or the generator may be malfuntioning. The ABS might not be operational. The brake system is still functioning normally but without the systems specified above. 왘 Continue driving with added caution. When the voltage is above this value again, the ESP® is operational again and the message in the multifunction display should disappear. If the message in the multifunction display does not disappear: 왘 Have the generator (alternator) and battery checked. 왘 Have the system checked at an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center as soon as possible. 359 Practical hints What to do if … Display message SRS Possible cause/consequence Possible solution Restraint system malfunction There is a malfunction in the supple- 왘 Drive with added caution to an Visit workshop mental restraint systems. The air bags authorized Mercedes-Benz Center or emergency tensioning devices (ETDs) could deploy unexpectedly or fail to activate in an accident. Transmission Visit workshop Warning! Vehicles with automatic transmission*: The provided operating safety of the automatic transmission is reduced. G In the event a malfunction of the SRS is indicated as outlined above, the SRS may not be operational. For your safety, we strongly recommend that you contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center immediately to have the system checked; otherwise the SRS may not be deployed when needed in an accident, which could result in serious 360 or fatal injury, or it might deploy unexpectedly and unnecessarily which could also result in an accident and/or injury to you or to others. and have the system checked immediately. 왘 Drive with added caution to the nearest authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. Practical hints What to do if … Display message Possible cause/consequence Front passenger airbag enabled See Operator’s Manual The passenger front air bag and the passenger-side knee bag are activated while driving even though a child, small individual, or object below the system’s weight threshold is on the passenger seat, or the passenger seat is empty. Objects on the seat or forces acting on the seat may make the system sense supplemental weight. Possible solution Stop the vehicle in a safe location as soon as possible and check the passenger seat for the following: 왘 Switch off the ignition (컄 page 37). 왘 Apply the parking brake (컄 page 59). 왘 Remove child and child restraint from passenger seat. 왘 Make sure that no objects which are applying supplemental weight onto the seat are present. The system may recognize such supplemental weight and sense that an occupant on the passenger seat is of a greater weight than actually present. 왘 Keep the seat unoccupied, close the passenger door and switch on the ignition (컄 page 37). Monitor the 75 indicator lamp on the center console (컄 page 29) and the multifunction display in the instrument cluster (컄 page 121) for the following: (Continued on next page) 361 Practical hints What to do if … Display message Possible cause/consequence Possible solution With the seat unoccupied and the ignition switched on, 앫 the 75 indicator lamp on the center console should illuminate and remain illuminated, indicating that the OCS (컄 page 71) has deactivated the passenger front air bag and the passenger-side knee bag. 앫 the message Front passenger airbag enabled See Operator’s Manual or the message Front passenger airbag disabled See Operator’s Manual should not appear in the multifunction display at any time the seat is unoccupied. Wait at least 60 seconds for the system to complete the necessary check cycles and to make sure neither message appears in the multifunction display. If above conditions are met, you can occupy the passenger seat again. Depending on the passenger classification sensed by the OCS (컄 page 71), the 75 indicator lamp will remain illuminated or go out. If above conditions are not met, the system is not working properly. Have the system checked as soon as possible by an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. Warning! If the 75 indicator lamp 362 G remains illuminated with an adult occupant on the passenger seat even after performing the above corrective steps, do not have any passenger use the passenger seat until the system has been repaired. Practical hints What to do if … Display message Possible cause/consequence Front passenger airbag disabled See Operator’s Manual The passenger front air bag and the passenger-side knee bag are deactivated while driving even though an adult or someone larger than a small individual is occupying the front passenger seat. Forces acting on the seat may make the system sense a decrease in weight. Possible solution Stop the vehicle in a safe location as soon as possible and check the passenger seat for the following: 왘 Switch off the ignition (컄 page 37). 왘 Apply the parking brake (컄 page 59). 왘 Have the passenger vacate the seat and exit the vehicle. 왘 Keep the seat unoccupied, close the passenger door and switch on the ignition (컄 page 37). Monitor the 75 indicator lamp on the center console (컄 page 29) and the multifunction display in the instrument cluster (컄 page 121) for the following: (Continued on next page) 363 Practical hints What to do if … Display message Possible cause/consequence Possible solution With the seat unoccupied and the ignition switched on, 앫 the 75 indicator lamp on the center console should illuminate and remain illuminated, indicating that the OCS has deactivated the passenger front air bag and the passenger-side knee bag. 앫 the message Front passenger airbag enabled See Operator’s Manual or the message Front passenger airbag disabled See Operator’s Manual should not appear in the multifunction display at any time the seat is unoccupied. Wait at least 60 seconds for the system to complete the necessary check cycles and to make sure neither message appears in the multifunction display. If above conditions are met, you can occupy the passenger seat again. Depending on the passenger classification sensed by the OCS (컄 page 71), the 75 indicator lamp will remain illuminated or go out. If above conditions are not met, the system is not working properly. Have the system checked as soon as possible by an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. Warning! If the 75 indicator lamp 364 G remains illuminated with an adult occupant on the passenger seat even after performing the above corrective steps, do not have any passenger use the passenger seat until the system has been repaired. Practical hints What to do if … Display message Possible cause/consequence Possible solution Run Flat Indicator The Run Flat Indicator* is malfunctioning. 왘 inoperative Have the Run Flat Indicator* checked by an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. The Run Flat Indicator* has been switched off due to a malfunction. The Run Flat Indicator* indicates 왘 Carefully bring the vehicle to a halt, avoiding that the pressure is too low in one or abrupt steering and braking maneuvers. Observe more tires. the traffic situation around you. Tire pressure Check tires Check tires Warning! Then restart Run Flat Indicator G Do not drive with a flat tire. A flat tire affects the ability to steer or brake the vehicle. 왘 Check and adjust the tire inflation pressure as required (컄 page 314). 왘 If necessary, change the wheel (컄 page 401). 왘 Restart the Run Flat Indicator* after adjusting the tire inflation pressure values (컄 page 314). There was a warning message about 왘 Make sure that the correct tire inflation pressure a loss in tire inflation pressure and is set for each tire. the Run Flat Indicator* has not been 왘 Then restart the Run Flat Indicator* restarted yet. (컄 page 316). You may lose control of the vehicle. Continued driving with a flat tire will cause excessive heat build-up and possibly a fire. 365 Practical hints What to do if … Symbol messages Display symbol Display message # Possible cause/consequence Possible solution The battery is no longer charging. Possible causes: 왘 앫 Alternator malfunctioning If it is broken: 앫 Broken poly-V-belt 왘 Do not forget that the brake system requires electrical energy and may be operating with restricted capability. Considerably greater brake pedal force is required and the stopping distance is increased. USA only: ; Canada only: ! 366 Release parking brake Stop the vehicle immediately in a safe location and check the poly-V-belt. You are driving with the parking brake set. Do not continue to drive. Otherwise, the engine will overheat due to an inoperative water pump which may result in damage to the engine. Contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. If it is in order: 왘 왘 Contact an Mercedes-Benz Center immediately. Adjust driving to be consistent with reduced braking responsiveness. Release the parking brake (컄 page 53). Practical hints What to do if … Display symbol Display message Possible cause/consequence Possible solution USA only: Check brake fluid level There is insufficient brake fluid in the reservoir. 왘 Risk of accident! 왘 Stop the vehicle in a safe location or as soon as it is safe to do so. 왘 Turn off the engine. 왘 Apply the parking brake (컄 page 59). 왘 Do not drive any further. 왘 Contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. ; Canada only: 3 Do not add brake fluid! This will not solve the problem. 2 Warning! The brake pads have reached their 왘 Have the brake pads replaced as soon as wear limit. possible. Brake wear G Driving with the message Check brake fluid level displayed can result in an accident. Have your brake system checked immediately. Do not add brake fluid before checking the brake system. Overfilling the brake fluid reservoir can result in spilling brake fluid on hot engine parts and the brake fluid catching fire. You can be seriously burned. ! If you find that the brake fluid in the brake fluid reservoir has fallen to the minimum mark or below, have the brake system checked for brake pad thickness and leaks. ! Brake pad thickness must be visually checked by a qualified technician at the intervals specified in the Maintenance Booklet. 367 Practical hints What to do if … Display symbol Display message Possible cause/consequence Possible solution • Coolant Stop, turn engine off The coolant is too hot. 왘 Stop the vehicle in a safe location or as soon as it is safe to do so. Among other possible causes, the poly-V-belt could be broken. 왘 Turn off the engine. 왘 Apply the parking brake (컄 page 59). 왘 Check the poly-V-belt. If it is broken: 왘 Do not continue to drive. Otherwise, the engine will overheat due to an inoperative water pump which may result in damage to the engine. Contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. If it is intact: 왘 Wait for the message to disappear before restarting the engine. Doing otherwise could result in serious engine damage that is not covered by the Mercedes-Benz Limited Warranty. (Continued on next page) 368 Practical hints What to do if … Display symbol Display message Possible cause/consequence Possible solution 왘 Observe the coolant temperature display (컄 page 127). If the temperature rises again: 왘 Warning! G Driving when your engine is overheated can cause some fluids which may have leaked into the engine compartment to catch fire. You could be seriously burned. During severe operating conditions, e.g. stop-and-go traffic, the coolant temperature may rise close to 248°F (120°C). Contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center immediately. ! The engine should not be operated with the coolant temperature above 248°F (120°C). Doing so may cause serious engine damage which is not covered by the Mercedes-Benz Limited Warranty. Steam from an overheated engine can cause serious burns and can occur just by opening the hood. Stay away from the engine if you see or hear steam coming from it. Turn off the engine, get out of the vehicle and do not stand near the vehicle until the engine has cooled down. 369 Practical hints What to do if … Display symbol Display message • Possible cause/consequence Possible solution The cooling fan for the coolant is malfunctioning. 왘 Observe the coolant temperature display (컄 page 127). If the coolant temperature is below 120°C, you may continue driving to the nearest specialist workshop. / Top up coolant See Oper. Manual The coolant level is too low. 왘 Avoid heavy loads on the engine (e.g. by driving uphill) as well as stop-and-go traffic. 왘 Have the fan replaced as soon as possible. 왘 Add coolant (컄 page 300). Comply with all warnings while doing so. 왘 Warning! G Do not spill antifreeze on hot engine parts. Antifreeze contains ethylene glycol which may burn if it comes into contact with hot engine parts. You could be seriously burned. 370 ! Do not ignore the low engine coolant level warning. Extended driving with this message and symbol displayed may cause serious engine damage not covered by the Mercedes-Benz Limited Warranty. Do not drive without sufficient amount of coolant in the cooling system. The engine will overheat, causing major engine damage. If you have to add coolant frequently, have the cooling system checked by an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. Practical hints What to do if … Display symbol Display message Possible cause/consequence ± Display malfunction Drive to workshop Certain electronic systems are un- 왘 Have the electronic systems checked by an able to relay information to the conauthorized Mercedes-Benz Center. trol system. The following systems may have failed: J 앫 Coolant temperature display 앫 Tachometer 앫 Cruise control display You are driving with one or more doors open. Possible solution 왘 Close the doors. 371 Practical hints What to do if … Display symbol Display message Possible cause/consequence Possible solution N Check oil level when next refueling SLK 280 and SLK 350 only: 왘 USA only: SLK 55 AMG only: Add 1 qt. engine oil when next refueling The engine oil level is too low. Check the engine oil level (컄 page 296) and add engine oil as required (컄 page 299). The engine oil level has dropped to a critical level. 왘 If you must add engine oil frequently, have the engine checked for possible leaks. 왘 Add engine oil (컄 page 299) and check the engine oil level (컄 page 296). 왘 Have the measuring system checked by an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. Canada only: Add 1 liter engine oil when next refueling Cannot measure motor oil level 372 SLK 55 AMG only: The measuring system is malfunctioning. Practical hints What to do if … Display symbol Display message Possible cause/consequence Possible solution N Engine oil level Reduce oil level SLK 55 AMG only: 왘 Engine oil level Stop, turn engine off There is no oil in the engine. There 왘 Stop the vehicle in a safe location or as soon is a danger of engine damage. as it is safe to do so. When the message Add 1 qt. (Canada: 1 liter) engine oil when next refueling (SLK 55 AMG) or Check oil level when next refueling (SLK 280, SLK 350) appears while the engine is running and at operating temperature, the engine oil level has dropped to approximately the minimum level. When this occurs, the warning will first come on intermittently and then stay on if the oil level drops further. You have added too much engine oil. There is a risk of damaging the engine or the catalytic converter. Have oil siphoned or drained off. Observe all legal requirements with respect to its disposal. 왘 Turn off the engine. 왘 Apply the parking brake (컄 page 59). 왘 Add engine oil (컄 page 299) and check the engine oil level (컄 page 296). Visually check for oil leaks. If no obvious oil leaks are noted, drive to the nearest service station where the engine oil should be topped to the required level with an approved engine oil. For information on approved engine oils, refer to the Factory Approved Service Products pamphlet (USA only) or contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. ! The engine oil level warnings should not be ignored. Extended driving with the symbol displayed could result in serious engine damage that is not covered by the Mercedes-Benz Limited Warranty. 373 Practical hints What to do if … Display symbol Display message Possible cause/consequence Possible solution A Reserve fuel The fuel level has dropped below the 왘 Refuel at the next gas station (컄 page 291). reserve mark. 4 Gas cap is open A loss of pressure has been detected 왘 Check the fuel cap (컄 page 291). in the fuel system. The fuel cap may If it is not closed properly: not be closed properly or the fuel 왘 Close the fuel cap. system may be leaky. If it is closed properly: K 374 Retractable roof You are driving with the retractable Open/Close completely hardtop not properly locked. 왘 Have the fuel system checked by an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. 왘 Stop the vehicle in a safe location. Observe the traffic situation around you. 왘 Push the retractable hardtop switch forward or rearward until the retractable hardtop is completely closed or open (컄 page 240). Retractable roof being opened The retractable hardtop is not com- 왘 Make sure the retractable hardtop is completely opened or closed. The roof pletely opened or closed (컄 page 240). hydraulics will start to lose pressure. Retractable roof locked while vehicle is moving You have attempted to open the retractable hardtop while driving. 왘 Stop the vehicle in a safe location and try to open the hardtop again. Practical hints What to do if … Display symbol Display message O I . Possible cause/consequence Possible solution You are driving with the hood open. Risk of accident! 왘 Stop the vehicle in a safe location or as soon as it is safe to do so. 왘 Apply the parking brake (컄 page 59). 왘 Close the hood (컄 page 294). Please get a new key The SmartKey is malfunctioning. 왘 Contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. Remove key You have forgotten to remove the SmartKey from the starter switch. 왘 Remove the SmartKey from the starter switch. 3rd brake lamp The high mounted brake lamp is malfunctioning. This message will only appear if a critical number of LEDs have stopped working. 왘 Contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center as soon as possible. AUTO-Light inoperative The light sensor is malfunctioning. 왘 Contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz The headlamps switch on automatiCenter as soon as possible. cally. To switch off the headlamps (U.S. vehicles only): 왘 In the control system, set lamp operation to manual mode (컄 page 143). 왘 Switch off headlamps using the exterior lamp switch (컄 page 109). 375 Practical hints What to do if … Display symbol Display message Possible cause/consequence . Brake-/tail lamp left The left brake lamp is malfunction- 왘 Contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz ing. This message will only appear if Center as soon as possible. a critical number of LEDs have stopped working. Brake-/tail lamp right The right brake lamp is malfunction- 왘 Contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz ing. This message will only appear if Center as soon as possible. a critical number of LEDs have stopped working. Front foglamp left The left front fog lamp is malfunctioning. Front foglamp right The right front foglamp is malfunc- 왘 Contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz tioning. Center as soon as possible. Rear foglamp Auxiliary bulb on The rear fog lamp on the driver’s side is malfunctioning. A backup bulb has been brought into use. 왘 Replace the bulb as soon as possible (컄 page 393). High beam left The left high beam lamp (halogen headlamps)/high beam flasher lamp (Bi-Xenon* headlamps) is malfunctioning. 왘 Replace the bulb as soon as possible (컄 page 393). 376 Possible solution 왘 Contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center as soon as possible. Practical hints What to do if … Display symbol Display message Possible cause/consequence Possible solution . High beam right The right high beam lamp (halogen 왘 Replace the bulb as soon as headlamps)/high beam flasher possible (컄 page 393). lamp (Bi-Xenon* headlamps) is malfunctioning. License plate lamp left The left license plate lamp is malfunctioning. 왘 Replace the bulb as soon as possible (컄 page 393). License plate lamp right The right license plate lamp is malfunctioning. 왘 Replace the bulb as soon as possible (컄 page 393). Reverse lamp left The left backup lamp is malfunctioning. 왘 Replace the bulb as soon as possible (컄 page 393). Reverse lamp right The right backup lamp is malfunctioning. 왘 Replace the bulb as soon as possible (컄 page 393). Low beam left The left low beam lamp is malfunc- Halogen headlamp: tioning. 왘 Replace the bulb as soon as possible (컄 page 393). Bi-Xenon* headlamp: 왘 Contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center as soon as possible. 377 Practical hints What to do if … Display symbol Display message Possible cause/consequence Possible solution . Low beam right The right low beam lamp is malfunc- Halogen headlamp: tioning. 왘 Replace the bulb as soon as possible (컄 page 393). Bi-Xenon* headlamp: 왘 Parking lamp, front left Auxiliary bulb on Contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center as soon as possible. The left front parking lamp is 왘 Replace the bulb as soon as malfunctioning. A backup bulb has possible (컄 page 393). been brought into use. Parking lamp, front right The right front parking lamp is 왘 Replace the bulb as soon as Auxiliary bulb on malfunctioning. A backup bulb has possible (컄 page 393). been brought into use. 378 왘 Front left marker lamp The left front side marker lamp is malfunctioning. Front right marker lamp The right front side marker lamp is 왘 Contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz malfunctioning. Center as soon as possible. Rear left marker lamp The left rear side marker lamp is malfunctioning. This message will only appear if a critical number of LEDs have stopped working. 왘 Contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center as soon as possible. Contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center as soon as possible. Practical hints What to do if … Display symbol Display message Possible cause/consequence Possible solution . Rear right marker lamp The right rear side marker lamp is malfunctioning. This message will only appear if a critical number of LEDs have stopped working. 왘 Tail lamp, left Auxiliary bulb on The left tail lamp is malfunctioning. 왘 Contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz This message will only appear if a Center as soon as possible. critical number of LEDs have stopped working. A backup bulb has been brought into use. Tail lamp, right Auxiliary bulb on The right tail lamp is malfunction- 왘 Contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz ing. This message will only appear if Center as soon as possible. a critical number of LEDs have stopped working. A backup bulb has been brought into use. Turn off lights You have removed the SmartKey 왘 Switch off the headlamps (컄 page 61). from the starter switch, opened the driver’s door and left the headlamps on. Turn off lights or remove key The exterior lamp switch is set to 왘 Switch off the headlamps (컄 page 61). position U, and you have forgot- or ten to remove the SmartKey from 왘 Remove the SmartKey from the starter the starter switch. The parking switch. lamps remain switched on. Contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center as soon as possible. 379 Practical hints What to do if … Display symbol Display message Possible cause/consequence Possible solution . Left mirror turn signal The left turn signal in the side mirror 왘 Contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz is malfunctioning. This message will Center as soon as possible. only appear if a critical number of LEDs have stopped working. Right mirror turn signal The right turn signal in the side mir- 왘 Contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz ror is malfunctioning. This message Center as soon as possible. will only appear if a critical number of LEDs have stopped working. Front left turn signal The left front turn signal is malfunc- 왘 Replace the bulb as soon as tioning. possible (컄 page 393). Front right turn signal The right front turn signal is malfunctioning. Rear left turn signal Auxiliary bulb on The left rear turn signal is malfunc- 왘 Replace the bulb as soon as tioning. A backup bulb has been possible (컄 page 393). brought into use. 왘 Replace the bulb as soon as possible (컄 page 393). Rear right turn signal The right rear turn signal is malfunc- 왘 Replace the bulb as soon as Auxiliary bulb on tioning. A backup bulb has been possible (컄 page 393). brought into use. 380 Practical hints What to do if … Display symbol Display message Possible cause/consequence Possible solution < Driver Please fasten belt The display reminds you to fasten your seat belt. 왘 Front passenger Please fasten belt The display reminds you and your 왘 Fasten your seat belts. passenger to fasten your seat belts. PHONE OFF This display appears if button s or t on the multifunction steering wheel is pressed and the vehicle is not equipped with a telephone*. t Ê Fasten your seat belt. This message will appear whenever 왘 Close the trunk lid. the trunk lid is open. M Close trunk partition You are trying to open or close the 왘 Close the luggage cover (컄 page 241). retractable hardtop even though the luggage cover in the trunk is not closed and/or properly engaged. W Top up washer fluid The fluid level in the windshield 왘 Add washer fluid (컄 page 302). washer fluid reservoir has dropped below its minimum mark. 381 Practical hints Where will I find...? First aid kit Vehicle tool kit, vehicle jack Removing the vehicle tool kit The first aid kit is stored in a parcel net behind the driver’s seat. The vehicle tool kit is stored in a storage compartment under the trunk floor. Vehicles with spare wheel i Check expiration dates and contents for The following is included: completeness at least once a year and replace missing/expired items. 앫 Collapsible wheel chock 앫 Vehicle jack 앫 Protective wrap (except SLK 55 AMG with Performance Package) 앫 Alignment bolt 앫 Towing eye bolt 앫 Wheel wrench 앫 Spare fuses 앫 Fuse extractor 앫 Valve extractor 앫 Electric air pump 앫 TIREFIT kit (SLK 55 AMG with Performance Package only) 382 왘 Open the trunk (컄 page 100). 왘 Lift up trunk floor. 왘 Remove the spare wheel (컄 page 385). You can now access the vehicle tool kit. Practical hints Where will I find...? Vehicles with TIREFIT* Vehicle jack Warning! 1 Collapsible wheel chock 2 Vehicle jack 3 Protective wrap 4 Alignment bolt 5 Towing eye bolt 6 Wheel wrench 7 Spare fuses, fuse extractor and valve extractor 8 Electric air pump 1 TIREFIT kit 2 Vehicle jack 3 Collapsible wheel chock 4 Towing eye bolt 5 Alignment bolt 6 Wheel wrench 7 Spare fuses, fuse extractor and valve extractor 8 Electric air pump 왘 Open the trunk (컄 page 100). 왘 Lift up trunk floor. G The jack is designed exclusively for jacking up the vehicle at the jack take-up brackets built into both sides of the vehicle. To help avoid personal injury, use the jack only to lift the vehicle during a wheel change. Never get beneath the vehicle while it is supported by the jack. Keep hands and feet away from the area under the lifted vehicle. Always firmly set parking brake and block wheels before raising vehicle with jack. Do not disengage parking brake while the vehicle is raised. Be certain that the jack is always vertical (plumb line) when in use, especially on hills. Always try to use the jack on level surface. Make sure the jack arm is fully seated in the jack take-up bracket. Always lower the vehicle onto sufficient capacity jackstands before working under the vehicle. 383 Practical hints Where will I find...? Setting up the collapsible wheel chock The vehicle jack is located in the storage compartment underneath the trunk floor. The collapsible wheel chock serves to additionally secure the vehicle, e.g. while changing the wheel. Operational position 왘 Storage position 왘 Remove vehicle jack from its compartment. 왘 Turn crank handle in the direction of arrow as far as it will go. Turn crank handle clockwise. Before storing the vehicle jack in its compartment: 앫 It should be fully collapsed. 앫 The handle must be folded in (storage position). 1 Tilt the plate upward 2 Fold the lower plate outward 3 Insert the plate 384 Practical hints Where will I find...? 왘 Tilt both plates upward 1. 왘 Fold the lower plate outward 2. 왘 Guide the tabs of the lower plate all the way into the openings of the base plate 3. Spare wheel with collapsible tire The spare wheel is located in the storage compartment underneath the trunk floor. For information on where to place wheel chocks when changing a wheel, see “Lifting the vehicle” (컄 page 407). 왘 Open the trunk (컄 page 100). 왘 Lift up trunk floor. 왘 Loosen retaining screw 3 by turning it counterclockwise. 왘 Remove spare wheel 1. 왘 Take off the wheel bolts for spare wheel 1. Storing the spare wheel with collapsible tire 1 Spare wheel, spare wheel bolts (located under plastic cover on the outside of spare wheel rim) 2 Vehicle tool kit (under spare wheel) 3 Retaining screw If you wish to store the spare wheel after use, carry out the following steps. Otherwise the spare wheel will not fit the storage compartment. ! Make sure the collapsible tire is dry when storing it. 왘 Unscrew the valve cap from the valve of the collapsible tire. 왘 Take the valve extractor from the vehicle tool kit (컄 page 382). 컄컄 385 Practical hints Where will I find...? 컄컄 왘 Unscrew the valve insert from the valve and allow the air to escape. Spare wheel bolts i It may take a few minutes for the collapsible tire to deflate completely. 왘 Screw the valve insert back into the valve. 왘 Screw the valve cap back on the valve. 왘 Pull the protective wrap provided with the vehicle tool kit over the spare wheel. 왘 Store the spare wheel and the valve extractor in the storage compartment underneath the trunk floor. 왘 Pierce the protective wrap with retaining screw 3. 왘 Secure the spare wheel by turning retaining screw 3 clockwise. For information on mounting the spare wheel, see “Flat tire” (컄 page 401). 386 1 Wheel bolt for light alloy rims 2 Wheel bolt for spare wheel with collapsible tire (located under plastic cover on the outside of spare wheel rim) ! Wheel bolts 2 must be used when mounting the spare wheel with collapsible tire. The use of any wheel bolts other than wheel bolts 2 for the spare wheel with collapsible tire will physically damage the vehicle’s brakes. Practical hints Unlocking/locking in an emergency 왔 Unlocking/locking in an emergency Unlocking the vehicle Removing the mechanical key Unlocking the driver’s door If you cannot unlock the vehicle with the SmartKey, open the driver’s door and the trunk using the mechanical key. i Unlocking the vehicle with the mechanical key and opening the driver’s door or the trunk will trigger the anti-theft alarm system (컄 page 90). To cancel the alarm, insert the SmartKey in the starter switch. 1 Mechanical key locking tab 2 Mechanical key 왘 Move locking tab 1 in direction of arrow. 왘 Slide mechanical key 2 out of the housing. 1 Unlocking 2 Mechanical key 왘 Insert mechanical key 2 into the driver’s door lock until it stops. 왘 Turn mechanical key 2 counterclockwise to position 1 until the locking knobs moves up. The driver’s door is unlocked. 왘 Pull the door handle to open the driver’s door. 387 Practical hints Unlocking/locking in an emergency Unlocking and opening the trunk 왘 A minimum height clearance of 5.78 ft (1.76 m) is required to open the trunk lid. Insert mechanical key 3 into the trunk lid lock until it stops. 왘 Turn mechanical key 3 counterclockwise to position 1 until it stops, and simultaneously 왘 pull trunk lid handle 2 and lift lid. Locking the vehicle If you cannot lock the vehicle with the SmartKey, do the following: 왘 Close the passenger door and the trunk lid. 왘 Press the central locking switch in the upper part of the center console (컄 page 103). 왘 Check to see whether the locking knob on the passenger door has moved down. 왘 If necessary, push it down manually. ! Always make sure there is sufficient overhead clearance. 왘 Turn mechanical key 3 back and remove it from the trunk lid lock. 1 Unlocking 2 Handle 3 Mechanical key 388 The passenger door is locked. 왘 Exit the vehicle and close the driver’s door. Practical hints Unlocking/locking in an emergency Manually unlocking the gear selector lever (automatic transmission*) In case of power failure, the gear selector lever can be manually unlocked, e.g. to tow the vehicle. 1 Locking 2 Mechanical key 왘 Insert mechanical key 2 into the driver’s door lock until it stops. 왘 Turn mechanical key 2 clockwise to position 1. 왘 Insert flat, blunt object (e.g. screwdriver) into the left edge of cover 1 at the position indicated by the arrows. 왘 Loosen cover 1 using this object. 왘 Using your hands, pull cover 1 out and remove. 왘 Push down and hold release 2 in direction of arrow. 왘 Simultaneously move gear selector lever out of position P. The gear selector lever is unlocked now. i The gear selector lever is locked again as 1 Gear selector lever cover 2 Release soon as you place it in position P again. The driver’s door is locked. i This procedure does not arm the anti-theft alarm system, nor does it lock the fuel filler flap. 왘 Turn back mechanical key 2 and remove it from driver’s door lock. 389 Practical hints Opening/closing in an emergency Raising retractable hardtop manually Warning! Warning! G If the retractable hardtop does not completely open or close, the roof hydraulics will lose pressure and the retractable hardtop is lowered 앫 after approximately 7 minutes when the ignition is switched on 앫 after approximately 15 seconds when the ignition is switched off Shortly before the hardtop is lowered, a warning will sound. In the multifunction display you will see K and the message Retractable roof being opened. 앫 Properly lock retractable hardtop before continuing to drive (컄 page 240). 390 G Manually closing the retractable hardtop is a complicated and technically demanding procedure and should only be performed by an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center or qualified technician. Attempting to manually close the retractable hardtop may cause damage to the retractable hardtop and/or personal injury. Warning! G To prevent possible accidents, drive the vehicle only with the retractable hardtop either completely closed and locked, or fully lowered into its storage compartment. Practical hints Replacing SmartKey batteries 왔 Replacing SmartKey batteries If the batteries in the SmartKey are discharged, the vehicle can no longer be locked or unlocked. It is recommended to have the batteries replaced at an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. Warning! G Batteries contain materials that can harm the environment if disposed of improperly. Recycling of batteries is the preferred method of disposal. Many states require sellers of batteries to accept old batteries for recycling. SmartKey Replacement batteries: Lithium, type CR 2025 or equivalent. 왘 Remove the mechanical key from the SmartKey (컄 page 387). i When inserting the batteries, make sure they are clean and free of lint. Batteries contain poisonous and corrosive substances. Therefore keep the batteries out of reach of children. If a battery is swallowed, seek medical help immediately. i When replacing batteries, always replace both batteries. The required replacement batteries are available at any Mercedes-Benz Center. 1 Mechanical key 2 Battery compartment 왘 Insert mechanical key 1 into opening. 왘 Press mechanical key 1 in direction of arrow. Battery compartment 2 is unlatched. 왘 Pull battery compartment 2 out of the housing. 컄컄 391 Practical hints Replacing SmartKey batteries 컄컄 3 Batteries 4 Contact springs 왘 Pull out batteries 3. 392 왘 Using a lint-free cloth, insert new batteries 3 under contact springs 4 with the positive terminal (+) side facing up. 왘 Return battery compartment 2 (컄 page 391) into the housing until it locks into place. 왘 Slide the mechanical key back into the SmartKey. 왘 Check the operation of the SmartKey. Practical hints Replacing bulbs 왔 Replacing bulbs Warning! G Bulbs and bulb sockets can be very hot. Allow the lamp to cool down before changing a bulb. Keep bulbs out of reach of children. Halogen lamps contain pressurized gas. A bulb can explode if you: 앫 touch or move it when hot 앫 drop the bulb 앫 scratch the bulb Bulbs Safe vehicle operation depends on proper exterior lighting and signaling. It is therefore essential that all bulbs and lamp assemblies are in good working order at all times. Correct headlamp adjustment is extremely important. Have headlamps checked and readjusted at regular intervals and when a bulb has been replaced. Contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center for headlamp adjustment. i If the headlamps are fogged up on the inside as a result of high humidity, driving the vehicle a short distance with the lights on should clear up the fogging. i Backup bulbs will be brought into use when lamps malfunction. Read and observe the messages in the multifunction display (컄 page 375). Wear eye and hand protection. Because of high voltage in Xenon lamps, it is dangerous to replace the bulb or repair the lamp and its components. We recommend that you have such work done by a qualified technician. 393 Practical hints Replacing bulbs Front lamps Lamp LED 2 Turn signal lamp 3457 AK 3 Halogen headlamp: Low beam H7 (55 W) 4 Front fog lamp 394 Type 1 Additional turn signal lamp Bi-Xenon* headlamp: Low and high beam1 1 Lamp D2S-35 W HB4 (51 W) Front fog lamp (vehicles with Sport Package* and SLK 55 AMG) H7 (55 W) Corner illuminating front fog lamp* H7 (55 W) Vehicles with Bi-Xenon* headlamps: Low beam and high beam use the same D2S-35W lamp. Do not replace the Bi-Xenon* bulbs yourself. Contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. 5 Parking and standing lamp Type W5W 6 Halogen headlamp: High beam/high beam flasher H7 (55 W) Bi-Xenon* headlamp: High beam flasher 7 Side marker lamp H7 (55 W) W5W Practical hints Replacing bulbs Rear lamps Notes on bulb replacement 앫 Only use 12-volt bulbs of the same type and with the specified watt rating. 8 Rear fog lamp (driver’s P 21 W side only) 앫 9 High mounted brake lamp Switch the lights off before replacing a bulb to prevent short circuits. 앫 Always use a clean lint-free cloth when handling bulbs. Lamp Type LED a Tail, parking, standing, LED side marker lamp and brake lamp 앫 Your hands should be dry and free of oil and grease. b License plate lamps C5W 앫 c Backup lamp P 21 W If the newly installed bulb does not come on, contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. d Turn signal lamp PY 21 W Have the LEDs and bulbs for the following lamps replaced by an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center: 앫 Additional turn signal lamps in the exterior rear view mirrors 앫 Bi-Xenon* lamps 앫 Front fog lamps 앫 High mounted brake lamp 앫 Brake lamps 앫 Front and rear side marker lamps 앫 Parking/standing lamps in the tail lamp assemblies ! Do not replace the LEDs yourself. You could otherwise damage the LEDs or parts of the vehicle. Only have the LEDs replaced by an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. 395 Practical hints Replacing bulbs Replacing bulbs for front lamps Warning! Before you start to replace a bulb for a front lamp, do the following first: 왘 Turn the exterior lamp switch to position M (컄 page 109). 왘 Open the hood (컄 page 294). Do not remove the cover 1 for the Bi-Xenon* headlamp. Because of high voltage in Bi-Xenon lamps, it is dangerous to replace the bulb or repair the lamp and its components. We recommend that you have such work done by a qualified technician. 1 Housing cover for low beam (halogen headlamps only) Housing cover for Bi-Xenon* headlamps. Do not remove. 2 Bulb socket for turn signal lamp 3 Bulb socket for high beam/high beam flasher lamp 4 Bulb socket for parking and standing light lamp 5 Bulb socket for low beam bulb (Halogen headlamps only) 396 G Practical hints Replacing bulbs Low beam bulb (Halogen headlamps only) 왘 Turn housing cover 1 counterclockwise and remove. 왘 Turn bulb socket 5 with the bulb counterclockwise and remove. 왘 Pull the bulb out of bulb socket 5. 왘 Press the new bulb into bulb socket 5. 왘 Place bulb socket 5 back into the lamp and turn it clockwise. 왘 Reinstall housing cover 1. High beam/high beam flasher bulb (Halogen headlamps) / High beam flasher bulb (Bi-Xenon* headlamps) 왘 Turn bulb socket 3 with the bulb counterclockwise and remove. 왘 Pull the bulb out of bulb socket 3. 왘 Press the new bulb into bulb socket 3. 왘 Place bulb socket 3 back into the lamp and turn it clockwise. Front turn signal bulb 왘 Turn bulb socket 2 with the bulb counterclockwise and remove. 왘 Press gently onto the bulb and turn it counterclockwise out of bulb socket 2. 왘 Press the new bulb gently into bulb socket 2 and turn it clockwise. 왘 Place bulb socket 2 back into the lamp and turn it clockwise. Replacing bulbs for rear lamps Before you start to replace a bulb for a rear lamp, do the following first: 왘 Turn the exterior lamp switch to position M (컄 page 109). 왘 Open the trunk lid (컄 page 100). Tail lamp unit Parking and standing lamp bulb 왘 Turn bulb socket 4 with the bulb counterclockwise and remove. 왘 Pull the bulb out of bulb socket 4. 왘 Press the new bulb into bulb socket 4. 왘 Place bulb socket 4 back into the lamp and turn it clockwise. 1 Bulb socket for rear fog lamp (driver’s side only) 2 Bulb socket for turn signal lamp 3 Bulb socket for backup lamp 397 Practical hints Replacing bulbs 왘 Fold corresponding trim to side. 왘 Turn the respective bulb socket counterclockwise and remove. 왘 Press gently onto the bulb and turn counterclockwise out of its bulb socket. 왘 Press the new bulb gently into its bulb socket and turn clockwise. 왘 Reinstall the bulb socket and turn clockwise until it engages. 왘 Reinstall trim. 398 License plate lamp 1 Screws 왘 Loosen both screws 1. 왘 Remove the license plate lamp. 왘 Replace the bulb. 왘 Reinstall the license plate lamp. 왘 Retighten screws 1. Practical hints Replacing wiper blades 왔 Replacing wiper blades Warning! G For safety reasons, switch off wipers and remove the SmartKey from the starter switch before replacing a wiper blade. Otherwise, the motor could suddenly turn on and cause injury. Warning! G Wiper blades are components that are subject to wear and tear. Replace the wiper blades twice a year, preferably in the spring and fall. Otherwise the windows will not be properly wiped. As a result, you may not be able to observe surrounding traffic conditions and could cause an accident. ! To avoid damage to the hood: 앫 The wiper arms should only be folded forward when in the vertical position. 앫 Never open the hood when a wiper arm is folded forward. Placing wiper arms in vertical position ! Hold on to the wiper when folding the wiper arm back. If released, the force of the impact from the tensioning spring could crack the windshield. Do not allow the wiper arms to contact the windshield glass without a wiper blade inserted. For your convenience, we recommend that you have this work carried out by an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. 1 Wiper arms 왘 Turn the SmartKey in the starter switch to position 1 (컄 page 37). 왘 Turn combination switch to wiper setting II (컄 page 56). 왘 With wiper arms 1 in vertical position, turn the SmartKey in the starter switch to position 0. 왘 Remover the SmartKey from the starter switch. 399 Practical hints Replacing wiper blades Removing wiper blades 왘 ! Do not pull on the wiper blade inserts. They could tear. 왘 Fold the wiper arms forward until they engage. Press tabs 2 together and tilt wiper blade 1 in direction of arrow. 왘 Maintaining a tilted position of the wiper blade, place cover 1 onto attachment 3 so that guide tab 2 is under cover 1. 왘 Tilt the wiper blade in direction of the arrow towards the wiper arm. 왘 Simultaneously press tabs 4 together and let the wiper blade engage into both recesses of attachment 3. 왘 Check if the wiper blade is securely fastened. 왘 Fold the wiper arm backward to rest on the windshield. Tabs 2 on both recesses of attachment 3 are detached. 왘 Maintaining its tilted position, remove wiper blade 1 out of attachment 3. Installing wiper blades 1 Wiper blade 2 Tabs 3 Attachment 4 Cover 400 Make sure you hold on to the wiper arm when folding it back. ! Make sure the wiper blades are properly 1 Cover 2 Guide tab 3 Attachment 4 Tabs installed. Improperly installed wiper blades may cause windshield damage. Practical hints Flat tire 왔 Flat tire The SLK 55 AMG with Performance Package* is equipped with a TIREFIT kit. Sealing tires with TIREFIT Warning! i SLK 55 AMG with Performance Package* Preparing the vehicle 왘 Park the vehicle in a safe distance from moving traffic on a hard, flat surface when possible. 왘 Turn on the hazard warning flashers. 왘 Turn the steering wheel so that the front wheels are in a straight ahead position. 왘 Set the parking brake (컄 page 53). 왘 Move the gear selector lever* to P (manual transmission to first or reverse gear). 왘 Turn off the engine (컄 page 61). 왘 Remove the SmartKey from the starter switch. only. Warning! G Keep TIREFIT away from sparks, open flame or heat source. Do not smoke. Small tire punctures, particularly those in the tread, can be sealed with TIREFIT. TIREFIT can be used in ambient temperatures down to -4°F (-20°C). G TIREFIT is a limited repair device. TIREFIT cannot be used for cuts or punctures larger than approximately 0.16 in (4 mm) and tire damage caused by driving with extremely low tire inflation pressure, or on a flat tire, or a damaged wheel. Do not drive the vehicle under such circumstances. Contact the nearest Mercedes-Benz Center for assistance or call Roadside Assistance. 왘 Foreign objects (e.g. screws or nails) should not be removed from the tire. 왘 Take TIREFIT, the sticker, and the electric air pump out of the trunk (컄 page 382). i Open door only when conditions are safe to do so. 왘 Have any passenger exit the vehicle at a safe distance from the roadway. 401 컄컄 Practical hints Flat tire 컄컄 Warning! G i If sealant has leaked out, let it dry. You can then peel it off. Take care not to allow the contents of TIREFIT to come in contact with hair, eyes or clothing. TIREFIT is harmful if inhaled, swallowed or absorbed through the skin – causes skin, eye and respiratory irritation. Any contact with eyes or skin should be flushed immediately with plenty of water. Two-part sticker 1 Sticker for instrument cluster 2 Sticker for wheel 왘 왘 Attach sticker part 1 where it will be easily seen by the driver on the instrument cluster. Attach sticker part 2 to the damaged tire (close to the tire vent). If clothing comes in contact with TIREFIT, change clothing as soon as possible. In case of allergic reaction or rash, consult a physician immediately. Warning! G Keep TIREFIT out of reach of children. If swallowed, rinse mouth immediately with plenty of water and drink plenty of water. Do not induce vomiting! Consult a physician immediately. Keep away from open flame or heat source. 402 Warning! G Observe safety instructions on air pump label. i Your vehicle may be equipped with either of two versions of the electric air pump: 앫 Version 1 The air hose with pressure gauge and the electrical plug are located behind a flap. 앫 Version 2 The pressure gauge is located in the pump housing. The following description applies to both versions. Differences in usage are expressly declared. Practical hints Flat tire 왘 Screw the air pump’s air hose 5 onto flange 6 of TIREFIT container 1. 왘 Stick TIREFIT container 1 upside down into notch 2 of the electric air pump. Version 1 Version 2 1 TIREFIT container 2 Notch 3 Electric air pump switch 4 Electrical plug 5 Air hose 6 Flange 7 Flap 1 TIREFIT container 2 Notch 3 Electric air pump switch 4 Electrical plug 5 Air hose 6 Flange 8 Filler hose 9 Tire valve 왘 Open flap 7 on the electric air pump (version 1 only). 왘 왘 Pull plug 4 and air hose 5 out of the pump housing. Unscrew the valve cap of the damaged tire from tire valve 9. 컄컄 403 Practical hints Flat tire 왘 컄컄 Press I on electric air pump switch 3 (컄 page 403). 왘 If the tire inflation pressure of at least 26 psi (1.8 bar) is not attained, turn off the electric air pump by pressing 0 on electric air pump switch 3 (컄 page 403). 왘 Detach filler hose 8 from tire valve 9 (컄 page 403). 왘 Drive vehicle back and forth very slowly approximately 30 ft (10 m). The electric air pump is switched on and inflates the tire. i First, the sealing is pumped into the tire. The pressure may briefly rise to up to 73 psi (5 bar). This is normal and not an indication of a malfunction. Do not switch off the electric air pump. 왘 Version 1 a Vent screw b Pressure gauge Let the electric air pump inflate the tire for approximately 5 minutes. The pressure gauge must display at least 26 psi (1.8 bar). The air hose can become hot during inflation. Please exercise appropriate caution. 왘 Close vent screw a on pressure gauge b (version 1 only). 왘 Screw filler hose 8 onto tire valve 9 (컄 page 403). ! Do not operate the electric air pump longer than 6 minutes without interruption. Otherwise it may overheat. 왘 Insert electrical plug 4 (컄 page 403) into the cigarette lighter (컄 page 256). You may operate the air pump again after it has cooled off. 왘 Turn the SmartKey in the starter switch to position 1 (컄 page 37). 404 This serves to better distribute the TIREFIT sealant material inside the tire. 왘 Unscrew the air pump’s air hose 5 from flange 6 of TIREFIT container 1 (컄 page 403). 왘 Screw air hose 5 onto tire valve 9. 왘 Inflate the tire again. Practical hints Flat tire Warning! G If a tire inflation pressure of 26 psi (1.8 bar) is not attained, the tire is too severely damaged for TIREFIT to provide a reliable tire repair. In this case, TIREFIT cannot properly seal the tire. Do not drive the vehicle. 왘 The air hose may still be hot. Please exercise appropriate caution. 왘 Place the electrical air pump back in the trunk. 왘 Close the trunk lid. 왘 Drive off immediately. The TIREFIT sealant will distribute itself evenly inside the tire. Contact the nearest Mercedes-Benz Center or call Roadside Assistance. Warning! 왘 After attaining a tire inflation pressure of 26 psi (1.8 bar), press 0 on electric air pump switch 8 (컄 page 403). The electric air pump is switched off. 왘 Turn the SmartKey in the starter switch to position 0 (컄 page 37). 왘 Detach the electric air pump. G Do not exceed vehicle speed of 50 mph (80 km/h). A TIREFIT repair is not designed to operate at higher speeds. After driving the vehicle for an initial 10 minutes, check the tire inflation pressure using pressure gauge 9 on the air pump. Warning! G If tire inflation pressure has fallen below 20 psi (1.3 bar) do not continue to drive the vehicle. Park your vehicle safely away from the roadway and contact the nearest authorized Mercedes-Benz Center or Roadside Assistance. 컄컄 Have the damaged tire replaced. The sticker must be attached on the instrument cluster where it will be easily seen by the driver. Vehicle handling characteristics may change. Adapt your driving accordingly. 405 Practical hints Flat tire 왘 컄컄 To decrease tire inflation pressure (version 2): Press yellow deflate button a located in air pump housing next to pressure gauge b. Warning! 왘 Recommended duration of use: A maximum of 300 miles (500 km) at 50 mph (80 km/h) or below with the recommended tire inflation pressure. G Follow recommend inflation pressures. Version 2 a Deflate button b Pressure gauge 왘 If the tire inflation pressure is at least 20 psi (1.3 bar), inflate or deflate the tire to correct tire inflation pressure (see placard on the driver’s door B-pillar): 왘 To increase tire inflation pressure: Switch on the electric air pump. 왘 To decrease tire inflation pressure (version 1): Open vent screw a on pressure gauge b (컄 page 404). 406 Do not overinflate tires. Overinflating tires can result in sudden deflation (blowout) because they are more likely to become punctured or damaged by road debris, potholes, etc. Do not underinflate tires. Underinflated tires wear unevenly, adversely affect handling and fuel economy, and are more likely to fail from being overheated. Do not overload the tires by exceeding the specified vehicle capacity weight (as indicated by the label on the pillar in the driver’s door opening). Overloading the tires can overheat them, possibly causing a blowout. Drive to the nearest qualified workshop, e.g. an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center, to have the damaged tire replaced. 왘 Contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center as soon as possible to obtain a new TIREFIT kit. 왘 Bring used TIREFIT materials to an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center for proper disposal. 왘 Replace your TIREFIT container every 4 years. Replacement containers are available at your authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. Practical hints Flat tire Mounting the spare wheel Warning! G The dimensions of the spare wheel are different from those of the road wheels. As a result, the vehicle handling characteristics change when driving with a spare wheel with collapsible tire mounted. Adapt your driving style accordingly. The spare wheel is for temporary use only. When driving with spare wheel mounted, ensure proper tire inflation pressure and do not exceed vehicle speed of 50 mph (80 km/h). Drive to the nearest Mercedes-Benz Center as soon as possible to have the spare wheel replaced with a regular road wheel. Lifting the vehicle 왘 Never operate the vehicle with more than one spare wheel mounted. Prevent the vehicle from rolling away by blocking wheels with wheel chocks (not included) or other sizeable objects. Do not switch off the ESP® when a spare wheel is mounted. One wheel chock is included with the vehicle tool kit (컄 page 383). When changing wheel on a level surface: Preparing the vehicle 왘 Prepare the vehicle as described (컄 page 401). 왘 Take the spare wheel, wheel wrench, wheel bolts, jack, and electric air pump out of the trunk (컄 page 382). 왘 Place one wheel chock or other sizeable object in front of and another wheel chock or other sizeable object behind the wheel that is diagonally opposite to the wheel being changed. Always try lifting the vehicle using the jack on a level surface. However, should circumstances require you to do so on a hill, place the wheel chock or other sizeable object and the other wheel chock or other sizeable object as follows: 왘 Place wheel chocks and other sizeable objects on the downhill side blocking both wheels of the axle not being worked on. 407 Practical hints Flat tire Warning! G The jack is designed exclusively for jacking up the vehicle at the jack take-up brackets built into either side of the vehicle. To help avoid personal injury, use the jack only to lift the vehicle during a wheel change. Never get beneath the vehicle while it is supported by the jack. Keep hands and feet away from the area under the lifted vehicle. Always firmly set parking brake and block wheels before raising vehicle with jack. Do not disengage parking brake while the vehicle is raised. Be certain that the jack is always vertical (plumb line) when in use, especially on hills. Always try to use the jack on level surface. Be sure the jack arm is fully seated in the jack take-up bracket. Always lower the vehicle onto sufficient capacity jackstands before working under the vehicle. 1 Wheel wrench 왘 On wheel to be changed, loosen but do not yet remove the wheel bolts in direction of arrow (approximately one full turn with wheel wrench 1). The jack take-up brackets are located directly behind the front wheel housings and in front of the rear wheel housings. 2 Jack 3 Take-up bracket 왘 Place jack 2 on firm ground. 왘 Position jack 2 under take-up bracket 3 so that it is always vertical (plumb-line) as seen from the side, even if the vehicle is parked on an incline. Warning! G Position the jack only on the jack take-up brackets designed for this purpose. If the jack is not properly positioned, the vehicle may fall off of the jack. 408 Practical hints Flat tire Removing the wheel Mounting the spare wheel Warning! G Inflate collapsible tire only after the wheel is properly mounted. Inflate the collapsible tire using the electric pump (컄 page 411) before lowering the vehicle. 왘 Jack up the vehicle until the wheel is a maximum of 1.2 in (3 cm) from the ground. Warning! G The jack is intended only for lifting the vehicle briefly for wheel changes. It is not suited for performing maintenance work under the vehicle. 4 Alignment bolt 왘 Unscrew the upper-most wheel bolt and remove. 왘 Replace this wheel bolt with alignment bolt 4 supplied in the vehicle tool kit (컄 page 382). 왘 Remove the remaining bolts. 앫 Never start the engine when the vehicle is raised. ! Do not place wheel bolts in sand or dirt. This could result in damage to the bolt and wheel hub threads. 앫 Never lie down under the raised vehicle. 왘 Remove the wheel. 1 Wheel bolt for light alloy rims 2 Wheel bolt for spare wheel with collapsible tire (located under plastic cover on the outside of spare wheel rim) 409 Practical hints Flat tire ! Wheel bolts 2 must be used when mounting the spare wheel with collapsible tire. The use of any wheel bolts other than wheel bolts 2 for the spare wheel with collapsible tire will physically damage the vehicle’s brakes. 왘 Clean contact surfaces of wheel and wheel hub. ! To avoid paint damage, place wheel flat against hub and hold it there while installing first wheel bolt. Warning! G Always replace wheel bolts that are damaged or rusted. Never apply oil or grease to wheel bolts. Damaged wheel hub threads should be repaired immediately. Do not continue to drive under these circumstances! Contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center or call Roadside Assistance. Incorrect wheel bolts or improperly tightened wheel bolts can cause the wheel to come off. This could cause an accident. Be sure to use the correct wheel bolts. 410 왘 Guide the spare wheel onto the alignment bolt and push it on. 왘 Insert the wheel bolts and tighten them slightly. Practical hints Flat tire Warning! G Use only genuine Mercedes-Benz wheel bolts. Other wheel bolts may come loose. Do not tighten the wheel bolts when the vehicle is raised. Otherwise the vehicle could fall off the jack. 왘 Unscrew the alignment bolt, install last wheel bolt and tighten slightly. 왘 Inflate the collapsible tire (컄 page 411). Inflating the collapsible tire Warning! G Observe instructions on air pump label. ! Do not lower the vehicle before inflating the collapsible tire. Otherwise the rim may be damaged. 왘 Take the electric air pump out of the trunk (컄 page 383). 왘 Open flap 1 on air pump. 왘 Pull out electrical plug 3 and air hose with pressure gauge 4. 왘 Close vent screw on air hose 4. 왘 Remove the valve cap from the tire valve. 왘 Screw union nut 5 onto the tire valve. 왘 Make sure electric air pump switch 2 is set to 0. 왘 Insert electrical plug 3 into the power outlet in the passenger footwell (컄 page 257). ! The cigarette lighter (컄 page 256) is not de1 Flap 2 Air pump switch 3 Electrical plug 4 Air hose with pressure gauge and vent screw 5 Union nut signed for use with the electric air pump. Use the power outlet in the passenger footwell (컄 page 257) for electric air pump operation. 왘 Turn the SmartKey in the starter switch to position 1. 컄컄 411 Practical hints Flat tire 컄컄 왘 Press I on electric air pump switch 2. The electric air pump switches on and inflates the collapsible tire. 왘 Inflate the collapsible tire to approximately 51 psi (3.5 bar). This takes about 5 minutes. Air hose 4 and union nut 5 can become hot during inflation. Exercise proper caution to avoid burning yourself when using the equipment. ! Compare the recommended tire inflation pressure for your vehicle with the tire inflation pressure on the yellow label located on the spare wheel rim. If the tire inflation pressure on the yellow label on the spare wheel rim differs from the values given in this Operator’s Manual, inflate the collapsible tire to the recommended tire inflation pressure given on the yellow label on the spare wheel rim. 412 ! Do not operate the electric air pump longer than 6 minutes without interruption. Otherwise it may overheat. Warning! You may operate the electric air pump again after it has cooled off. Follow recommended tire inflation pressures. 왘 Press 0 on electric air pump switch 2. 왘 Turn the SmartKey in the starter switch to position 0. Do not underinflate tires. Underinflated tires wear excessively and/or unevenly, adversely affect handling and fuel economy, and are more likely to fail from being overheated. The electric air pump is switched off. 왘 If the tire inflation pressure is above 51 psi (3.5 bar), release excess tire inflation pressure using the vent screw on air hose 4. G Do not overinflate tires. Overinflated tires can adversely affect handling and ride comfort, wear unevenly, increase stopping distance, and result in sudden deflation (blowout) because they are more likely to become punctured or damaged by road debris, potholes etc. 왘 Detach the electric air pump. 왘 Reinstall tire valve cap. 왘 Store electrical plug 3 and air hose 4 behind flap 1 and place the electric air pump back in the trunk. 왘 Lower the vehicle (컄 page 413). Practical hints Flat tire Lowering the vehicle Warning! G Inflate the collapsible tire using the electric pump (컄 page 411) before lowering the vehicle. 왘 왘 Lower vehicle by turning the crank counterclockwise until vehicle is resting fully on its own weight. Remove the jack. 왘 Tighten the five wheel bolts evenly in the direction of the arrow, following the diagonal sequence illustrated (1 to 5), until all bolts are tight. Observe a tightening torque of 80 lb-ft (110 Nm). Warning! 1 - 5 Wheel bolts 왘 Fully collapse the jack. 왘 Place the vehicle tool kit, electric air pump, and the jack back in the storage compartment underneath the trunk floor. 왘 Wrap the damaged wheel in the protective sheet provided with the vehicle tool kit and put the wheel in the trunk. i The flat tire may be transported in the trunk when the retractable hardtop is closed. For information on storing the spare wheel in the trunk after it has been replaced by a regular road wheel, see “Storing the spare wheel with collapsible tire” (컄 page 385). G Have the tightening torque checked after changing a wheel. The wheels could come loose if they are not tightened to a torque of 80 lb-ft (110 Nm). 413 Practical hints Flat tire MOExtended system* Warning! The MOExtended system allows you to continue driving your vehicle even if there is a total loss of pressure in one or more tires. G In emergency mode, your vehicle’s driving characteristics are diminished in such situations as: Do not continue driving in emergency mode if 앫 you notice knocking sounds 앫 the vehicle starts to shake 앫 smoke develops and you smell rubber You may only use the MOExtended system in conjunction with the Run Flat Indicator* (컄 page 315). 앫 driving around curves ESP® is intervening continuously 앫 앫 while braking 앫 you notice tears on the tire sidewalls 앫 while accelerating rapidly ! The maximum distance in emergency mode Therefore, your driving style must be adapted accordingly. Avoid abrupt steering and driving maneuvers, as well as driving over obstacles (road curbs, potholes, or off-road areas). This is especially important if the vehicle is heavily loaded. depends on the vehicle’s load. It is 30 miles (50 km) if the vehicle is partially loaded and 18 miles (30 km) if the vehicle is fully loaded. The point at which the maximum driving distance begins in emergency mode is when the warning message appears in the multifunction display indicating that there is a loss of tire inflation pressure. Do not exceed the maximum speed of 50 mph (80 km/h). 414 The emergency driving distance that can be achieved greatly depends on the demands placed on the vehicle. Depending on speed, load, driving maneuvers, road conditions, outside temperature, etc., the distance can be significantly shorter or, if the vehicle is driven cautiously, somewhat longer. After driving in emergency mode, you must have the rims inspected by an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center to check if they are suitable for further use. The failed tire must be replaced in any case. i When replacing individual or all tires on the vehicle, make sure only tires marked with“MOExtended” are mounted in the size specified for your vehicle (컄 page 434). Practical hints Battery 왔 Battery The battery is located in the engine compartment on the right-hand side below the water tray (컄 page 416). Warning! G G Failure to follow these instructions can result in severe injury or death. Do not place metal objects on the battery as this could result in a short circuit. Observe all safety instructions and precautions when handling automotive batteries (컄 page 303). Use leak-proof batteries only to avoid the risk of acid burns in the event of an accident. Never lean over batteries while connecting them, as you could otherwise be injured. 1 Battery 2 Positive terminal 3 Negative terminal Warning! Battery fluid contains sulfuric acid. Do not allow this fluid to come into contact with eyes, skin or clothing. In case it does, immediately flush affected area with water and seek medical help if necessary. A battery will also produce hydrogen gas, which is flammable and explosive. Keep flames or sparks away from battery, avoid improper connection of jumper cables, smoking, etc. ! Never loosen or detach battery terminal clamps while the engine is running or the SmartKey is in the starter switch. Otherwise the alternator and other electronic components could be severely damaged. Have the battery checked regularly by an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. Refer to Maintenance Booklet for maintenance intervals or contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center for further information. 415 Practical hints Battery ! Always disconnect the battery in the order Disconnecting the battery Warning! G With a disconnected battery 앫 you will no longer be able to turn the SmartKey in the starter switch 앫 automatic transmission*: the gear selector lever will remain locked in position P 1 Water tray 2 Lock 416 왘 Use a 10 mm open-end wrench to disconnect the negative lead from battery negative terminal 3 (컄 page 415). described below. Otherwise the vehicle’s electronics can be damaged. 왘 Apply the parking brake (컄 page 59). 왘 왘 Make sure the gear selector lever* is set to position P (manual transmission to Neutral). Remove the cover from battery positive terminal 2 (컄 page 415). 왘 Use a 10 mm open-end wrench to disconnect the positive lead from battery positive terminal 2 (컄 page 415). 왘 Turn off all electrical consumers. 왘 Remove the SmartKey from the starter switch. 왘 Open the hood (컄 page 294). 왘 Turn locks 2 one quarter turn. 왘 Remove water tray 1. 왘 Read and observe safety instructions and precautions (컄 page 303) and (컄 page 415). Practical hints Battery Removing the battery Charging and reinstalling battery 왘 Remove the screw on the swivel bar. 왘 Remove the swivel bar. Warning! 왘 Pull out the battery ventilation hose from the battery (depending on battery arrangement in your vehicle model, the ventilation hose is located either on the left or right side of the battery). Never charge a battery while still installed in the vehicle unless the accessory battery charge unit approved by Mercedes-Benz is being used. Gases may escape during charging and cause explosions that may result in paint damage, corrosion or personal injury. 왘 Take out the battery. G 왘 Charge battery in accordance with the instructions of the battery charger manufacturer. 왘 Reinstall the charged battery. Follow the previously described steps in reverse order. ! The battery, its filler caps and the ventilation hose must always be securely installed when the vehicle is in operation. An accessory battery charge unit specially adapted for Mercedes-Benz vehicles and tested and approved by Mercedes-Benz is available, permitting the charging of the battery in its installed position. Contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center for information and availability. Charge battery in accordance with the separate instructions for the accessory battery charger. 417 Practical hints Battery Reconnecting the battery ! Always connect the battery in the order described below. Otherwise the vehicle’s electronics can be damaged. 왘 Turn off all electrical consumers. 왘 Connect the battery positive lead 2 (컄 page 415) and fasten its cover. 왘 Connect the battery negative lead 3 (컄 page 415). ! Never invert the terminal connections! 왘 Reinsert water tray 1 (컄 page 416). 왘 Push in locks 2 (컄 page 416) and turn one quarter turn. i The following procedures must be carried out following any interruption of battery power (e.g. due to reconnection): 앫 Set the clock (컄 page 141). 앫 Synchronize the power windows (컄 page 239). 418 Practical hints Jump starting 왔 Jump starting Warning! G Failure to follow these directions will cause damage to the electronic components, and can lead to a battery explosion and severe injury or death. ! Vehicles with automatic transmission*: Do not tow-start vehicle. ! Avoid repeated and lengthy starting attempts. Do not attempt to start the engine using a battery quick charge unit. Never lean over batteries while connecting or jump starting, as you could otherwise be injured. If the engine does not run after several unsuccessful starting attempts, have it checked at the nearest authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. Battery fluid contains sulfuric acid. Do not allow this fluid to come in contact with eyes, skin or clothing. In case it does, immediately flush affected area with water, and seek medical help if necessary. Excessive unburned fuel generated by repeated failed starting attempts may damage the catalytic converter and may present a fire risk. A battery will also produce hydrogen gas, which is flammable and very explosive. Keep flames or sparks away from battery, avoid improper connection of jumper cables, smoking, etc. Make sure the cable clamps do not touch any other metal part while the other end is still attached to a battery. Attempting to jump start a frozen battery can result in it exploding, causing personal injury. If the battery is discharged, the engine can be started with jumper cables and the battery of another vehicle. Observe the following: 앫 Jump starting should only be performed when the engine and catalytic converter are cold. 앫 Do not start the engine if the battery is frozen. Let the battery thaw out first. 앫 Only jump start from batteries with the same voltage rating (12 V). Jump starting with a higher voltage battery could damage the vehicle’s electrical system, which will not be covered by the Mercedes-Benz Limited Warranty. 앫 Only use jumper cables with sufficient cross-section and insulated terminal clamps. 앫 Always make sure the jumper cables are not on or near pulleys, fans, or other parts that move when an engine is started or running. Make sure the jumper cables do not have loose or missing insulation. Read all instructions before proceeding. 419 Practical hints Jump starting Warning! G 왘 Connect negative terminal 3 of the charged battery with negative under-hood terminal 4 with the second jumper cable. Clamp the cable to negative terminal 3 of the charged battery first. 왘 Start the engine of the disabled vehicle. Keep flames or sparks away from battery. Do not smoke. Observe all safety instructions and precautions when handling automotive batteries (컄 page 303). 왘 Make sure the two vehicles do not touch. 왘 Turn off all electrical consumers. 왘 Apply the parking brake (컄 page 59). 왘 Make sure the gear selector lever* is set to position P (manual transmission to Neutral). 왘 Open the hood (컄 page 294). 왘 Flip up cover from positive under hood terminal 2 in front of water tray 1 (컄 page 416). 1 Positive terminal of charged battery 2 Positive terminal 3 Negative terminal of charged battery 4 Negative terminal 왘 ! Never invert the terminal connections. 왘 420 Connect positive terminal 1 of the charged battery with positive under-hood terminal 2 in front of the water tray with one jumper cable. Clamp the cable to positive terminal 1 of the charged battery first. Start the engine of the vehicle with the charged battery and run at idle speed. You can now turn on the electrical consumers. Do not switch on the headlamps under any circumstances. 왘 Remove the jumper cables first from negative terminals 3 and 4 and then from positive terminals 2 and 1. You can now switch on the headlamps. 왘 Have the battery checked at the nearest authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. Practical hints Towing the vehicle 왔 Towing the vehicle Mercedes-Benz recommends that the vehicle be transported with all wheels off the ground using flatbed or appropriate wheel lift/dolly equipment. ! Vehicles with automatic transmission*: Do not tow-start vehicle. ! Use flatbed or wheel lift/dolly equipment with the SmartKey in the starter switch in position 0. Do not tow with sling-type equipment. Towing with sling-type equipment over bumpy roads will damage radiator and supports. To prevent damage during transport, do not tie down vehicle by its chassis or suspension parts. Use the towing eyes. Switch off the tow-away alarm (컄 page 91) and the automatic central locking (컄 page 102). When circumstances do not permit the recommended towing methods, the vehicle may be towed with all wheels on the ground or front wheels raised only so far as necessary to have the vehicle moved to a safe location where the recommended towing methods can be employed. Warning! G If circumstances require towing the vehicle with all wheels on the ground, always tow with a tow bar if: 앫 the engine will not run 앫 there is a malfunction in the brake system 앫 there is a malfunction in the power supply or in the vehicle’s electrical system as that will be necessary to adequately control the towed vehicle. Prior to towing the vehicle with all wheels on the ground, make sure the SmartKey is in starter switch position 2. If the SmartKey is left in starter switch position 0 for an extended period of time, it can no longer be turned in the switch. In this case, the steering is locked. To unlock, remove SmartKey from starter switch and reinsert. Warning! G With the engine not running, there is no power assistance for the brake and steering systems. In this case, it is important to keep in mind that a considerably higher degree of effort is necessary to brake and steer the vehicle. Adapt your driving accordingly. ! If the vehicle is towed with the front axle raised, the gear selector lever* must be in position N (manual transmission: gear shift lever in neutral position) and the engine must be shut off (SmartKey in starter switch position 0 or 1). Active braking action through the ESP® may otherwise seriously damage the brake system. When towing the vehicle with all wheels on the ground, the gear selector lever* must be in position N (manual transmission: gear shift lever in neutral position) and the SmartKey must be in starter switch position 2. When towing the vehicle with all wheels on the ground or the front axle raised, the vehicle may be towed only for distances up to 30 miles (50 km) and at a speed not to exceed 30 mph (50 km/h). 421 Practical hints Towing the vehicle ! Towing of the vehicle should only be done i To signal turns while being towed with the Installing towing eye bolt using the properly installed towing eye bolt. Never attach a tow cable, tow rope or tow rod to the vehicle chassis, frame or suspension parts. hazard warning flasher in use, switch on ignition and activate the combination switch for the left or right turn signal in the usual manner – only the selected turn signal will operate. The towing eye bolt is supplied with the vehicle tool kit, located in the compartment underneath the trunk floor (컄 page 382). i When towing the vehicle with all wheels on the ground, please note the following: With the automatic central locking activated and the SmartKey in starter switch position 2, the vehicle doors lock if the left front wheel as well as the right rear wheel are turning at vehicle speeds of approximately 9 mph (15 km/h) or more. To prevent the vehicle door locks from locking, deactivate the automatic central locking (컄 page 102). Upon canceling the turn signal, the hazard warning flasher will operate again. i The gear selector lever* will remain locked in position P (vehicles with automatic transmission*) and the SmartKey will not turn in the starter switch if the battery is disconnected or discharged. For more information, see “Battery” (컄 page 415) or “Jump starting” (컄 page 419). The towing eyes are located on the passenger side in the front and rear bumper. 왘 Take vehicle tool kit out of trunk (컄 page 382). Front cover Vehicles with automatic transmission*: For information on manual unlocking of gear selector lever, see (컄 page 389). 1 Cover in front bumper 422 Practical hints Towing the vehicle Removing Installing 왘 Press mark on cover 1. 왘 왘 Cover 1 springs open at the top right corner. Unscrew the towing eye bolt using the lug wrench. 왘 To reinstall cover 1, tilt the marked lower left corner towards the opening. 왘 Maintaining its tilted position, insert cover 1 by applying the latches at the top left and lower right corner into the opening. 왘 To close cover 1, press on the diagonal opposite side of the marked corner until it fully engages. 왘 Pull at the protruding part of cover 1 and fold cover down to reveal the threaded hole for the towing eye bolt. Do not disconnect cover 1 from its check strap. 왘 Screw towing eye bolt in to its end stop and tighten with lug wrench. i Make sure the cover’s check strap does not Rear cover Example illustration (AMG vehicles and vehicles with Sport Package* have a square cover) 1 Cover in rear bumper get caught when closing. 423 Practical hints Towing the vehicle Removing Installing 왘 Press mark on cover 1. 왘 왘 Cover 1 springs open at the top. Unscrew the towing eye bolt using the lug wrench. 왘 Pull at the protruding part of cover 1 and fold cover down to reveal the threaded hole for the towing eye bolt. 왘 To reinstall cover 1, tilt the marked lower edge towards the opening. 왘 Maintaining its tilted position, insert cover 1 by applying the latches at the marked lower edge into the opening. 왘 To close cover 1, press on the unmarked top until it fully engages. Do not disconnect cover 1 from its check strap. 왘 Screw towing eye bolt in to its end stop and tighten with lug wrench. i Make sure the cover’s check strap does not get caught when closing. 424 Practical hints Fuses 왔 Fuses The electrical fuses in your vehicle serve to switch off malfunctioning power circuits. If a fuse is blown, the components and systems secured by that fuse will stop operating. Warning! G Only use fuses approved by Mercedes-Benz with the specified amperage for the system in question and do not attempt to repair or bridge a blown fuse. Using other than approved fuses or using repaired or bridged fuses may cause an overload leading to a fire, and/or cause damage to electrical components and/or systems. Have the cause determined and remedied by an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. i A blown fuse must be replaced by an appropriate spare fuse (recognizable by its color or the fuse rating given on the fuse) of the amperage recommended in the fuse chart. Any Mercedes-Benz Center will be glad to advise you on this subject. If a newly inserted fuse blows again, have the cause determined and rectified by an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. The following aids are available to help you replace fuses. The spare fuses and the fuse extractor are located in the trunk with the vehicle tool kit (컄 page 382) and the fuse chart is located in the fuse box in the passenger compartment (컄 page 425). 앫 Fuse chart The fuse chart explains the fuse allocation and fuse amperages. 앫 Spare fuses 앫 Fuse extractor Before replacing fuses: 왘 Apply the parking brake (컄 page 59). 왘 Make sure the gear selector lever* is set to position P (컄 page 157) (manual transmission to Neutral). 왘 Turn off all electrical consumers. 왘 Turn off the engine (컄 page 61). 왘 Remove the SmartKey from the starter switch. Fuse box in passenger compartment The electrical fuses are located in different fuse boxes: 앫 in the passenger compartment on the driver’s side (컄 page 425) 앫 on the driver’s side of the engine compartment (컄 page 426) 1 Fuse box cover 425 Practical hints Fuses ! Do not use sharp objects such as a screw driver to open fuse box cover 1 in the dashboard, as this could damage it. Fuse box in engine compartment The fuse box is located in the engine compartment on the driver’s side. Opening 왘 Open the hood (컄 page 294). 왘 With a dry cloth, remove any moisture from the fuse box. Opening 왘 Open the driver’s door. 왘 Release clamps 2. 왘 Insert flat, blunt object as a lever into recess on the edge of cover 1 at the position indicated by the arrow. 왘 Remove fuse box cover 3. Closing 왘 Loosen cover 1 from dashboard using the lever. 왘 Make sure the sealing rubber is properly positioned. 왘 Pull cover 1 out and remove. 왘 Press fuse box cover 3 down and secure with clamps 2. Closing 왘 Attach cover 1 in the front. 왘 Fold cover 1 in until it engages. 426 1 Fuse box 2 Clamp 3 Fuse box cover ! Fuse box cover 3 must be properly positioned as described to prevent moisture or dirt from entering the fuse box and possibly impairing fuse operation. Technical data Parts service Warranty coverage Identification labels Layout of poly-V-belt drive Engine Rims and tires Electrical system Main Dimensions Weights Fuels, coolants, lubricants, etc. 427 Technical data Parts service The “Technical data” section provides the necessary technical data for your vehicle. All authorized Mercedes-Benz Centers maintain a stock of Genuine Mercedes-Benz Parts required for maintenance and repair work. In addition, strategically located parts distribution centers provide quick and reliable parts service. More than 300000 different parts for Mercedes-Benz models are available. Genuine Mercedes-Benz Parts are subjected to stringent quality inspections. Each part has been specifically developed, manufactured or selected for and adapted to Mercedes-Benz vehicles. Therefore, Genuine Mercedes-Benz Parts should be installed. 428 ! The use of non-genuine Mercedes-Benz parts and accessories not authorized by Mercedes-Benz could damage the vehicle, which is not covered by the Mercedes-Benz Limited Warranty, or could compromise the vehicle’s durability or safety. Technical data Warranty coverage 왔 Warranty coverage Your vehicle is covered under the terms of the warranties printed in the Service and Warranty Information booklet. Your authorized Mercedes-Benz Center will exchange or repair any defective parts originally installed in the vehicle in accordance with the terms of the following warranties: 앫 New Vehicle Limited Warranty 앫 Emission System Warranty 앫 Emission Performance Warranty 앫 California, Maine, Massachusetts, and Vermont Emission Control Systems Warranty Replacement parts and accessories are covered by the Mercedes-Benz Parts and Accessories warranties, copies of which are available at any authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. Loss of Service and Warranty Information Booklet Should you lose your Service and Warranty Information booklet, have an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center arrange for a replacement. It will be mailed to you. 429 Technical data Identification labels 1 Certification label (on driver’s door B-pillar) The Vehicle Identification Number (VIN) can be found in the following locations: 앫 on the certification label 앫 on the center tunnel, under a carpet cover behind the passenger seat (컄 page 431) 앫 on the lower edge of the windshield (컄 page 431) 430 Example certification label (U.S. vehicles) 2 VIN 3 Paintwork code Example certification label (Canada vehicles) 2 VIN 3 Paintwork code i Data shown on certification label are for illustration purposes only. These data are specific to each vehicle and may vary from data shown in the illustration. Refer to certification label on vehicle for actual data specific to your vehicle. Technical data Identification labels 4 VIN 5 Engine number (engraved on engine) 6 VIN (lower edge of windshield) 7 Vacuum line routing diagram label 8 Emission control information label, includes both federal and California certification exhaust emission standards i When ordering parts, please specify vehicle identification and engine numbers. 431 Technical data Layout of poly-V-belt drive SLK 280, SLK 350 SLK 55 AMG 1 Idler pulley 2 Idler pulley 3 Automatic belt tensioner 4 Power steering pump 5 Air conditioning compressor 6 Crankshaft 7 Coolant pump 8 Generator (alternator) 1 Automatic belt tensioner 2 Power steering pump 3 Air conditioning compressor 4 Crankshaft 5 Coolant pump 6 Generator (alternator) 7 Idler pulley 432 Technical data Engine 왔 Engine Model SLK 280 (171.454)1 SLK 350 (171.456)1 SLK 55 AMG (171.473)1 Engine 272 272 113 Mode of operation 4-stroke engine, gasoline injection 4-stroke engine, gasoline injection 4-stroke engine, gasoline injection No. of cylinders 6 6 8 Bore 3.47 in (88.00 mm) 3.66 in (92.90 mm) 3.82 in (97.00 mm) Stroke 3.23 in (82.20 mm) 3.39 in (86.00 mm) 3.60 in (92.00 mm) Total piston displacement 182.8 cu in (2996 cm3) 213.5 cu in (3498 cm3) 331.8 cu in (5439 cm3) Compression ratio 11.3:1 10.7:1 11:1 Output according to SAE J 1349 228 hp/6100 rpm (170 kW/6100 rpm) 268 hp/6000 rpm (200 kW/6000 rpm) 355 hp/5750 rpm2 (265 kW/5750 rpm) Maximum torque according to SAE J 1349 221 lb-ft/2500 - 5000 rpm (300 Nm/2500 - 5000 rpm) 258 lb-ft/2400 - 5000 rpm (350 Nm/2400 - 5000 rpm) 376 lb-ft/4000 rpm (510 Nm/4000 rpm) Maximum engine speed 6500 rpm 6500 rpm 6700 rpm Firing order 1-4-3-6-2-5 1-4-3-6-2-5 1-5-4-2-6-3-7-8 Poly-V-belt 2404 mm 2404 mm 2380 mm 1 2 2 2 The quoted data apply only to the standard vehicle. Contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center for the corresponding data of all special bodies and special equipment. Premium fuel required. Performance may vary with fuel octane rating. 433 Technical data Rims and tires ! Only use tires which have been tested and ! Using tires other than those approved by approved by Mercedes-Benz. Tires approved by Mercedes-Benz are developed to provide best possible performance in conjunction with the driving safety systems on your vehicle such as ABS or ESP®. Tires specially developed for your vehicle and tested and approved by Mercedes-Benz can be identified by finding the following on the tire’s sidewall: Mercedes-Benz can have detrimental effects, such as 앫 MO = Mercedes-Benz Original equipment tires AMG vehicles: Does not apply to all approved tires on AMG vehicles. For information on tested and approved tires for AMG vehicles, contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. 앫 MOE = Mercedes-Benz Original Extended (tires with limited run-flat characteristics) original equipment tires Using tires other than those approved by Mercedes-Benz may result in damage that is not covered by the Mercedes-Benz Limited Warranty. i For information on driving with MOExtended tires, see “MOExtended system*” (컄 page 414). 434 앫 poor handling characteristics 앫 increased noise 앫 increased fuel consumption Moreover, tires and rims not approved by Mercedes-Benz may, under load, exhibit dimensional variations and different tire deformation characteristics that could cause them to come into contact with the vehicle body or axle parts. Damage to the tires or the vehicle may be the result. i Further information on tires and rims is available at any authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. A placard with the recommended tire inflation pressures is located on the driver’s door B-pillar. Some vehicles may have supplemental tire inflation pressure information for driving at high speeds (컄 page 313) or for vehicle loads less than the maximum loaded vehicle condition (컄 page 313). If such information is provided, it can be found on the placard located on the inside of the fuel filler flap. The tire inflation pressure should be checked regularly and should only be adjusted on cold tires. Follow tire manufacturer’s maintenance recommendation included with vehicle. i The following pages also list the approved wheel rim and tire sizes for equipping your vehicles with winter tires. Winter tires are not available as standard or optional factory equipment, but can be purchased from an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. Depending on vehicle model and the standard or optional factory-equipped wheel rim/tire configuration on your vehicle (Performance Package, Sport Package etc.), equipping your vehicle with winter tires approved for your vehicle model may also require the purchase of two or four wheel rims of the recommended size for use with these winter tires. Contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center for more information. Technical data Rims and tires Same size tires Model SLK 280 SLK 280 SLK 280 (Appearance Package*) SLK 350 SLK 350 (Appearance Package*) Rims (light alloy) 7 J x 16 H2 7.5 J x 17 H2 Wheel offset 1.34 in (34 mm) 1.42 in (36 mm) Winter tires 205/55 R16 91H M+S. 225/45 R17 91H M+S. Rims (light alloy) – 7.5 J x 17 H2 Wheel offset – 1.42 in (36 mm) – 225/45 R17 91H M+S.MOExtended 1,2 Winter 1 2 3 tires*1,2,3 Radial-ply tires Not available as factory equipment. Must be used in conjunction with Run Flat Indicator* only. 435 Technical data Rims and tires Model SLK 280 (Sport Package*) SLK 350 (Sport Package*) SLK 55 AMG SLK 55 AMG SLK 55 AMG (Performance Package*) Rims (light alloy) 7.5 J x 17 H2 7.5 J x 18 H2 Wheel offset 1.46 in (37 mm) 1.46 in (37 mm) 205/50 R17 89H M+S. or 225/45 R17 91H M+S. 225/40 R18 92H XL (Extra Load) M+S. Winter tires 1 2 3 1,2,3 Radial-ply tires Not available as factory equipment. For use with snow chains contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. 436 Technical data Rims and tires Mixed size tires Model SLK 280 SLK 280* SLK 280 (Appearance Package*) SLK 350 SLK 350 (Appearance Package*) Rims (light alloy) 7 J x 16 H2 7.5 J x 17 H2 Wheel offset 1.34 in (34 mm) 1.42 in (36 mm) 205/55 R16 91V 225/45 R17 91W or 225/45 R17 91W MOExtended* 2 Rims (light alloy) 8 J x16 H2 8.5 J x17 H2 Wheel offset 1.18 in (30 mm) 1.18 in (30 mm) 225/50 R16 92V 245/40 R17 91W or 245/40 R17 91W MOExtended* 2 Front axle: 1 Summer tires Rear axle: Summer 1 2 3 tires1,3 Radial-ply tires Must be used in conjunction with Run Flat Indicator* only. Must not be used with snow chains. 437 Technical data Rims and tires Model SLK 280 (Sport Package*) SLK 350 (Sport Package*) SLK 55 AMG SLK 55 AMG (Performance Package*) AMG rims (light alloy) 7.5 J x 17 H2 7.5 J x 18 H2 Wheel offset 1.46 in (37 mm) 1.46 in (37 mm) 225/45 ZR17 91Y or 225/45 R17 91W MOExtended* 2 225/40 ZR18 92Y XL (Extra Load) AMG rims (light alloy) 8.5 J x17 H2 8.5 J x18 H2 Wheel offset 1.18 in (30 mm) 1.18 in (30 mm) 245/40 ZR17 91Y or 245/40 R17 91W MOExtended* 2 245/35 ZR18 92Y XL (Extra Load) Front axle: Summer tires1,3 Rear axle: Summer tires 1 2 3 1,3 Radial-ply tires Must be used in conjunction with Run Flat Indicator* only. Must not be used with snow chains. 438 Technical data Rims and tires Spare wheel with collapsible tire Model All models (except SLK 55 AMG with Performance Package*) Rim (light alloy) 4.5 B x 17 H2 Wheel offset 0.47 in (12 mm) Collapsible tire 145/70-17 92P1 1 Must not be used with snow chains. ! Please compare the recommended tire inflation pressure for your vehicle with the tire inflation pressure on the yellow label located on the spare wheel rim. If the tire inflation pressure on the yellow label on the spare wheel rim differs from the values given in this Operator’s Manual, inflate the collapsible tire to the recommended tire inflation pressure given on the yellow label on the spare wheel rim. i Please note that the tire inflation pressure of the collapsible tire differs from the tire inflation pressure of the road tires. Inflate the collapsible tire to approximately 51 psi (3.5 bar). i The SLK 55 AMG with Performance Package* does not have a spare wheel. The SLK 55 AMG with Performance Package* is equipped with TIREFIT (컄 page 401). 439 Technical data Electrical system Model SLK 280 SLK 350 SLK 55 AMG Generator (alternator) 14 V/150 A 14 V/150 A 14 V/150 A Starter motor 12 V/1.4 kW 12 V/1.4 kW 12 V/1.7 kW Battery 12 V/74 Ah 12 V/74 Ah 12 V/74 Ah Spark plugs NGK PLKR 6A Bosch Platin Y 7 MPP33 NGK PLKR 6A NGK IFR6D10 Electrode gap 0.031 in (0.8 mm) 0.031 in (0.8 mm) 0.039 in (1.0 mm) Tightening torque 15 – 22 lb-ft (20 – 30 Nm) 15 – 22 lb-ft (20 – 30 Nm) 18 – 22 lb-ft (25 – 30 Nm) 440 Technical data Main Dimensions 왔 Main Dimensions Model SLK 280 SLK 350 SLK 55 AMG Overall vehicle length 161.0 in (4089 mm) 161.0 in (4089 mm) 161.1 in (4093 mm) Overall vehicle width 77.5 in (1969 mm) 77.5 in (1969 mm) 77.5 in (1969 mm) Overall vehicle height 51.0 in (1296 mm) 51.1 in (1298 mm) 50.6 in (1286 mm) Overall vehicle height when opening/closing hardtop 60.8 in (1544 mm) 60.8 in (1544 mm) 60.4 in (1534 mm) Wheelbase 95.7 in (2430 mm) 95.7 in (2430 mm) 95.7 in (2430 mm) Track, front 60.2 in (1530 mm) 60.1 in (1526 mm) 60.0 in (1524 mm) Track, rear 61.0 in (1549 mm) 61.0 in (1549 mm) 61.0 in (1549 mm) Turning circle 34.5 ft (10.51 m) 34.5 ft (10.51 m) 34.5 ft (10.51 m) 441 Technical data Weights Model SLK 280 SLK 350 SLK 55 AMG Maximum roof load 110 lb (50 kg) 110 lb (50 kg) Maximum trunk load 220 lb (100 kg) 220 lb (100 kg) ! This vehicle is not designed to carry items on its roof. Roof rails and any roof-mounted devices, unless expressly approved by Mercedes-Benz for use on this vehicle model, must not be used as they will damage the vehicle and retractable hardtop. ! This vehicle is not designed to carry any items on its trunk lid or accommodate any type of trunk lid rack or device. Using such devices may damage the vehicle and retractable hardtop mechanism. At time of printing, Mercedes-Benz does not offer any roof racks or any other roof-mounted devices for use on this vehicle. 442 Technical data Fuels, coolants, lubricants, etc. 왔 Fuels, coolants, lubricants, etc. Capacities Warning! Vehicle components and their respective lubricants must match. Therefore, only use products tested and approved by Mercedes-Benz. Please refer to the Factory Approved Service Products pamphlet (USA only), or inquire at an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. Engine with oil filter G Comply with all valid regulations with respect to handling, storing and disposing of service fluids. Otherwise you could endanger persons or the environment. For health reasons, you should prevent service fluids from coming into direct contact with you skin or clothing. If a service fluid is swallowed, contact a physician immediately. Keep service fluids out of the reach of children. Model Capacity Fuels, coolants, lubricants etc. All models 8.5 US qt (8.0 l) Approved engine oils Automatic transmission* SLK 280, SLK 350 9.5 US qt (9.0 l) SLK 55 AMG MB Automatic Transmission Fluid 9.2 US qt (8.7 l) Manual transmission SLK 280, SLK 350 1.6 US qt (1.5 l) MB Manual Transmission Oil Rear axle SLK 280 1.1 US qt (1.0 l) Hypoid gear oil SAE 85 W 90 SLK 350 1.2 US qt (1.1 l) SLK 55 AMG 1.3 US qt (1.2 l) 443 Technical data Fuels, coolants, lubricants, etc. Model Capacity Fuels, coolants, lubricants etc. Power steering All models 1.1 US qt (1.0 l) MB Power Steering Fluid (Pentosin CHF 11S or, depending on vehicle production date, Chevron Texaco PSF 9109)1 Front wheel hubs All models approx. 2.1 oz (60 g) each High temperature roller bearing grease Brake system All models 0.5 US qt (0.5 l) MB Brake Fluid (DOT 4+) Cooling system SLK 280 approx. 10.4 US qt (9.8 l) MB 325.0 Anticorrosion/Antifreeze Agent SLK 350 approx. 10.4 US qt (9.8 l) SLK 55 AMG approx. 11.7 US qt (11.1 l) Fuel tank All models approx. 18.5 US gal (70.0 l) including a reserve of SLK 280, SLK 350 approx. 2.4 US gal (9.0 l) SLK 55 AMG approx. 2.6 US gal (10.0 l) Air conditioning system All models Hydraulic system for retractable hardtop All models 0.19 US qt (0.18 l) MB Hydraulic Fluid Windshield washer system and headlamp cleaning system* All models 7.4 US qt (7.0 l) MB Windshield washer concentrate2 1 2 Premium unleaded gasoline: Minimum posted Octane 91 (average of 96 RON/86 MON) R-134a refrigerant and special PAG lubricant oil (never R-12) For detailed information, please refer to the Factory Approved Service Products pamphlet (USA only) or contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. Use MB Windshield Washer Concentrate“MB SummerFit” and water for temperatures above freezing point or MB Windshield Washer Concentrate “MB SummerFit” and commercially available premixed windshield washer solvent/antifreeze for temperatures below freezing point. Follow suggested mixing ratios (컄 page 450). 444 Technical data Fuels, coolants, lubricants, etc. Engine oils Engine oil additives Air conditioning refrigerant Engine oils are specifically tested for their suitability in our engines and durability for our service intervals. Therefore, only use approved engine oils and oil filters required for vehicles with Maintenance System. For a listing of approved engine oils and oil filters, refer to the Factory Approved Service Products pamphlet (USA only), or contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. ! Do not blend oil additives with engine oil. They may damage the engine. Damage or malfunctions resulting from blending oil additives are not covered by the Mercedes-Benz Limited Warranty. R-134a (HFC) refrigerant and special PAG lubricating oil are used in the air conditioning system. ! Never use R-12 (CFC) or mineral-based lubricating oil, otherwise damage to the system will occur. ! Using engine oils and oil filters of specification other than those expressly required for the Maintenance System, or changing of oil and oil filter at change intervals longer than those called for by the Maintenance System will result in engine or emission control system damage not covered by the Mercedes-Benz Limited Warranty. Please follow Maintenance System recommendations for scheduled oil changes. Failure to do so will result in engine or emission control system damage not covered by the Mercedes-Benz Limited Warranty. 445 Technical data Fuels, coolants, lubricants, etc. Brake fluid Warning! G During vehicle operation, the boiling point of the brake fluid is continuously reduced through the absorption of moisture from the atmosphere. Under extremely strenuous operating conditions, this moisture content can lead to the formation of bubbles in the system, thus reducing the system’s efficiency. Therefore, the brake fluid must be replaced regularly. Refer to your vehicle’s Maintenance Booklet for replacement interval. Only brake fluid approved by Mercedes-Benz is recommended. Any authorized Mercedes-Benz Center will provide you with additional information. 446 ! To maintain the engine’s durability and per- Premium unleaded gasoline Warning! G formance, premium unleaded gasoline must be used. If premium unleaded gasoline is not available and low octane fuel is used, follow these precautions: 앫 Have the fuel tank only partially filled with unleaded regular gasoline and fill up with premium unleaded gasoline as soon as possible. Never allow sparks, flame or smoking materials near gasoline! 앫 Avoid full throttle driving and abrupt acceleration. Turn off the engine before refueling. 앫 Do not exceed an engine speed of 3000 rpm if the vehicle is loaded with a light load such as two persons and no luggage. 앫 Do not exceed 2/3 of maximum accelerator pedal position if the vehicle is fully loaded or operating in mountainous terrain. Gasoline is highly flammable and poisonous. It burns violently and can cause serious personal injury. Whenever you are around gasoline, avoid inhaling fumes and skin contact, extinguish all smoking materials. Direct skin contact with fuels and the inhalation of fuel vapors are damaging to your health. Technical data Fuels, coolants, lubricants, etc. Fuel requirements Gasoline additives Only use premium unleaded fuel: A major concern among engine manufacturers is carbon build-up caused by gasoline. Mercedes-Benz only recommends only the use of quality gasoline containing additives that prevent the build-up of carbon deposits. 앫 The octane number (posted at the pump) must be 91 min. It is an average of both the Research Octane Number (RON) and the Motor Octane Number (MON): (RON+MON)/2. This is also known as the ANTI-KNOCK INDEX. Unleaded gasoline containing oxygenates such as ethanol, IPA, IBA, and TBA can be used provided the ratio of any one of these oxygenates to gasoline does not exceed 10%; MTBE not to exceed 15%. The ratio of methanol to gasoline must not exceed 3% plus additional cosolvents. Using mixtures of ethanol and methanol is not allowed. Gasohol, which contains 10% ethanol and 90% unleaded gasoline, can be used. After an extended period of using fuels without such additives, carbon deposits can build up, especially on the intake valves and in the combustion area, leading to engine performance problems such as: 앫 Warm-up hesitation 앫 Unstable idle 앫 Knocking/pinging 앫 Misfire 앫 Power loss In areas where carbon deposits may be encountered due to lack of availability of gasolines which contain these additives, Mercedes-Benz recommends the use of additives approved by us for use on Mercedes-Benz vehicles. Refer to Factory Approved Service Products pamphlet (USA only) or contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center for a listing of approved product(s). Follow directions on product label. Do not blend other fuel additives with fuel. This only results in unnecessary costs and may be harmful to engine operation. ! Damage or malfunction resulting from poor fuel quality or from blending additional fuel additives other than those tested and approved by us for use on Mercedes-Benz vehicles are not covered by the Mercedes-Benz Limited Warranty. These blends must also meet all other fuel requirements, such as resistance to spark knock, boiling range, vapor pressure, etc. 447 Technical data Fuels, coolants, lubricants, etc. Coolants The engine coolant is a mixture of water and anticorrosion/antifreeze, which provides: 앫 Corrosion protection 앫 Freeze protection 앫 Boiling protection (by increasing the boiling point) The cooling system was filled at the factory with a coolant providing freeze protection to approximately -35°F (-37°C) and corrosion protection. ! Add premixed coolant solution only. Adding water and MB 325.0 Anticorrosion/Antifreeze separately from each other, could cause engine damage not covered by the Mercedes-Benz Limited Warranty. If the antifreeze mixture is effective to -35°F (-37°C), the boiling point of the coolant in the pressurized cooling system is reached at approximately 266°F (130°C). 448 The coolant solution must be used year round to provide the necessary corrosion protection and increase boil-over protection. Refer to Maintenance Booklet for replacement interval. Coolant system design and coolant used determine the replacement interval. The replacement interval published in the Maintenance Booklet is only applicable if MB 325.0 Anticorrosion/Antifreeze solution or other Mercedes-Benz approved products of equal specification are used to renew the coolant concentration or bring it back up to the proper level. For information on other Mercedes-Benz approved products of equal specification, refer to the Factory Approved Service Products pamphlet (USA only) or contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. To provide important corrosion protection, the solution must be at least 50% anticorrosion/antifreeze (equivalent to freeze protection to approximately -35°F [-37°C]). If you use a solution that is more than 55% anticorrosion/antifreeze (freeze protection to approximately -49°F [-45°C]), the engine temperature will increase due to the lower heat transfer capability of the solution. Therefore, do not use more than this amount of anticorrosion/antifreeze. If the coolant level is low, water and MB 325.0 Anticorrosion/Antifreeze should be used to bring it up to the proper level (have cooling system checked for signs of leakage). Please make sure the mixture is in accordance with label instructions. The water in the cooling system must meet minimum requirements, which are usually satisfied by normal drinking water. If you are not sure about the water quality, contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. Technical data Fuels, coolants, lubricants, etc. Anticorrosion/antifreeze Your vehicle contains a number of aluminum parts. The use of aluminum components in motor vehicle engines necessitates that anticorrosion/antifreeze coolant used in such engines be specifically formulated to protect the aluminum parts. Failure to use such anticorrosion/antifreeze coolant will result in a significantly shortened service life. Therefore, the following product is strongly recommended for use in your vehicle: MB 325.0 Anticorrosion/Antifreeze agent. Before the start of the winter season (or once a year in hot southern regions), you should have the anticorrosion/antifreeze concentration checked. The coolant is also regularly checked each time you bring your vehicle to an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center for service. Anticorrosion/antifreeze quantity Model Approximate freeze protection -35°F (-37°C) -49°F (-45°C) SLK 280, SLK 350 5.4 US qt (5.1 l) 6.0 US qt (5.6 l) SLK 55 AMG 5.9 US qt (5.5 l) 6.4 US qt (6.1 l) 449 Technical data Fuels, coolants, lubricants, etc. Windshield washer system and headlamp cleaning system* Warning! Washer solvent/antifreeze is highly flammable. Do not spill washer solvent/antifreeze on hot engine parts because it may ignite and burn. You could be seriously burned. Both the windshield washer system and headlamp cleaning system* are supplied from the windshield washer reservoir. The windshield washer reservoir has a capacity of approximately 7.4 US qt (7.0 l). 왘 Refill the reservoir with MB Windshield Washer Concentrate “MB SummerFit” and water (or concentrate and commercially available premixed windshield washer solvent/antifreeze, depending on ambient temperatures). G Windshield and headlamp washer fluid mixing ratio For temperatures above freezing point, use MB Windshield Washer Concentrate “MB SummerFit” and water: 앫 1 part “MB SummerFit” to100 parts water (1.34 fl oz [40 ml] “MB SummerFit” to 1 gal [4.0 l] water) 450 For temperatures below freezing point, use MB Windshield Washer Concentrate “MB SummerFit” and commercially available premixed windshield washer solvent/antifreeze: 앫 1 part “MB SummerFit” to 100 parts solvent (1.34 fl oz [40 ml] “MB SummerFit” to 1 gal [4.0 l] solvent) Index A ABS 84 Indicator lamp 346, 347 Messages in the multifunction display 358 Accelerator position, automatic transmission 159 Accessory weight 327 Accident 58 Air bags 66 Children in the vehicle 79 Front 69 Head-thorax 70 Knee bag 70 Occupant Classification System (OCS) 71 Passenger 69 Passenger front air bag off indicator lamp 74 Safety guidelines 68 Air conditioning Automatic climate control* 191 Climate control 180 Air conditioning refrigerant 445 Air pressure see Tire inflation pressure AIRSCARF neck level heating* 105 Alarm system see Anti-theft systems Alignment bolt (Vehicle tool kit) 382, 409 Anticorrosion/antifreeze 449 Antilock Brake System see ABS Anti-theft systems 90 Alarm system 90 Immobilizer 90 Tow-away alarm 91 Ashtray 32, 255 Aspect ratio 327 Audio search function 146 Audio system 193 Audio and telephone*, operation 193 CD changer* 212 CD operation 208 Introduction to satellite radio* (USA only) 203 MP3 210 Operating and display elements 194 Auto-dimming*, Rear view mirrors 169 Automatic central locking 102 Control system 146 Automatic climate control* 182 Air conditioning refrigerant 444 Air conditioning, Cooling 191 Air recirculation mode 189 Air vents 182, 187 Air volume 188 Automatic mode 186 Control panel 184 451 Index Deactivating 185 Defrosting 170, 188 Residual heat utilization 192 Sun sensor 25 Temperature 186 Automatic shift program 161 Automatic transmission* Accelerator position 159 Automatic shift program 161 Automatic transmission fluid (ATF) 300 Driving 53 Emergency operation (limp-home mode) 167 Fluid level 300 Gear ranges 160 Gear selector lever 155 Gear selector lever (Unlocking manually) 389 452 Gear selector lever control one-touch gearshifting 162 Gear selector lever positions 157 Gear shifting malfunctions 167 Gearshift pattern 52 Kickdown 159 Kickdown, manual shift program* 167 Manual shift program* 165 Program mode selector switch 161 Shifting procedure 156 Steering wheel gearshift control one-touch gearshifting* 163 B Backup lamp Messages in the multifunction display 377 Replacing bulbs 395 Bar 328 BAS 86 Batteries (SmartKey) Replacing 391 Battery (Vehicle) 303, 415 Charging 417 Jump starting 419 Messages in the multifunction display 366 Bead 328 Bi-Xenon headlamps* 394 Brake Assist System see BAS Brakes 280 Brake fluid 292, 446 Messages in the multifunction display 367 SLK 55 AMG 281 Warning lamp 348 Break-in period 278 Bulbs Messages in the multifunction display 375–380 Replacing 393 Index C California retail buyers and lessees, Important notice for 11 Call priority, Tele Aid* 268 Capacities and recommended fuels/lubricants 443 Carpets, cleaning 342 Catalytic converter 288 CD Changer* 208, 252 Player/Changer*, operation 134, 208 CD changer* (Audio system) 212 Center console Lamp 354 Lower part 30 Upper part 29 Central locking Automatic 102, 146 Locking/unlocking from inside 102 SmartKey 62 Certification label 430 CHECK ENGINE indicator lamp 349 Children in the vehicle Air bags 79 Passenger front air bag off indicator lamp 74, 354 Infant and child restraint systems 79 Occupant Classification System (OCS) 71 Cigarette lighter 32, 256 Climate control 172 Air conditioning refrigerant 444 Air conditioning, Cooling 180 Air recirculation mode 178 Air vents 172 Air volume 177 Control panel 174 Defrosting 170, 177 Residual heat utilization 181 Switching on/off 175 Temperature 175 Clock 120 Cockpit 24 Cold tire inflation pressure 328 Collapsible wheel chock 384 COMAND* system 29 Driving instructions 287 Navigation 135 453 Index Combination switch 113 High beam flasher 113 High beam headlamps 55, 113 Low beam headlamps 55 Turn signals 55 Windshield wipers 56 Control system 121 Control system menus 124 AMG 128 AUDIO 133 NAV* 135 Settings 136 Standard display 127 TEL* 149 Trip computer 148 Vehicle status message memory 135 454 Control system submenus Convenience* 147 Instrument cluster 139 Lighting 143 Time/Date 141 Vehicle 146 Convenience opening/closing* Power windows 238 Retractable hardtop 244 Coolant 448 Adding water 293 Anticorrosion/antifreeze 449 Checking coolant level 300 Messages in the multifunction display 368–370 Technical data 444 Temperature 289 Temperature gauge (Multifunction display) 127 Corner-illuminating front fog lamps* Replacing bulbs 393 Cruise control 247 Messages in the multifunction display 358 Cup holder 254 Curb weight 328 D Date (Control system) 142 Daytime running lamp mode 111 Setting 143 Deep water see Standing water Defrosting Rear window 170 Windshield (Automatic climate control*) 188 Windshield (Climate control) 177 114 Index Delayed shut-off Exterior lamps 144 Interior lighting 145 Department of Transportation see DOT Difficulties Wile driving 58 With starting the engine 52 Digital speedometer 128 Dimensions, Vehicle 441 Dipstick see Oil dipstick Direction of rotation (Tires) 307 Display text see Messages in the multifunction display Displays Digital speedometer 128 Maintenance service indicator 334 Multifunction display 121 Outside temperature 128 Symbol messages 366 Text messages 358 Vehicle status message memory 135 Vehicle status messages 356 Distance to empty (range), Trip computer 149 Door Control panel 34 Entry lamps 117 Locking in an emergency 388 Locking/unlocking, SmartKey 94 Opening from inside 99 Remote door unlock, Tele Aid* 269 Unlocking in an emergency 387 DOT 328 Drink holder see Cup holder Drinking and driving 279 Driver’s air bag see Air bags Driving 53 Abroad 287 Accelerator position 159 Automatic transmission* 53 Driving off 282 Fuel saving 279 Hydroplaning 284 In winter 286 Instructions 48, 279 Kickdown 159 Manual transmission 53 Standing water 287 Tires 283 Driving safety systems 84 ABS 84 BAS 86 Electronic traction system 88 ESP® 86 Driving systems Cruise control 247 Driving tips 159 455 Index E Easy-entry/exit feature* 44, 147 Electric air pump Inflating collapsible tire 411 Sealing tires with TIREFIT 401 Vehicle tool kit 382 Electrical system (Technical data) 440 Electronic Stability Program see ESP® Emergency call (911) 233 Emergency call system 262 Tele Aid* 263 Emergency operations Automatic transmission* (Limp-Home Mode) 167 Remote door unlock, Tele Aid* 269 Retractable hardtop 390 Selector lever*, unlocking manually 389 Trunk lid, Releasing from the inside 101 Unlocking/locking the vehicle 387 456 Emergency Tensioning Device see ETD Emission control 289 Information label 431 System warranties 10 Vacuum line routing diagram 431 Engine Cleaning 339 Compartment 294 Malfunction indicator lamp 27, 349 Number 431 Poly-V-belt layout 432 Starting 51 Tachometer 119 Technical data 433 Turning off 61 Engine oil 296, 445 Adding 299 Additives 445 Checking level (Control system) 296 Checking level (Dipstick) 298 Consumption 296 Messages in the multifunction display 297, 372–373 ESP® 84, 86 Messages in the multifunction display 358, 359 Warning lamp 350 ETD 79 Safety guidelines 68 Warning and indicator lamps 353 Exterior lamp switch 109 Exterior lighting Lamps 393 Replacing bulbs 393 Exterior rear view mirrors see Mirrors Index F First aid kit 382 Flat tire 401 Inflating collapsible spare tire 411 Lifting vehicle 407 Lowering vehicle 413 Mounting spare wheel 407, 409 TIREFIT kit* 401 Floormat 257 Fog lamps 112, 394 Corner-illuminating front fog lamps* 114 Footwell lighting* 117 FSS PLUS (Canada vehicles) 334 Fuel Additives 447 Consumption statistics (Control system) 148 Filler flap 291 Fuel tank capacity 444 MON 292, 447 Premium unleaded gasoline 292, 446 Refueling 291 Requirements 292, 447 Reserve warning lamp 353 RON 292, 447 Technical data 443 Fuel filler flap 291 Fuel gauge (Instrument cluster) 27 Fuse extractor (Vehicle tool kit) 382 Fuses 425 Fuse extractor 425 Replacing 425 Spare fuses 425 Spare fuses (Vehicle tool kit) 382 G Garage door opener* 270 Gasoline see Fuel GAWR 328 Gear range Automatic transmission 160 Limiting 160 Shifting into optimal 163, 165 Gear selector lever 155 Gearshift pattern 155 Position 156, 157 Shifting procedure 156 Gear selector lever one-touch gearshifting Automatic transmission 162 Global locking/unlocking see SmartKey Glove box 252 Good visibility 168 GPS 90, 91 Tele Aid system* 262 Gross Axle Weight Rating see GAWR Gross Vehicle Weight Rating see GVWR Gross Vehicle Weight see GVW GSM network phones (Telephone*) 219 GVW 328 GVWR 328 457 Index H Hard plastic trim items, cleaning 342 Hazard warning flasher 115, 116 Head restraint height (Seats) 42 Headlamps Bi-Xenon* 394 Cleaning system* 168, 302, 450 Night security illumination (Control system) 144 Switching off 61 Switching on 55 Headliner, cleaning 342 Head-thorax air bag 70 Heating Seats* 104 Steering wheel* 276 High beam Flasher 113 Headlamps 55, 113 Headlamps, bulbs 394 High beam headlamps 109 High mounted brake lamp 395 High-performance brake system 281 Hood 294 Horn 25 Hydroplaning 284 458 I Identification labels see Labels Ignition (Position in starter switch) 37 Immobilizer see Anti-theft systems Infant and child restraint systems see Children in the vehicle Instrument cluster 27, 118 Clock 120 Lamps, indicator and warning 346 Overview 26 Instruments and controls see Cockpit Interior rear view mirror see Mirrors Intermittent/interval wiping see Windshield wipers J Jack (Vehicle tool kit) 382 Lifting vehicle 407 Lowering vehicle 413 Jump starting 419 K Kickdown 159 Kilopascal 328 Knee bag see Air bags L Labels 430 Lamp in center console 354 Lamps in instrument cluster 346 Lamps, indicator and warning ABS 346, 347 Battery (SmartKey) 97 Brakes 348 CHECK ENGINE 349 ESP® 87, 350 Passenger front air bag off 74, 354 Fuel reserve 353 Passenger front air bag off 354 Seat belts 351–352 SRS 65, 353 Index Language in multifunction display (Control system) 139 Layout of poly-V-belt drive 432 License plate lamps 395 Light alloy wheels Cleaning 341 Technical data 434 Lighter see Cigarette lighter Lighting 109 Combination switch 113 Corner-illuminating front fog lamps* 114 Daytime running lamp mode 111 Door entry lamps 117 Exterior lamp switch 109 Exterior lamps, cleaning 340 Fog lamps 112 Footwell lighting* 117 Hazard warning flasher 115 Headlamp mode, automatic/manual 110 High beam 113 High beam flasher 113 Individual settings (Control system) 143 Instrument cluster illumination 118 Interior lighting 116 Low beam headlamps 109 Night security illumination (Control system) 144 Reading lamps 117 Standing lamps 109 Trunk 116 Limp-home mode 167 Loading 251, 307, 327 Locator lighting (Control system) 144 Locking And parking 59 Centrally (Control system) 146 Centrally from inside 102 Locking knob (Doors) 99 Locking the vehicle 62 Long trip, checking before 292 Loss of Service and Warranty Booklet 429 SmartKey or mechanical key 98 Low beam headlamps 109, 394 Lubricants, technical data 443 Luggage cover 32, 241 M Main dimensions 441 Maintenance service indicator (Control system) 334 Maintenance System 334 Manual seat see Seats Manual shift program* 165 Deactivating 167 459 Index Manual transmission 153 Driving 53 Gearshift pattern 51 Starting with SmartKey 51 Maximum inflation pressure 329 Maximum load rating 328 Maximum loaded vehicle weight 328 Mechanical key see SmartKey Memory function* 107 Menus see Control system menus Messages in the multifunction display see Multifunction display messages Mirror lamp* see Sun visors Mirrors 168 Additional turn signals 394 Adjusting 46 Antiglare position 168 Auto-dimming* 169 Exterior rear view mirrors 46 Interior rear view mirror 46 460 Mobile phone see Telephone* MOE tires* see MOExtended system* MOExtended system* 317, 414 MON 292, 447 Motor Octane Number see MON MP3 210 Multifunction display 121 Multifunction display messages 356 ABS 358 Air bags 361–364 Battery, Vehicle 366 Brake fluid 367 Brakes 367 Bulbs 375–380 Coolant 368–370 Cruise control 358 Doors 371 Engine oil 372–373 ESP® 358, 359 Passenger front air bag 363 Fuel 374 Hood 375 Maintenance service indicator 334 Parking brake 366 Retractable hardtop 374, 381 Run Flat Indicator* 365 Seat belt 381 SmartKey 375 SRS 360 Symbol messages 366 Telephone* 381 Text messages 358 Transmission 360 Trunk lid 381 Vehicle status message memory 135 Washer fluid 381 Multifunction steering wheel 28, 122 Heating* 276 Index N Navigation system* 135 Neck-level heating see AIRSCARF* Neutral gear position Automatic transmission* 155, 157 Manual transmission 154 Night security illumination (Control system) 144 Normal occupant weight 329 Number, Vehicle Identification (VIN) 430 O Occupant Classification System see OCS Occupant distribution 329 Occupant safety 64 Passenger front air bag off indicator lamp 74 OCS 71 Seat belts 48, 68 SRS 64 OCS 71 Self-test 75 Oil see Engine oil One-touch gearshifting Gear selector lever 162 Steering wheel gearshift control* 163 Operating safety 16, 193 Operating vehicle outside the USA and Canada 13 Operator’s Manual 10 Ornamental moldings see Vehicle care Outside temperature indicator 119, 128 Outside temperature/speed 140 Overhead control panel 31 Overspeed range 119 P Paintwork code 430 Paintwork see Vehicle care Panic alarm 83 Parcel net (Storage compartment) 253 Parking 59, 282 Parking brake 53, 59 Parking lamps 109, 394 Parts service 428 PASS AIR BAG OFF indicator lamp see Passenger front air bag off indicator lamp Passenger air bag see Air bags Passenger compartment 287 Passenger front air bag Messages in the multifunction display 361–364 Passenger front air bag off indicator lamp 74, 354 Passenger safety see Occupant safety 461 Index Phone book see Telephone* Plastic parts, cleaning 342 Poly-V-belt drive 432 Potential problems associated with underinflated and overinflated tires 317 Power outlet 257 Power seat* see Seats Power washer see Vehicle care Power windows 235 Operating rear side windows 237 Operating with retractable hardtop switch 237 Summer opening/convenience closing* 238 Synchronizing 239 462 Practical hints Fuses 425 Lamps in instrument cluster 346 Spare wheel bolts 386 Towing vehicle 421 Vehicle jack 383 What to do if... 346 Premium unleaded gasoline 446 Problems While driving 58 With vehicle 17 Product information 9 Production options weight 329 Program mode see Automatic transmission, Automatic shift program Program mode selector switch Automatic shift program 161 PSI 329 R RACETIMER see Control system menus, AMG Radio Operation (Audio system) 199 Operation (Control system) 133 Satellite* (USA only) 134 Radio transmitters, control and operation 287 Reading lamps 117 Rear view mirrors see Mirrors Rear window defroster 170 Recommended inflation pressure 329 Recovery services for stolen vehicle (Tele Aid*) 269 Refrigerant (Air conditioning) 445 Refueling 291 Regular checks 292 Remote control see SmartKey Index Remote door unlock with Tele Aid* 269 Reporting, safety defects 18 Research Octane Number see RON Reset button (Instrument cluster) 27 Residual engine heat utilization see REST REST Automatic climate control* 192 Climate control 181 Restraint systems Emergency Tensioning Device (ETD) 79 Seat belts 64, 76 Retractable hardtop 240 Locking after raising/lowering 242 Opening and closing 240 Operating manually 390 Problems when operating 242 Summer opening/convenience closing* 244 Wind screen* 246 Reverse gear position Automatic transmission* 155, 157 Manual transmission 154 Rims 329, 434 Roadside Assistance 12, 265 RON 292, 447 Roof rack 251 Rubber parts, cleaning 342 Run Flat Indicator* 315 S Safety belts see Seat belts Safety defects, reporting 18 Safety, occupant 64 Satellite radio* (USA only) 134 Seat belt force limiter 79 Seat belts 64, 76 Cleaning 343 Fastening 48 Proper use of 50 Release button 49 Safety guidelines 68 Warning lamp 351–352 Seating capacity 308 Seats 104 Adjusting 39 Easy-entry/exit feature* 44 Head restraint height 42 Heating* 104 Power seats* 41 Selective setting see SmartKey Selector lever see Gear selector lever Selector lever* lock 52 Self-test OCS 75 Service Information 12 Maintenance Booklet 12 Service and warranty Booklet 429 Information 10 Service life (Tires) 305 463 Index Service system Maintenance service indicator 334 Parts service 428 Settings menu (Control system) 136 Shelf behind roll bar 254 Shift program mode, Automatic transmission* 161 Shifting, Automatic transmission 155 Side marker lamps 394 Side windows see Power windows Sidewall 329 SmartKey 94 Checking batteries 98 Factory setting 96 Global locking 96 Global unlocking 96 Locking and unlocking 94 Loss of SmartKey or mechanical key 98 464 Mechanical key 387 Panic button 83 Positions in starter switch 37 Power windows, opening/closing* 238 Remote control 94 Replacing batteries 391 Restoring to factory setting 98 Retractable hardtop, opening/closing* 244 Selective setting 97 Starting engine 51 Turning off engine 61 Snow chains 333 Spare fuses (Vehicle tool kit) 382 Spare parts see Parts service Spare wheel 385 SRS Indicator lamp 353 Messages in the multifunction display 360 Standard display menu (Control system) 127 Standing lamps 109, 394 Standing water, driving instructions 287 Starter switch positions 37 Starting 37, 51 Difficulties with 52 Position in starter switch 37 Steering column see Steering wheel Steering wheel Adjusting 43 Heating* 276 Lock 52 Index Steering wheel gearshift control one-touch gearshifting Automatic transmission* 163 Stolen vehicle, Recovery services (Tele Aid*) 269 Storage compartments 32, 252 Armrest 32, 252 Between seat backrests 32, 253 Cup holder 32, 254 Door pockets 32 Glove box 32, 252 Parcel net 32, 253 Storage tray 32 Telephone* compartment 32, 252 Trunk 32 Storing tires 306 Summer opening* Power windows 238 Retractable hardtop 244 Sun visors 170 Symbols in display 366 T Tachometer 119 Tail lamps 395 Tar stains see Vehicle care TDMA or CDMA network phones (Telephone*) 226 Technical data Air conditioning refrigerant 445 Brake fluid 446 Coolants 448 Electrical system 440 Engine 433 Engine oil 445 Fuel additives 447 Fuel requirements 447 Fuels, coolants, lubricants, etc. 443 Headlamp cleaning system* 450 Main dimensions 441 Parts service 428 Premium unleaded gasoline 446 Rims and tires 434 Weights 442 Windshield washer system 450 Tele Aid system* 261 Call priority 268 Initiating an emergency call 264 Remote door unlock 269 Requirements 262 Roadside Assistance 265 Stolen Vehicle Recovery services 269 System self-check 263 Telephone* 258 Changing mobile phone cradle 261 Compartment 33, 252 GSM network phones 219 Inserting in cradle 259 Installing a different mobile phone cradle 261 Operation 149, 193 Removing from cradle 260 Tightening torque Wheel bolts 413 465 Index Time and date synchronization with head unit* (Control system) 141 TIN 329 Tire and Loading Information 308 Tire and loading terminology 327 Tire care and maintenance 305 Tire Identification Number see TIN Tire inflation pressure 404 Air pressure 327 Checking 312, 314 Tire inspection 305 Tire load rating 329 Tire ply composition and material used 329 Tire speed rating 320, 330 Tire terminology 327 TIREFIT* Instructions for use 401 Vehicle tool kit 382, 383 466 Tires 304, 434 Cleaning 306 Direction of rotation 307 Driving instructions 283 Flat tire 401 Important guidelines 304 Inflating with air pump 411 MOExtended* 434 Mounting wheel 409 Removing wheel 409 Retreads 304 Rims and tires 434 Rotating 330 Run Flat Indicator* 315 Service life 305 Sizes 434 Snow chains 333 Spare wheel 385 Speed rating 285 Storing 306 Temperature 326 Traction 284 Tread depth 306, 332 Treadwear indicators (TWI) 283 Wear pattern 331 Wheel chock (Vehicle tool kit) 382 Winter 332 Tools see Vehicle tool kit Tow-away alarm see Anti-theft systems Towing (Vehicle) 421 Traction 88, 330 Transmission Messages in the multifunction display 360 Transmission see Automatic transmission* or Manual Transmission Transporting the vehicle 92 Traveling abroad 287 Index Tread 330 Tread depth 306, 332 Treadwear indicators 283, 330 Trip computer menu (Control system) 148 Trunk 100 Lighting 116 Luggage cover 241 Trunk lid emergency release 101 Trunk lid lock 388 Turn signals 55, 394 Additional in mirrors 394 TWI see Treadwear indicators U Uniform Tire Quality Grading Standards 330 Unlocking 36 Centrally from inside 102 In an emergency 269 With SmartKey 36 Upholstery Cleaning 343 Useful features Ashtray 255 Cigarette lighter 256 Cup holder 254 Floormat (Driver’s side only) 257 Garage door opener* 270 Heated steering wheel* 276 Parcel net 253 Power outlet 257 Storage compartments, interior 252 Tele Aid* 261 V Valve extractor (Vehicle tool kit) 382 Vehicle Battery 303, 415 Bulbs 393 Fuses 425 Individual settings (Control system) 136 Jump starting 419 Lifting with jack 407 Locking 62 Proper use of 16 Towing 421 Unlocking/locking in an emergency 387 Vehicle capacity weight 330 Vehicle care 337 Vehicle Identification Number see VIN Vehicle jack 383 467 Index Vehicle loading terminology 327 Vehicle status message memory menu (Control system) 135 Vehicle tool kit 32, 382 Collapsible wheel chock 384 Vehicle washing see Vehicle care VIN 431 W Warning sounds Anti-theft alarm system 90 Exterior lighting 62, 99, 109 Maintenance service indicator Panic alarm 83 Parking brake 53, 348 Seat belts 78, 351, 352 Tow-away alarm 91 Warranty coverage 429 468 335 Washing the vehicle see Vehicle care Wear pattern (Tires) 331 Weights 442 Wheel bolts 386 Wheel chock (Vehicle tool kit) 382 Wheel wrench (Vehicle tool kit) 382 Wheels Tightening torque 413 Wheels see Tires Where will I find...? 382 Wind screen* 246 Windows see Power windows Windshield Washer fluid reservoir 302 Washer system 450 Windshield wipers 56 Replacing wiper blades 399 Wiper blades, cleaning 340 Winter driving 332 Instructions 286 Snow chains 333 Tires 332 Winter tires 332 Wood trims Cleaning 343 Service and Literature Your authorized Mercedes-Benz Center has trained technicians and Genuine Mercedes-Benz Parts to service your vehicle properly. For expert advice and quality service, contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. If you are interested in obtaining service literature for your vehicle, please contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. We consider this the best way for you to obtain accurate information for your vehicle. For further information you can find us on the Mercedes-Benz web-site www.mbusa.com or www.mercedes-benz.ca. G Warning! To help avoid personal injury, be extremely careful when performing any service work or repairs. Improper or incomplete service or the use of incorrect or inappropriate parts or materials may damage the vehicle or its equipment, which may in turn result in personal injury. If you have questions about carrying out any type of service, turn to the advice of an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. We reserve the right to make changes in design and equipment. Therefore, information, illustrations and descriptions in this Operator’s Manual might differ from your vehicle. Reprinting, translation and copying, even of excerpts, are not permitted without our prior authorization in writing. Press time October 13, 2006 GSP/TID Printed in U. S. A.
advertisement
Key Features
- Retractable Hardtop
- SmartKey
- ESP®
- ABS
- BAS
- Multifunction Steering Wheel
- Climate Control
- Audio System
- Power Windows
- Cruise Control
Related manuals
Frequently Answers and Questions
How do I use the SmartKey to unlock and start the engine?
The SmartKey provides keyless entry and ignition. To unlock, simply have the key fob in your pocket or bag and press the handle. To start, turn the ignition switch to position "Start" and release the button.
What is the role of the ESP® system in my SLK Class?
ESP® is an electronic stability program designed to help maintain vehicle stability during challenging driving conditions. It works by adjusting engine power and applying brakes to individual wheels.
How do I adjust the climate control settings in my SLK Class?
The climate control system allows you to adjust temperature, air distribution, and fan speed. Use the buttons and controls on the center console to set your preferred comfort level.